US20170087381A1 - Charged particle cancer therapy patient constraint apparatus and method of use thereof - Google Patents
Charged particle cancer therapy patient constraint apparatus and method of use thereof Download PDFInfo
- Publication number
- US20170087381A1 US20170087381A1 US15/232,512 US201615232512A US2017087381A1 US 20170087381 A1 US20170087381 A1 US 20170087381A1 US 201615232512 A US201615232512 A US 201615232512A US 2017087381 A1 US2017087381 A1 US 2017087381A1
- Authority
- US
- United States
- Prior art keywords
- patient
- tumor
- proton
- axis
- charged particle
- Prior art date
- Legal status (The legal status is an assumption and is not a legal conclusion. Google has not performed a legal analysis and makes no representation as to the accuracy of the status listed.)
- Abandoned
Links
- YENRYPGPPWPITJ-UHFFFAOYSA-N C=C1C(CC2)C2CC1 Chemical compound C=C1C(CC2)C2CC1 YENRYPGPPWPITJ-UHFFFAOYSA-N 0.000 description 1
- 0 CC1CC(*)CCC1 Chemical compound CC1CC(*)CCC1 0.000 description 1
Images
Classifications
-
- A—HUMAN NECESSITIES
- A61—MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
- A61N—ELECTROTHERAPY; MAGNETOTHERAPY; RADIATION THERAPY; ULTRASOUND THERAPY
- A61N5/00—Radiation therapy
- A61N5/10—X-ray therapy; Gamma-ray therapy; Particle-irradiation therapy
-
- A—HUMAN NECESSITIES
- A61—MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
- A61N—ELECTROTHERAPY; MAGNETOTHERAPY; RADIATION THERAPY; ULTRASOUND THERAPY
- A61N5/00—Radiation therapy
- A61N5/10—X-ray therapy; Gamma-ray therapy; Particle-irradiation therapy
- A61N5/1048—Monitoring, verifying, controlling systems and methods
- A61N5/1064—Monitoring, verifying, controlling systems and methods for adjusting radiation treatment in response to monitoring
- A61N5/1069—Target adjustment, e.g. moving the patient support
-
- A—HUMAN NECESSITIES
- A61—MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
- A61N—ELECTROTHERAPY; MAGNETOTHERAPY; RADIATION THERAPY; ULTRASOUND THERAPY
- A61N5/00—Radiation therapy
- A61N5/10—X-ray therapy; Gamma-ray therapy; Particle-irradiation therapy
- A61N5/1048—Monitoring, verifying, controlling systems and methods
- A61N5/1064—Monitoring, verifying, controlling systems and methods for adjusting radiation treatment in response to monitoring
- A61N5/1069—Target adjustment, e.g. moving the patient support
- A61N5/107—Target adjustment, e.g. moving the patient support in real time, i.e. during treatment
-
- A—HUMAN NECESSITIES
- A61—MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
- A61N—ELECTROTHERAPY; MAGNETOTHERAPY; RADIATION THERAPY; ULTRASOUND THERAPY
- A61N5/00—Radiation therapy
- A61N5/10—X-ray therapy; Gamma-ray therapy; Particle-irradiation therapy
- A61N5/1077—Beam delivery systems
- A61N5/1081—Rotating beam systems with a specific mechanical construction, e.g. gantries
- A61N5/1082—Rotating beam systems with a specific mechanical construction, e.g. gantries having multiple beam rotation axes
-
- A—HUMAN NECESSITIES
- A61—MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
- A61N—ELECTROTHERAPY; MAGNETOTHERAPY; RADIATION THERAPY; ULTRASOUND THERAPY
- A61N5/00—Radiation therapy
- A61N5/10—X-ray therapy; Gamma-ray therapy; Particle-irradiation therapy
- A61N2005/1085—X-ray therapy; Gamma-ray therapy; Particle-irradiation therapy characterised by the type of particles applied to the patient
- A61N2005/1087—Ions; Protons
-
- A—HUMAN NECESSITIES
- A61—MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
- A61N—ELECTROTHERAPY; MAGNETOTHERAPY; RADIATION THERAPY; ULTRASOUND THERAPY
- A61N5/00—Radiation therapy
- A61N5/10—X-ray therapy; Gamma-ray therapy; Particle-irradiation therapy
- A61N2005/1092—Details
- A61N2005/1097—Means for immobilizing the patient
-
- A—HUMAN NECESSITIES
- A61—MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
- A61N—ELECTROTHERAPY; MAGNETOTHERAPY; RADIATION THERAPY; ULTRASOUND THERAPY
- A61N5/00—Radiation therapy
- A61N5/10—X-ray therapy; Gamma-ray therapy; Particle-irradiation therapy
- A61N5/1077—Beam delivery systems
Definitions
- This invention relates generally to a patient positioning/constraint system.
- Proton therapy works by aiming energetic ionizing particles, such as protons accelerated with a particle accelerator, onto a target tumor. These particles damage the DNA of cells, ultimately causing their death. Cancerous cells, because of their high rate of division and their reduced ability to repair damaged DNA, are particularly vulnerable to attack on their DNA.
- energetic ionizing particles such as protons accelerated with a particle accelerator
- Patents related to the current invention are summarized here.
- the invention comprises a patient positioning/constraint apparatus and method of use thereof.
- FIG. 1 illustrates component connections of a charged particle beam therapy system
- FIG. 2 illustrates a charged particle therapy system
- FIG. 3 illustrates an ion beam generation system
- FIG. 4A and FIG. 4B illustrate negative ion beam sources
- FIG. 5 illustrates an ion beam focusing system
- FIGS. 6 (A-D) illustrate focusing electrodes about a negative ion beam path
- FIG. 7A illustrates a negative ion beam path vacuum system
- FIG. 7B illustrates a support structure
- FIG. 7C illustrates a foil
- FIG. 7D illustrates a carbon ion beam injector
- FIG. 8 is a particle beam therapy control flowchart
- FIG. 9 illustrates straight and turning sections of a synchrotron
- FIG. 10 illustrates bending magnets of a synchrotron
- FIG. 11 provides a perspective view of a bending magnet
- FIG. 12 illustrates coil geometry about a bending magnet
- FIG. 13 illustrates a cross-sectional view of a bending magnet
- FIG. 14 illustrates magnetic field concentration in a bending magnet
- FIG. 15 illustrates correction coils in a bending magnet
- FIG. 16 illustrates a magnetic turning section of a synchrotron
- FIG. 17A and FIG. 17B illustrate an RF accelerator and an RF accelerator subsystem, respectively;
- FIG. 18A illustrates a charged particle extraction system and FIG. 18B and FIG. 18C illustrate charged particles with different energy levels penetrating different distances into a body;
- FIG. 19 illustrates a charged particle extraction and intensity control system
- FIG. 20A and FIG. 20B illustrate proton beam position verification systems
- FIG. 21A and FIG. 21B respectively illustrate a patient positioning system from: (A) a front view and (B) a top view;
- FIG. 22 provides X-ray, proton, and carbon beam dose distributions
- FIGS. 23 illustrate controlled scanning and depth of focus irradiation
- FIGS. 24 (A-E) illustrate multi-field irradiation
- FIG. 25 illustrates dose efficiency enhancement via use of multi-field irradiation
- FIGS. 26 (A-C) and FIG. 26E illustrate distal irradiation of a tumor from varying rotational directions and FIG. 26D illustrates integrated radiation resulting from distal radiation;
- FIG. 27A and FIG. 27B illustrate multi-dimensional scanning of a charged particle beam spot scanning system operating on (A) a 2-D slice or (B) a 3-D volume of a tumor, respectively;
- FIG. 28A illustrates irradiating varying depths within a tumor and FIG. 28B illustrates changes in irradiation intensity correlating with the varying depths in the tumor;
- FIG. 29 illustrates an electron gun source used in generating X-rays coupled with a particle beam therapy system
- FIG. 30 illustrates an X-ray source proximate a particle beam path
- FIG. 31 illustrates an expanded X-ray beam path
- FIG. 32 provides an X-ray tomography system
- FIG. 33 illustrates a semi-vertical patient positioning system
- FIG. 34 provides an example of a sitting patient positioning system
- FIG. 35 illustrates a laying patient positioning system
- FIG. 36 illustrates a head restraint system
- FIG. 37 illustrates hand and head supports
- FIG. 38 illustrates a rapid patient positioning system
- FIGS. 39 (A-C) illustrate a patient constraint system
- FIG. 40 provides a method of positioning, imaging, and irradiating a tumor
- FIG. 41 provides a method of imaging a tumor with rotation of the patient
- FIG. 42 provides a method of coordinating X-ray collection with patient respiration
- FIG. 43 provides a method of charged particle beam control
- FIG. 44 provides a method of multi-axis charged particle beam irradiation control
- FIG. 45 illustrates a patient positioning, immobilization, and repositioning system
- FIG. 46 shows particle field acceleration timed to a patient's respiration cycle
- FIG. 47 illustrates adjustable particle field acceleration timing
- FIG. 48 illustrates charged particle cancer therapy controllers
- FIGS. 49 (A-D) illustrate searing a tumor perimeter with time
- FIG. 50 illustrates search offset concentric tumor perimeters
- FIG. 51A and FIG. 51B illustrate overlapping and interwoven searing layers
- FIG. 52A illustrates a fast magnet
- FIG. 52B and FIG. 52C illustrate low and high voltage control, respectively
- FIG. 52D and FIG. 52E illustrate a circuit switch and corresponding current control, respectively;
- FIGS. 53 (A-F) illustrate a rotatable beamline magnet relative to a rotatable patient positioning system
- FIGS. 54 illustrate a tiltable patient side/back support system and FIG. 54D illustrates multiple treatment angles of a tumor using the side/back support system;
- FIGS. 55 (A-C) illustrate co-movement of an imaging beam path and a positively charged particle beam path with gantry movement
- FIG. 56 illustrates a charged particle tomography system
- the invention comprises a patient positioning/constraint apparatus and method of use thereof.
- a patient is tilted about a longitudinal axis, such as rotation about a head-to-foot axis of the patient where the head-to-foot axis of the patient is horizontal.
- Optional side support constraints are optionally used to constrain radial movement of the patient on the tilted patient support.
- the side support constraints are optionally formed to or coupled to a radially outer shape of an individual patient, such as the dexter or sinister side of the individual's head, arm, torso, hip, and/or leg.
- Patient tilt is optionally combined with rotation of the patient about a vertical axis, rotation of the entire patient about an axis not overlapped by the patient, and/or control angles of the charged particle beam through use of guiding magnets in a beamline of the charged particle therapy system.
- the synchrotron includes: turning magnets, edge focusing magnets, magnetic field concentration magnets, winding and correction coils, flat magnetic field incident surfaces, and extraction elements, which minimize the overall size of the synchrotron, provide a tightly controlled proton beam, directly reduce the size of required magnetic fields, directly reduce required operating power, and allow continual acceleration of protons in a synchrotron even during a process of extracting protons from the synchrotron.
- the ion beam source system and synchrotron are preferably computer integrated with a patient imaging system and a patient interface including respiration monitoring sensors and patient positioning elements. Further, the system is integrated with intensity control of a charged particle beam, acceleration, extraction, and/or targeting method and apparatus. More particularly, intensity, energy, and timing control of a charged particle stream of a synchrotron is coordinated with patient positioning and tumor treatment.
- the synchrotron control elements allow tight control of the charged particle beam, which compliments the tight control of patient positioning to yield efficient treatment of a solid tumor with reduced tissue damage to surrounding healthy tissue.
- the system reduces the overall size of the synchrotron, provides a tightly controlled proton beam, directly reduces the size of required magnetic fields, directly reduces required operating power, and allows continual acceleration of protons in a synchrotron even during a process of extracting protons from the synchrotron.
- All of these systems are preferably used in conjunction with an X-ray system capable of collecting X-rays of a patient: (1) in a positioning, immobilization, and automated repositioning system for proton treatment; (2) at a specified moment of the patient's respiration cycle; and (3) using coordinated translation and rotation of the patient.
- the systems provide for efficient, accurate, and precise noninvasive tumor treatment with minimal damage to surrounding healthy tissue.
- the charged particle cancer therapy system incorporates any of:
- safety systems for a charged particle system are implemented.
- the safety system includes any of: multiple X-ray images from multiple directions, a three-dimensional X-ray image, a proton beam approximating a path of an X-ray beam, tight control of a proton beam cross-sectional area with magnets, ability to control proton beam energy, ability to control proton beam energy, a set of patient movement constrains, a patient controlled charged particle interrupt system, distribution of radiation around a tumor, and timed irradiation in terms of respiration.
- the tumor is imaged from multiple directions in phase with patient respiration. For example, a plurality of two-dimensional pictures are collected that are all in the about the same phase of respiration. The two-dimensional pictures are combined to produce a three-dimensional picture of the tumor relative to the patient.
- One or more safety features are optionally used in the charged particle cancer therapy system independently and/or in combination with the three-dimensional imaging system, as described infra.
- the system independently controls patient translation position, patient rotation position, two-dimensional beam trajectory, delivered radiation beam energy, delivered radiation beam intensity, timing of charged particle delivery, beam velocity, and/or distribution of radiation striking healthy tissue.
- the system operates in conjunction with a negative ion beam source, synchrotron, patient positioning, imaging, and/or targeting method and apparatus to deliver an effective and uniform dose of radiation to a tumor while distributing radiation striking healthy tissue.
- a charged particle beam therapy system such as a proton beam, hydrogen ion beam, or carbon ion beam
- the charged particle beam therapy system is described using a proton beam.
- the aspects taught and described in terms of a proton beam are not intended to be limiting to that of a proton beam and are illustrative of a charged particle beam system. Any of the techniques described herein are equally applicable to any charged particle beam system.
- the charged particle beam preferably comprises a number of subsystems including any of: a main controller 110 ; an injection system 120 ; a synchrotron 130 that typically includes: (1) an accelerator system 132 and (2) an extraction system 134 ; a scanning/targeting/delivery system 140 ; a patient interface module 150 ; a display system 160 ; and/or an imaging system 170 .
- the main controller 110 controls one or more of the subsystems to accurately and precisely deliver protons to a tumor of a patient. For example, the main controller 110 obtains an image, such as a portion of a body and/or of a tumor, from the imaging system 170 . The main controller 110 also obtains position and/or timing information from the patient interface module 150 . The main controller 110 then optionally controls the injection system 120 to inject a proton into a synchrotron 130 .
- the synchrotron typically contains at least an accelerator system 132 and an extraction system 134 .
- the main controller 110 preferably controls the proton beam within the accelerator system, such as by controlling speed, trajectory, and timing of the proton beam.
- the main controller then controls extraction of a proton beam from the accelerator through the extraction system 134 .
- the controller controls timing, energy, and/or intensity of the extracted beam.
- the controller 110 also preferably controls targeting of the proton beam through the scanning/targeting/delivery system 140 to the patient interface module 150 .
- One or more components of the patient interface module 150 are preferably controlled by the main controller 110 .
- display elements of the display system 160 are preferably controlled via the main controller 110 . Displays, such as display screens, are typically provided to one or more operators and/or to one or more patients.
- the main controller 110 times the delivery of the proton beam from all systems, such that protons are delivered in an optimal therapeutic manner to the tumor of the patient.
- the main controller 110 refers to a single system controlling the charged particle beam system 100 , to a single controller controlling a plurality of subsystems controlling the charged particle beam system 100 , or to a plurality of individual controllers controlling one or more sub-systems of the charged particle beam system 100 .
- the injection system 120 or ion source or charged particle beam source generates protons.
- the protons are delivered into a vacuum tube that runs into, through, and out of the synchrotron.
- the generated protons are delivered along an initial path 262 .
- Focusing magnets 230 such as quadrupole magnets or injection quadrupole magnets, are used to focus the proton beam path.
- a quadrupole magnet is a focusing magnet.
- An injector bending magnet 232 bends the proton beam toward the plane of the synchrotron 130 .
- the focused protons having an initial energy are introduced into an injector magnet 240 , which is preferably an injection Lambertson magnet.
- the initial beam path 262 is along an axis off of, such as above, a circulating plane of the synchrotron 130 .
- the injector bending magnet 232 and injector magnet 240 combine to move the protons into the synchrotron 130 .
- Main bending magnets, dipole magnets, turning magnets, or circulating magnets 250 are used to turn the protons along a circulating beam path 264 .
- a dipole magnet is a bending magnet.
- the main bending magnets 250 bend the initial beam path 262 into a circulating beam path 264 .
- the main bending magnets 250 or circulating magnets are represented as four sets of four magnets to maintain the circulating beam path 264 into a stable circulating beam path.
- any number of magnets or sets of magnets are optionally used to move the protons around a single orbit in the circulation process.
- the protons pass through an accelerator 270 .
- the accelerator accelerates the protons in the circulating beam path 264 .
- the fields applied by the magnets are increased.
- the speed of the protons achieved by the accelerator 270 are synchronized with magnetic fields of the main bending magnets 250 or circulating magnets to maintain stable circulation of the protons about a central point or region 280 of the synchrotron.
- the accelerator 270 /main bending magnet 250 combination is used to accelerate and/or decelerate the circulating protons while maintaining the protons in the circulating path or orbit.
- An extraction element of the inflector/deflector system 290 is used in combination with a Lambertson extraction magnet 292 to remove protons from their circulating beam path 264 within the synchrotron 130 .
- a deflector component is a Lambertson magnet. Typically the deflector moves the protons from the circulating plane to an axis off of the circulating plane, such as above the circulating plane.
- Extracted protons are preferably directed and/or focused using an extraction bending magnet 237 and extraction focusing magnets 235 , such as quadrupole magnets along a transport path 268 into the scanning/targeting/delivery system 140 .
- Two components of a scanning system 140 or targeting system typically include a first axis control 142 , such as a vertical control, and a second axis control 144 , such as a horizontal control.
- the first axis control 142 allows for about 100 mm of vertical or y-axis scanning of the proton beam 268 and the second axis control 144 allows for about 700 mm of horizontal or x-axis scanning of the proton beam 268 .
- a nozzle system 146 is used for imaging the proton beam and/or as a vacuum barrier between the low pressure beam path of the synchrotron and the atmosphere. Protons are delivered with control to the patient interface module 150 and to a tumor of a patient. All of the above listed elements are optional and may be used in various permutations and combinations. Each of the above listed elements are further described, infra.
- An ion beam generation system generates a negative ion beam, such as a hydrogen anion or H ⁇ beam; preferably focuses the negative ion beam; converts the negative ion beam to a positive ion beam, such as a proton or H + beam; and injects the positive ion beam 262 into the synchrotron 130 .
- a negative ion beam such as a hydrogen anion or H ⁇ beam
- a positive ion beam such as a proton or H + beam
- injects the positive ion beam 262 into the synchrotron 130 preferably under partial vacuum.
- the ion beam generation system 300 has four major subsections: a negative ion source 310 , a first partial vacuum system 330 , an optional ion beam focusing system 350 , and a tandem accelerator 390 .
- the negative ion source 310 preferably includes an injection port 312 , for injection of hydrogen gas or methane gas, into a high temperature plasma chamber 314 .
- the plasma chamber includes a magnetic material 316 , which provides a magnetic field 317 between the high temperature plasma chamber 314 and a low temperature plasma region on the opposite side of the magnetic field barrier.
- An extraction pulse is applied to a negative ion extraction electrode 318 to pull the negative ion beam into a negative ion beam path 319 , which proceeds through the first partial vacuum system 330 , through the ion beam focusing system 350 , and into the tandem accelerator 390 .
- Examples of negative ions in the negative ion beam path include H ⁇ , C ⁇ , or any anion.
- the first partial vacuum system 330 is an enclosed system running from the injection port 312 to a foil 395 in the tandem accelerator 390 .
- the foil 395 is preferably sealed directly or indirectly to the edges of the vacuum tube 320 providing for a higher pressure, such as about 10 ⁇ 5 torr, to be maintained on the first partial vacuum system side of the foil 395 and a lower pressure, such as about 10 ⁇ 7 torr, to be maintained on the synchrotron side of the foil.
- the first partial vacuum system 330 preferably includes: a first pump 332 , such as a continuously operating pump and/or a turbo molecular pump; a large holding volume 334 ; and a semi-continuously operating pump 336 .
- a pump controller 340 receives a signal from a pressure sensor 342 monitoring pressure in the large holding volume 334 .
- the pump controller 340 instructs an actuator 345 to open a valve 346 between the large holding volume and the semi-continuously operating pump 336 and instructs the semi-continuously operating pump to turn on and pump to atmosphere residual gases out of the vacuum line 320 about the charged particle stream.
- the lifetime of the semi-continuously operating pump is extended by only operating semi-continuously and as needed.
- the semi-continuously operating pump 336 operates for a few minutes every few hours, such as 5 minutes every 4 hours, thereby extending a pump with a lifetime of about 2,000 hours to about 96,000 hours.
- the synchrotron vacuum pumps such as turbo molecular pumps can operate over a longer lifetime as the synchrotron vacuum pumps have fewer gas molecules to deal with.
- the inlet gas is primarily hydrogen gas but may contain impurities, such as nitrogen and carbon dioxide.
- the optimal ion beam focusing system 350 preferably includes two or more electrodes where one electrode of each electrode pair partially obstructs the ion beam path with conductive paths 372 , such as a conductive mesh.
- conductive paths 372 such as a conductive mesh.
- two ion beam focusing system sections are illustrated, a two electrode ion beam focusing section 360 and a three electrode ion beam focusing section 370 .
- electric field lines running between the conductive mesh of a first electrode and a second electrode, provide inward forces focusing the negative ion beam. Multiple such electrode pairs provide multiple negative ion beam focusing regions.
- the two electrode ion focusing section 360 and the three electrode ion focusing section 370 are placed after the negative ion source and before the tandem accelerator and/or cover a space of about 0.5, 1, or 2 meters along the ion beam path 319 .
- Ion beam focusing systems are further described, infra.
- the tandem accelerator 390 preferably includes a foil 395 , such as a carbon foil.
- the negative ions in the negative ion beam path 319 are converted to positive ions, such as protons, and the initial ion beam path 262 results.
- the foil 395 is preferably sealed directly or indirectly to the edges of the vacuum tube 320 providing for a higher pressure, such as about 10 ⁇ 5 torr, to be maintained on the side of the foil 395 having the negative ion beam path 319 and a lower pressure, such as about 10 ⁇ 7 torr, to be maintained on the side of the foil 390 having the proton ion beam path 262 .
- Having the foil 395 physically separating the vacuum chamber 320 into two pressure regions allows for a system having fewer and/or smaller pumps to maintain the lower pressure system in the synchrotron 130 as the inlet hydrogen and its residuals are extracted in a separate contained and isolated space by the first partial vacuum system 330 .
- FIG. 4A and FIG. 4B cross-sections of two exemplary negative ion source systems are provided.
- a first negative ion source system 400 is illustrated for the formation of a H ⁇ ; however, the first negative ion source system 400 is optionally used to generate any negative ion, such as C.
- a second negative ion source system 405 is illustrated for the formation of as C ⁇ ; however, the second negative ion source system 405 is optionally used to generate any negative ion, such as H ⁇ .
- the first and second negative ion source systems 400 , 405 are further described, infra.
- the negative ion beam 319 is created in multiple stages.
- an element source such as hydrogen gas or methane gas is injected into a chamber.
- a negative ion is created by application of a first high voltage pulse, which creates a plasma about the hydrogen gas or methane gas to create negative ions.
- the negative ions are extracted from the plasma region by application of a second high voltage pulse.
- the chamber is illustrated as a cross-section of a cylinder, the cylinder is exemplary only and any geometry applies to the outer housing and central chamber.
- the first negative ion source system 400 is illustrated for ease of presentation using hydrogen gas to create a H ⁇ ion beam. More generally, an element in a molecule is injected and an ion of the element is extracted.
- gas 440 such as hydrogen gas
- gas 440 is injected through the injection port 312 into a high temperature plasma region 490 .
- the injection port 312 is open for a short period of time, such as less than about 1, 5, or 10 microseconds to minimize vacuum pump requirements to maintain vacuum chamber 320 requirements.
- the high temperature plasma region is maintained at reduced pressure by the partial vacuum system 330 .
- the injection of the hydrogen gas is optionally controlled by the main controller 110 , which is responsive to imaging system 170 information and patient interface module 150 information, such as patient positioning and period in a respiration cycle.
- a high temperature plasma region is created by applying a first high voltage pulse across a first electrode 422 and a second electrode 424 .
- a 5 kV pulse is applied for about 20 microseconds with 5 kV at the second electrode 424 and about 0 kV applied at the first electrode 422 .
- Hydrogen in the chamber is broken, in the high temperature plasma region 490 , into component parts, such as any of: atomic hydrogen, H 0 , a proton, H + , an electron, e ⁇ , and a hydrogen anion, H ⁇ .
- the high temperature plasma region 490 is at least partially separated from a low temperature plasma region 493 by the magnetic field 317 or in this specific example a magnetic field barrier 430 .
- High energy electrons are restricted from passing through the magnetic field barrier 430 .
- the magnetic field barrier 430 acts as a filter between, zone A and zone B, in the negative ion source.
- a central magnetic material 410 which is an example of the magnetic material 316 , is placed within the high temperature plasma region 490 , such as along a central axis of the high temperature plasma region 490 .
- the first electrode 422 and second electrode 424 are composed of magnetic materials, such as iron.
- the outer walls 450 of the high temperature plasma region are composed of a magnetic material, such as a permanent magnet, ferric or iron based material, or a ferrite dielectric ring magnet.
- a magnetic field loop is created by: the central magnetic material 410 , first electrode 422 , the outer walls 450 , the second electrode 424 , and the magnetic field barrier 430 .
- the magnetic field barrier 430 restricts high energy electrons from passing through the magnetic field barrier 430 .
- Low energy electrons interact with atomic hydrogen, H 0 , to create a hydrogen anion, H ⁇ , in the low temperature plasma region 493 .
- a second high voltage pulse or extraction pulse is applied at a third electrode 426 .
- the second high voltage pulse is preferentially applied during the later period of application of the first high voltage pulse.
- an extraction pulse of about 25 kV is applied for about the last 5 microseconds of the first creation pulse of about 20 microseconds.
- the potential difference, of about 20 kV, between the third electrode 426 and second electrode 424 extracts the negative ion, H ⁇ , from the low temperature plasma region 493 and initiates the negative ion beam 319 , from zone B to zone C.
- the magnetic field barrier 430 is optionally created in a number of ways.
- An example of creation of the magnetic field barrier 430 using coils is provided.
- the elements described, supra, in relation to FIG. 4A are maintained with several differences.
- the magnetic field is created using coils.
- An isolating material is preferably provided between the first electrode 422 and the cylinder walls 450 as well as between the second electrode 424 and the cylinder walls 450 .
- the central material 410 and/or cylinder walls 450 are optionally metallic. In this manner, the coils create a magnetic field loop through the first electrode 422 , isolating material, outer walls 450 , second electrode 424 , magnetic field barrier 430 , and the central material 410 .
- the coils generate a magnetic field in place of production of the magnetic field by the magnetic material 410 .
- the magnetic field barrier 430 operates as described, supra. Generally, any manner that creates the magnetic field barrier 430 between the high temperature plasma region 490 and low temperature plasma region 493 is functionally applicable to the ion beam extraction system 400 , described herein.
- the second negative ion source system 405 is illustrated for ease of presentation using methane gas to create a C ⁇ ion beam.
- an element in molecular, ionic, or elemental form is injected into the second negative ion source system 405 and an ion of the element is extracted from the second negative ion source system 405 .
- the second negative ion source system 405 generates an anion in a high temperature plasma region 490 as described, supra, for the first negative ion source system 400 and electrodes, such as the first electrode 422 and the second electrode 424 , are used to extract the anion. Differences between the first and second negative ion source systems 400 , 405 are described infra.
- the injection port 312 of the second negative ion source system 405 is illustrated as leading through an injection passage 482 or plenum of a central member 480 to an opening proximate the center of the high temperature plasma region 490 .
- the gas inlet opening to the high temperature plasma region is optionally any point connected to the high temperature plasma region 490 .
- the central member 480 is preferably a non-magnetic material and is preferably a rod or tube of any cross-sectional shape, where a circular cross-sectional shape is preferred.
- the central member 480 is held at a low potential relative to the second electrode 424 , is electrically connected to a first containment wall, described infra, and/or is maintained at about zero volts.
- the high temperature plasma region 490 includes a zone between a first containment wall 460 and the second electrode 424 .
- the first containment wall 460 and the second electrode comprise a magnetic material, such as a ferromagnetic material.
- the first containment wall 460 and the second electrode are separated by a non-conductive material, such as stainless steel.
- the non-conductive material comprises a set of four stainless steel rings, though any number of rings is optionally used and the geometry is optionally of any shape separating the voltage difference between ends of the high temperature plasma region 490 along the x-axis.
- a non-magnetic anode 484 preferably connected to the second electrode 424 or an end of the high temperature plasma region 490 opposite to the first containment wall.
- the non-magnetic anode is optionally of any geometry, but a solid elongated cross-section, tube, or 3-D tube is preferred.
- the second negative ion source uses an electric field pulse crossing a magnetic field, to form conditions used to create a magnetron discharge, to break apart the element source, such as CH 4 , to form the negative ion, such as C ⁇ , where the second and third electrodes 424 , 426 are used to extract the negative ion beam 319 or C ⁇ from the high temperature plasma region 490 , as described supra, but without the magnetic field barrier 430 .
- a magnetic field which is preferably a uniform magnetic field 491 , is maintained along the x-axis in the high temperature plasma region 490 between the first containment wall 460 and the second electrode 424 by a maintained or pulsed voltage difference between the second electrode 424 and the first containment wall 460 .
- an electric field which is preferably a uniform electric field 492 is maintained or pulsed across the high temperature plasma region 490 between the non-magnetic central member 480 and the non-magnetic anode 484 .
- Pulse times are optionally as described, supra, for the first negative ion source system 400 .
- the about uniform magnetic field 491 along the x-axis crosses the about uniform electric field 492 along any combination of the y- and z-axes at about a right angle.
- the illustrated methane source is broken down into: (1) hydrogen constituents, such as atomic hydrogen, H 0 , a proton, H + , an electron, e ⁇ , and a hydrogen anion, H ⁇ and (2) carbon constituents, such as atomic carbon, C 0 , various carbon cations, electrons, e ⁇ , and various forms of carbon anions, such as C.
- the C ⁇ ion is extracted from the high temperature plasma region 490 by the second and third electrodes 424 , 426 .
- the C ⁇ anion is subsequently accelerated toward the synchrotron 130 using the ion beam focusing system 350 and/or the tandem accelerator 390 , as described infra.
- a first electrode 510 and third electrode 530 are both negatively charged and each is a ring electrode circumferentially enclosing or at least partially enclosing the negative ion beam path 319 .
- a second electrode 520 is positively charged and is also a ring electrode at least partially and preferably substantially circumferentially enclosing the negative ion beam path.
- the second electrode includes one or more conducting paths 372 running through the negative ion beam path 319 .
- the conducting paths are a wire mesh, a conducting grid, or a series of substantially parallel conducting lines running across the second electrode.
- electric field lines run from the conducting paths of the positively charged electrode to the negatively charged electrodes.
- the electric field lines 540 run from the conducting paths 372 in the negative ion beam path 319 to the negatively charged electrodes 510 , 530 .
- Two ray trace lines 550 , 560 of the negative ion beam path are used to illustrate focusing forces.
- the first ray trace line 550 the negative ion beam encounters a first electric field line at point M.
- Negatively charged ions in the negative ion beam 550 encounter forces running up the electric field line 572 , illustrated with an x-axis component vector 571 .
- the x-axis component force vectors 571 alters the trajectory of the first ray trace line to a inward focused vector 552 , which encounters a second electric field line at point N.
- the negative ion beam 552 encounters forces running up the electric field line 574 , illustrated as having an inward force vector with an x-axis component 573 , which alters the inward focused vector 552 to a more inward focused vector 554 .
- the negative ion beam encounters a first electric field line at point O.
- Negatively charged ions in the negative ion beam encounter forces running up the electric field line 576 , illustrated as having a force vector with an x-axis force 575 .
- the inward force vector 575 alters the trajectory of the second ray trace line 560 to an inward focused vector 562 , which encounters a second electric field line at point P.
- the negative ion beam encounters forces running up the electric field line 578 , illustrated as having force vector with an x-axis component 577 , which alters the inward focused vector 562 to a more inward focused vector 564 .
- the net result is a focusing effect on the negative ion beam.
- Each of the force vectors 572 , 574 , 576 , 578 optionally has x and/or y force vector components resulting in a 3-dimensional focusing of the negative ion beam path.
- the force vectors are illustrative in nature, many electric field lines are encountered, and the focusing effect is observed at each encounter resulting in integral focusing. The example is used to illustrate the focusing effect.
- any number of electrodes are used, such as 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, 7, 8, or 9 electrodes, to focus the negative ion beam path where every other electrode, in a given focusing section, is either positively or negatively charged.
- three focusing sections are optionally used.
- the first ion focusing section 360 a pair of electrodes is used where the first electrode encountered along the negative ion beam path is negatively charged and the second electrode is positively charged, resulting in focusing of the negative ion beam path.
- the second ion focusing section 370 two pairs of electrodes are used, where a common positively charged electrode with a conductive mesh running through the negatively ion beam path 319 is used.
- the first electrode encountered along the negative ion beam path is negatively charged and the second electrode is positively charged, resulting in focusing of the negative ion beam path.
- the second ion focusing section moving along the negative ion beam path, a second focusing effect is observed between the second positively charged electrode and a third negatively charged electrode.
- a third ion focusing section is used that again has three electrodes, which acts in the fashion of the second ion focusing section, described supra.
- the central region of the electrodes in the ion beam focusing system 350 is further described.
- the central region of the negatively charged ring electrode 510 is preferably void of conductive material.
- the central region of positively charged electrode ring 520 preferably contains conductive paths 372 .
- the conductive paths 372 or conductive material within the positively charged electrode ring 520 blocks about 1, 2, 5, or 10 percent of the area and more preferably blocks about five percent of the cross-sectional area of the negative ion beam path 319 .
- one option is a conductive mesh 610 . Referring now to FIG.
- a second option is a series of conductive lines 620 running substantially in parallel across the positively charged electrode ring 520 that surrounds a portion of the negative ion beam path 319 .
- a third option is to have a foil 630 or metallic layer cover all of the cross-sectional area of the negative ion beam path with holes punched through the material, where the holes take up about 90-99 percent and more preferably about 95 percent of the area of the foil.
- the pair of electrodes 510 , 520 are configured to provide electric field lines that provide focusing force vectors to the negative ion beam 319 when the ions in the negative ion beam 319 translate through the electric field lines, as described supra.
- the negative ions are focused to a second cross-sectional diameter, d 2 , where d 1 >d 2 .
- the negative ions are focused using the three electrode system to a third negative ion beam cross-sectional diameter, d 3 , where d 1 >d 3 .
- the three electrode system provides tighter or stronger focusing compared to the two-electrode system, d 3 ⁇ d 2 .
- the electrodes are rings. More generally, the electrodes are of any geometry sufficient to provide electric field lines that provide focusing force vectors to the negative ion beam when the ions in the negative ion beam 319 translate through the electric field lines, as described supra.
- one negative ring electrode is optionally replaced by a number of negatively charged electrodes, such as about 2, 3, 4, 6, 8, 10, or more electrodes placed about the outer region of a cross-sectional area of the negative ion beam probe. Generally, more electrodes are required to converge or diverge a faster or higher energy beam.
- the negative ion beam is made to diverge.
- the negative ion beam path 319 is optionally focused and/or expanded using combinations of electrode pairs. For example, if the electrode having the mesh across the negative ion beam path is made negative, then the negative ion beam path is made to defocus.
- combinations of electrode pairs are used for focusing and defocusing a negative ion beam path, such as where a first pair includes a positively charged mesh for focusing and a where a second pair includes a negatively charged mesh for defocusing.
- tandem accelerator 390 is further described in terms of acceleration of H ⁇ and C ⁇ , respectively.
- the tandem accelerator accelerates ions using a series of electrodes 710 , 711 , 712 , 713 , 714 , 715 .
- negative ions such as H ⁇ or C ⁇
- in the negative ion beam path 319 are accelerated using a series of electrodes having progressively higher voltages relative to the voltage of the extraction electrode or third electrode 426 , of the negative ion beam source 310 .
- the tandem accelerator 390 optionally has electrodes ranging from the 25 kV of the extraction electrode to about 525 kV near the foil 395 in the tandem accelerator 390 while for C ⁇ the potential of the electrodes increase to about 3 MV or 3 MeV near the foil 395 .
- the tandem accelerator is illustrated in conjunction with electron stripping devices, such as a carbon foil stripping system 705 and/or a hydrogen gas stripping system 760 .
- electron stripping devices such as a carbon foil stripping system 705 and/or a hydrogen gas stripping system 760 .
- a stripping foil 395 is optionally used for proton formation.
- the stripping foil 395 is optionally used in conjunction with a hydrogen gas injected chamber. Both the proton and carbon ion beam formation systems are further described, infra.
- the proton is further accelerated in the tandem accelerator using appropriate voltages at a multitude of further electrodes 713 , 714 , 715 to pull the now positively charged ion forward.
- the protons are then injected into the synchrotron 130 as described, supra.
- the foil 395 in the tandem accelerator 390 is further described.
- the foil 395 is preferably a very thin carbon film of about thirty to two hundred angstroms in thickness.
- the foil thickness is designed to both: (1) not block the ion beam and (2) allow the transfer of electrons.
- the transfer of electrons yields the proton beam path 262 .
- the transfer of electrons yields the C 6+ beam path 263 .
- the proton beam path is used in subsequent illustrations and explanations; however, the C 6+ beam path 263 is optionally used in place of the proton beam path 262 .
- the foil 395 is preferably substantially in contact with a support layer 720 , such as a support grid.
- the support layer 720 provides mechanical strength to the foil 395 to combine to form a vacuum blocking element 725 .
- the foil 395 blocks nitrogen, carbon dioxide, hydrogen, and other gases, such as neutrally charged gases, from passing and thus acts as a vacuum barrier.
- the foil 395 is preferably sealed directly or indirectly to the edges of the vacuum tube 320 providing for a higher pressure, such as about 10 ⁇ 5 torr, to be maintained on the side of the foil 395 having the negative ion beam path 319 and a lower pressure, such as about 10 ⁇ 7 torr, to be maintained on the side of the foil 395 having the proton ion beam path 262 or carbon cation beam path 263 .
- the foil 395 and support layer 720 are preferably attached to the structure 750 of the tandem accelerator 390 or vacuum tube 320 to form a pressure barrier using any mechanical means, such as a metal, plastic, or ceramic ring 730 compressed to the walls with an attachment screw 740 . Any mechanical means for separating and sealing the two vacuum chamber sides with the foil 395 are equally applicable to this system. Referring now to FIG. 7B and FIG. 7C , examples of the support structure 720 and foil 395 are individually viewed in the x-, y-plane, respectively.
- a carbon anion such as C ⁇
- a carbon anion is initially converted into a multiply charged cation, a trivalent cation, a quadrivalent cation, a polyvalent cation, C 3+ , and/or C 4+ through stripping of electrons from the carbon anion, such as C ⁇ , by rapidly injected hydrogen gas, according to equations 2 and 3.
- the hydrogen gas, H 2(g) is injected into a vacuum tube 320 or secondary vacuum tube 762 passing through the primary vacuum tube 320 through use of a very fast switch 764 with an optional exit port 766 .
- the carbon ion injector the C 3+ cation, the C 4+ cation, or any cation of carbon retaining electrons is then passed through the foil 395 , where the carbon cations, such as C 4+ and C 3+ , lose additional electrons, such as two or three electrons, respectively, to yield a C 6+ cation, according to equations 4 and 5.
- stripping of the carbon anion uses either the hydrogen gas stripping system 760 , the carbon foil stripping system 705 , or the hydrogen gas stripping system 760 in combination with the carbon foil stripping system 705 to form the carbon cation accelerated in the synchrotron 130 , which is subsequently used for carbon ion therapy of the tumor 2120 .
- the carbon cation is not fully stripped of electrons.
- C + , C 2+ , C 3+ , C 4+ , and/or C 5+ are optionally accelerated in the synchrotron 130 and used to target the tumor 2120 using the charged particle therapy system 100 .
- the carbon foil stripping system 705 and/or the hydrogen gas stripping system 760 are optionally used to form cations of any element, such as any element with an atomic number up to twenty-six.
- the main controller 110 controls one or more of the subsystems to accurately and precisely deliver protons to a tumor of a patient. For example, the main controller sends a message to the patient indicating when or how to breathe.
- the main controller 110 obtains a sensor reading from the patient interface module, such as a temperature breath sensor or a force reading indicative of where in a respiration cycle the subject is. Coordinated at a specific and reproducible point in the respiration cycle, the main controller collects an image, such as a portion of a body and/or of a tumor, from the imaging system 170 .
- the main controller 110 also obtains position and/or timing information from the patient interface module 150 .
- the main controller 110 then optionally controls the injection system 120 to inject hydrogen gas into a negative ion beam source 310 and controls timing of extraction of the negative ion from the negative ion beam source 310 .
- the main controller controls ion beam focusing using the ion beam focusing lens system 350 ; acceleration of the proton beam with the tandem accelerator 390 ; and/or injection of the proton into the synchrotron 130 .
- the synchrotron typically contains at least an accelerator system 132 and an extraction system 134 .
- the synchrotron preferably contains one or more of: turning magnets, edge focusing magnets, magnetic field concentration magnets, winding and correction coils, and flat magnetic field incident surfaces, some of which contain elements under control by the main controller 110 .
- the main controller preferably controls the proton beam within the accelerator system, such as by controlling speed, trajectory, and/or timing of the proton beam.
- the main controller then controls extraction of a proton beam from the accelerator through the extraction system 134 . For example, the controller controls timing, energy, and/or intensity of the extracted beam.
- the main controller 110 also preferably controls targeting of the proton beam through the targeting/delivery system 140 to the patient interface module 150 .
- One or more components of the patient interface module 150 are preferably controlled by the main controller 110 , such as vertical position of the patient, rotational position of the patient, and patient chair positioning/stabilization/immobilization/control elements. Further, display elements of the display system 160 are preferably controlled via the main controller 110 . Displays, such as display screens, are typically provided to one or more operators and/or to one or more patients. In one embodiment, the main controller 110 times the delivery of the proton beam from all systems, such that protons are delivered in an optimal therapeutic manner to the tumor of the patient.
- synchrotron is used to refer to a system maintaining the charged particle beam in a circulating path.
- the charged particle beam is referred to herein as circulating along a circulating path about a central point of the synchrotron.
- the circulating path is alternatively referred to as an orbiting path; however, the orbiting path does not refer to a perfect circle or ellipse, rather it refers to cycling of the protons around a central point or region 280 .
- the synchrotron 130 preferably comprises a combination of straight sections 910 and ion beam turning sections 920 .
- the circulating path of the protons is not circular in a synchrotron, but is rather a polygon with rounded corners.
- the synchrotron 130 which is also referred to as an accelerator system, has four straight sections or elements and four turning sections.
- straight sections 910 include the: inflector 240 , accelerator 270 , extraction system 290 , and deflector 292 .
- ion beam turning sections 920 which are also referred to as magnet sections or turning sections. Turning sections are further described, infra.
- the synchrotron 130 comprises four straight sections 910 and four bending or turning sections 920 where each of the four turning sections use one or more magnets to turn the proton beam about ninety degrees.
- the ability to closely space the turning sections and efficiently turn the proton beam results in shorter straight sections. Shorter straight sections allow for a synchrotron design without the use of focusing quadrupoles in the circulating beam path of the synchrotron.
- the illustrated synchrotron has about a five meter diameter versus eight meter and larger cross-sectional diameters for systems using a quadrupole focusing magnet in the circulating proton beam path.
- Each of the turning sections preferably comprise multiple magnets, such as about 2, 4, 6, 8, 10, or 12 magnets.
- four turning magnets 1010 , 1020 , 1030 , 1040 in the first turning section 920 are used to illustrate key principles, which are the same regardless of the number of magnets in a turning section 920 .
- the turning magnets 1010 , 1020 , 1030 , 1040 are particular types of main bending or circulating magnets 250 .
- the Lorentz force is the force on a point charge due to electromagnetic fields.
- the Lorentz force is given by equation 6 in terms of magnetic fields with the electron field terms not included.
- Equation 6 F is the force in Newtons; q is the electric charge in coulombs; B is the magnetic field in Teslas; and v is the instantaneous velocity of the particles in meters per second.
- the turning section includes a gap 1110 through which protons circulate.
- the gap 1110 is preferably a flat gap, allowing for a magnetic field across the gap 1110 that is more uniform, even, and intense.
- a magnetic field enters the gap 1110 through a magnetic field incident surface and exits the gap 1110 through a magnetic field exiting surface.
- the gap 1110 runs in a vacuum tube between two magnet halves.
- the gap 1110 is controlled by at least two parameters: (1) the gap 1110 is kept as large as possible to minimize loss of protons and (2) the gap 1110 is kept as small as possible to minimize magnet sizes and the associated size and power requirements of the magnet power supplies.
- the flat nature of the gap 1110 allows for a compressed and more uniform magnetic field across the gap 1110 .
- One example of a gap dimension is to accommodate a vertical proton beam size of about two centimeters with a horizontal beam size of about five to six centimeters.
- a larger gap size requires a larger power supply. For instance, if the gap 1110 size doubles in vertical size, then the power supply requirements increase by about a factor of four.
- the flatness of the gap 1110 is also important. For example, the flat nature of the gap 1110 allows for an increase in energy of the extracted protons from about 250 to about 330 MeV. More particularly, if the gap 1110 has an extremely flat surface, then the limits of a magnetic field of an iron magnet are reachable.
- An exemplary precision of the flat surface of the gap 1110 is a polish of less than about five microns and preferably with a polish of about one to three microns. Unevenness in the surface results in imperfections in the applied magnetic field. The polished flat surface spreads unevenness of the applied magnetic field.
- the charged particle beam moves through the gap 1110 with an instantaneous velocity, v.
- a first magnetic coil 1120 and a second magnetic coil 1130 run above and below the gap 1110 , respectively.
- Current running through the coils 1120 , 1130 results in a magnetic field, B, running through the single magnet turning section 1010 .
- the magnetic field, B runs upward, which results in a force, F, pushing the charged particle beam inward toward a central point of the synchrotron, which turns the charged particle beam in an arc.
- FIG. 11 a portion of an optional second magnet bending or turning section 1020 is illustrated.
- the coils 1120 , 1130 typically have return elements 1140 , 1150 or turns at the end of one magnet, such as at the end of the first magnet turning section 1010 .
- the turns 1140, 1150 take space.
- the space reduces the percentage of the path about one orbit of the synchrotron that is covered by the turning magnets. This leads to portions of the circulating path where the protons are not turned and/or focused and allows for portions of the circulating path where the proton path defocuses.
- the space results in a larger synchrotron. Therefore, the space between magnet turning sections 1160 is preferably minimized.
- the second turning magnet is used to illustrate that the coils 1120 , 1130 optionally run along a plurality of magnets, such as 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, or more magnets. Coils 1120 , 1130 running across multiple turning section magnets allows for two turning section magnets to be spatially positioned closer to each other due to the removal of the steric constraint of the turns, which reduces and/or minimizes the space 1160 between two turning section magnets.
- a single main bending magnet 250 has a top half and a bottom half.
- FIG. 12 only the bottom halves of two sequential main bending magnets 250 are illustrated.
- the top halves, not illustrated for clarity of presentation, are essentially a repeat of the bottom halves rotated one hundred eighty degrees about the x-axis.
- the gap 1110 runs between the two halves.
- a shaped coil 1132 which is an example of the first winding coil 1250 and is further an example of the second magnetic coil 1130 , is wrapped about a central metal member 1211 , such as the first magnet 1210 , and between yoke members 1212 , which are also referred to as return yoke members of a first magnet 1210 .
- the gap 1110 runs directly above the central metal member 1211 .
- the shaped coil 1132 has a first width, w 1 , and a first thickness, t 1 , along the x-axis along the length of the magnet.
- the length of the magnet is along the axis of the circulating charged particle.
- the shaped coil 1132 has a second width, w 2 , and a second thickness, t 2 , along the y-axis at the end of the central metal member 1211 .
- the first width, w 1 is larger than the second width, w 2 .
- the smaller second width, w 2 allows a smaller distance, d 1 , between the first magnet turning section 1010 and the second magnet turning section 1020 .
- the first width, w 1 is more than about 1.1, 1.2, 1.3, 1.5, 1.75, 2.0, 2.25, or 2.5 times the second width, w 2 .
- the second thickness, t 2 is more than about 1.1, 1.2, 1.3, 1.5, 1.75, 2.0, 2.25, or 2.5 times the first thickness, t 1 .
- the second thickness, t 2 , of the coil 1130 along the y-axis at the end of the first magnet turning section 1010 or similarly at the end of central metal member 1211 is larger than the first thickness, t 1 , of the shaped coil 1132 along the x-axis between the yoke members 1212 , which allows a current along the x-axis length of the coil 1130 to be maintained when running along the y-axis as the end of the coil 1130 as a first cross-sectional area (w 1 ⁇ t 1 ) and a second cross-sectional area (w 2 ⁇ t 2 ) are preferably about equal, such as within less than a 2, 5, 10, or 15 percent different.
- the dimension of the first width, w 1 optionally tapers into the dimension of the second width, w 2
- the dimension of the first thickness, t 1 optionally tapers into the second thickness, t 2
- sections of the coil 1130 are welded together, such as where the length of the coil meets the end of the coil.
- the gap 1110 runs above the central metal member 1211 .
- a top half of a first main bending magnet using an optional flattened magnetic coil system is substantially the same as the herein described bottom half, is rotated one hundred eighty degrees about the x-axis and is positioned above the gap 1110 .
- a second coil 1134 is illustrated wrapped between two second yoke members 1292 and around a second metal member 1291 in the second magnet turning section 1020 .
- the second coil 1131 and its matching top half preferably has the design characteristics of the first coil 1132 , described herein.
- the magnet assembly has a first magnet 1210 and a second magnet 1220 .
- a magnetic field induced by coils, described infra runs between the first magnet 1210 to the second magnet 1220 across the gap 1110 .
- Return magnetic fields run through a first yoke 1212 and second yoke 1222 .
- the combined cross-section area of the return yokes roughly approximates the cross-sectional area of the first magnet 1210 or second magnet 1220 .
- the charged particles run through the vacuum tube in the gap 1110 . As illustrated, protons run into FIG.
- the magnetic field is created using windings.
- a first coil is used to form a first winding coil 1250 and a second coil of wire is used to form a second winding coil 1260 .
- Isolating or concentrating gaps 1230 , 1240 such as air gaps, isolate the iron based yokes from the gap 1110 .
- the gap 1110 is approximately flat to yield a uniform magnetic field across the gap 1110 , as described supra.
- the ends of a single bending or turning magnet are preferably beveled.
- Nearly perpendicular or right angle edges of a turning magnet 1010 are represented by dashed lines 1374 , 1384 .
- the dashed lines 1374 , 1384 intersect at a point 1390 beyond the center of the synchrotron 280 .
- the edge of the turning magnet is beveled at angles alpha, ⁇ , and beta, ⁇ , which are angles formed by a first line 1372 , 1382 going from an edge of the turning magnet 1010 and the center 280 and a second line 1374 , 1384 going from the same edge of the turning magnet and the intersecting point 1390 .
- angle alpha is used to describe the effect and the description of angle alpha applies to angle beta, but angle alpha is optionally different from angle beta.
- the angle alpha provides an edge focusing effect. Beveling the edge of the turning magnet 1010 at angle alpha focuses the proton beam.
- Multiple turning magnets provide multiple magnet edges that each have edge focusing effects in the synchrotron 130 . If only one turning magnet is used, then the beam is only focused once for angle alpha or twice for angle alpha and angle beta. However, by using smaller turning magnets, more turning magnets fit into the turning sections 920 of the synchrotron 130 . For example, if four magnets are used in a turning section 920 of the synchrotron, then for a single turning section there are eight possible edge focusing effect surfaces, two edges per magnet. The eight focusing surfaces yield a smaller cross-sectional beam size, which allows the use of a smaller gap.
- edge focusing effects in the turning magnets results in not only a smaller gap 1110 , but also the use of smaller magnets and smaller power supplies.
- a synchrotron 130 having four turning sections 920 where each turning sections has four turning magnets and each turning magnet has two focusing edges a total of thirty-two focusing edges exist for each orbit of the protons in the circulating path of the synchrotron 130 .
- 2, 6, or 8 magnets are used in a given turning section, or if 2, 3, 5, or 6 turning sections are used, then the number of edge focusing surfaces expands or contracts according to equation 7.
- TFE NTS * M NTS * FE M ( eq . ⁇ 7 )
- TFE is the number of total focusing edges
- NTS is the number of turning sections
- M is the number of magnets
- FE is the number of focusing edges.
- the inventors have determined that multiple smaller magnets have benefits over fewer larger magnets. For example, the use of 16 small magnets yields 32 focusing edges whereas the use of 4 larger magnets yields only 8 focusing edges.
- the use of a synchrotron having more focusing edges results in a circulating path of the synchrotron built without the use of focusing quadrupole magnets. All prior art synchrotrons use quadrupoles in the circulating path of the synchrotron. Further, the use of quadrupoles in the circulating path necessitates additional straight sections in the circulating path of the synchrotron. Thus, the use of quadrupoles in the circulating path of a synchrotron results in synchrotrons having larger diameters, larger circulating beam pathlengths, and/or larger circumferences.
- the synchrotron has any combination of:
- gap surface is described in terms of the first turning magnet 1010 , the discussion applies to each of the turning magnets in the synchrotron. Similarly, while the gap 1110 surface is described in terms of the magnetic field incident surface 1270 , the discussion additionally optionally applies to the magnetic field exiting surface 1280 .
- the incident magnetic field surface 1270 of the first magnet 1210 is further described.
- FIG. 12 is not to scale and is illustrative in nature. Local imperfections or unevenness in quality of the finish of the incident surface 1270 results in inhomogeneities or imperfections in the magnetic field applied to the gap 1110 .
- the magnetic field incident surface 1270 and/or exiting surface 1280 of the first magnet 1210 is preferably about flat, such as to within about a zero to three micron finish polish or less preferably to about a ten micron finish polish. By being very flat, the polished surface spreads the unevenness of the applied magnetic field across the gap 1110 .
- the very flat surface such as about 0, 1, 2, 4, 6, 8, 10, 15, or 20 micron finish, allows for a smaller gap size, a smaller applied magnetic field, smaller power supplies, and tighter control of the proton beam cross-sectional area.
- the first magnet 1210 preferably contains an initial cross-sectional distance 1410 of the iron based core.
- the contours of the magnetic field are shaped by the magnets 1210 , 1220 and the yokes 1212 , 1222 .
- the iron based core tapers to a second cross-sectional distance 1420 .
- the shape of the magnetic field vector 1440 is illustrative only. The magnetic field in the magnet preferentially stays in the iron based core as opposed to the gaps 1230 , 1240 .
- the magnetic field concentrates.
- the change in shape of the magnet from the longer distance 1410 to the smaller distance 1420 acts as an amplifier.
- the concentration of the magnetic field is illustrated by representing an initial density of magnetic field vectors 1430 in the initial cross-section 1410 to a concentrated density of magnetic field vectors 1440 in the final cross-section 1420 .
- the concentration of the magnetic field due to the geometry of the turning magnets results in fewer winding coils 1250 , 1260 being required and also a smaller power supply to the coils being required.
- the initial cross-section distance 1410 is about fifteen centimeters and the final cross-section distance 1420 is about ten centimeters.
- the concentration of the magnetic field is about 15/10 or 1.5 times at the incident surface 1270 of the gap 1110 , though the relationship is not linear.
- the taper 1460 has a slope, such as about twenty, forty, or sixty degrees. The concentration of the magnetic field, such as by 1.5 times, leads to a corresponding decrease in power consumption requirements to the magnets.
- the first magnet 1210 preferably contains an initial cross-sectional distance 1410 of the iron based core.
- the contours of the magnetic field are shaped by the magnets 1210 , 1220 and the yokes 1212 , 1222 .
- the core tapers to a second cross-sectional distance 1420 with a smaller angle theta, ⁇ .
- the magnetic field in the magnet preferentially stays in the iron based core as opposed to the gaps 1230 , 1240 .
- the magnetic field concentrates.
- the smaller angle, theta results in a greater amplification of the magnetic field in going from the longer distance 1410 to the smaller distance 1420 .
- the concentration of the magnetic field is illustrated by representing an initial density of magnetic field vectors 1430 in the initial cross-section 1410 to a concentrated density of magnetic field vectors 1440 in the final cross-section 1420 .
- the concentration of the magnetic field due to the geometry of the turning magnets results in fewer winding coils 1250 , 1260 being required and also a smaller power supply to the winding coils 1250 , 1260 being required.
- optional correction coils 1510 , 1520 are illustrated that are used to correct the strength of one or more turning magnets.
- the correction coils 1520 , 1530 supplement the winding coils 1250 , 1260 .
- the correction coils 1510 , 1520 have correction coil power supplies that are separate from winding coil power supplies used with the winding coils 1250 , 1260 .
- the correction coil power supplies typically operate at a fraction of the power required compared to the winding coil power supplies, such as about 1, 2, 3, 5, 7, or 10 percent of the power and more preferably about 1 or 2 percent of the power used with the winding coils 1250 , 1260 .
- the smaller operating power applied to the correction coils 1510 , 1520 allows for more accurate and/or precise control of the correction coils.
- the correction coils are used to adjust for imperfection in the turning magnets.
- separate correction coils are used for each turning magnet allowing individual tuning of the magnetic field for each turning magnet, which eases quality requirements in the manufacture of each turning magnet.
- winding coils 1630 and correction coils 1620 about a plurality of turning magnets 1010 , 1020 in an ion beam turning section 920 is illustrated.
- the winding coils preferably cover 1, 2, or 4 turning magnets.
- One or more high precision magnetic field sensors 1650 are placed into the synchrotron and are used to measure the magnetic field at or near the proton beam path.
- the magnetic sensors are optionally placed between turning magnets and/or within a turning magnet, such as at or near the gap 1110 or at or near the magnet core or yoke.
- the sensors are part of a feedback system to the correction coils, which is optionally run by the main controller.
- the system preferably stabilizes the magnetic field in the synchrotron rather than stabilizing the current applied to the magnets. Stabilization of the magnetic field allows the synchrotron to come to a new energy level quickly. This allows the system to be controlled to an operator or algorithm selected energy level with each pulse of the synchrotron and/or with each breath of the patient.
- the winding and/or correction coils correct one, two, three, or four turning magnets, and preferably correct a magnetic field generated by two turning magnets.
- a correction coil 1640 winds a single magnet section 1010 or a correction coil 1620 winds two or more magnet turning sections 1010 , 1020 .
- a winding or correction coil covering multiple magnets reduces space between magnets as fewer winding or correction coil ends are required, which occupy space. Reduction of space between turning magnets allows operation of the turning magnets with smaller power supplies and optionally without quadrupole magnet focusing sections.
- Space 1160 at the end of a turning magnets 1010 , 1040 is optionally further reduced by changing the cross-sectional shape of the winding coils.
- the cross-sectional dimension is thick and when the winding coils turn at the end of a turning magnet to run axially across the winding coil, then the cross-sectional area of the winding coils is preferably thin.
- the cross-sectional area of winding coils as measured by an m ⁇ n matrix is 3 ⁇ 2 running longitudinally along the turning magnet and 6 ⁇ 1 running axially at the end of the turning magnet, thereby reducing the width of the coils, n, while keeping the number of coils constant.
- the turn from the longitudinal to axial direction of the winding coil approximates ninety degrees by cutting each winding and welding each longitudinal section to the connecting axial section at about a ninety degree angle. The nearly perpendicular weld further reduces space requirements of the turn in the winding coil, which reduces space in circulating orbit not experiencing focusing and turning forces, which reduces the size of the synchrotron.
- the accelerator system 270 such as a radio-frequency (RF) accelerator system, is further described.
- the accelerator includes a series of coils 1710 - 1719 , such as iron or ferrite coils, each circumferentially enclosing the vacuum system 320 through which the proton beam 264 passes in the synchrotron 130 .
- the first coil 1710 is further described.
- a loop of standard wire 1730 completes at least one turn about the first coil 1710 .
- the loop attaches to a microcircuit 1720 .
- an RF synthesizer 1740 which is preferably connected to the main controller 110 , provides a low voltage RF signal that is synchronized to the period of circulation of protons in the proton beam path 264 .
- the RF synthesizer 1740 , microcircuit 1720 , loop 1730 , and coil 1710 combine to provide an accelerating voltage to the protons in the proton beam path 264 .
- the RF synthesizer 1740 sends a signal to the microcircuit 1720 , which amplifies the low voltage RF signal and yields an acceleration voltage, such as about 10 volts.
- the actual acceleration voltage for a single microcircuit/loop/coil combination is about five, ten, fifteen, or twenty volts, but is preferably about ten volts.
- the RF-amplifier microcircuit and accelerating coil are integrated.
- the integrated RF-amplifier microcircuit and accelerating coil presented in FIG. 17B is repeated, as illustrated as the set of coils 1711 - 1719 surrounding the vacuum tube 320 .
- the RF-synthesizer 1740 under main controller 130 direction, sends an RF-signal to the microcircuits 1720 - 1729 connected to coils 1710 - 1719 , respectively.
- Each of the microcircuit/loop/coil combinations generates a proton accelerating voltage, such as about ten volts each.
- a set of five coil combinations generates about fifty volts for proton acceleration.
- about five to twenty microcircuit/loop/coil combinations are used and more preferably about nine or ten microcircuit/loop/coil combinations are used in the accelerator system 270 .
- the RF synthesizer 1740 sends an RF-signal, with a period equal to a period of circulation of a proton about the synchrotron 130 , to a set of ten microcircuit/loop/coil combinations, which results in about 100 volts for acceleration of the protons in the proton beam path 264 .
- the 100 volts is generated at a range of frequencies, such as at about one MHz for a low energy proton beam to about fifteen MHz for a high energy proton beam.
- the RF-signal is optionally set at an integer multiple of a period of circulation of the proton about the synchrotron circulating path.
- Each of the microcircuit/loop/coil combinations are optionally independently controlled in terms of acceleration voltage and frequency.
- the prior art does not use microcircuits integrated with the accelerating coils but rather uses a set of long cables to provide power to a corresponding set of coils.
- the long cables have an impedance/resistance, which is problematic for high frequency RF control.
- the prior art system is not operable at high frequencies, such as above about ten MHz.
- the integrated RF-amplifier microcircuit/accelerating coil system is operable at above about ten MHz and even fifteen MHz where the impedance and/or resistance of the long cables in the prior art systems results in poor control or failure in proton acceleration.
- the long cable system costs about $50,000 and the integrated microcircuit system costs about $1000, which is fifty times less expensive.
- the microcircuit/loop/coil combinations in conjunction with the RF-amplifier system results in a compact low power consumption design allowing production and use of a proton cancer therapy system in a small space, as described supra, and in a cost effective manner.
- a winding coil 1630 that covers two turning magnets 1010 , 1020 is provided.
- a first winding coil 1640 covers two magnets 1010 , 1020 and a second winding coil, not illustrated, covers another two magnets 1030 , 1040 .
- a first correction coil 1640 is illustrated that is used to correct the magnetic field for the first turning magnet 1010 .
- a second correction coil 1620 is illustrated that is used to correct the magnetic field for a winding coil 1630 about two turning magnets. Individual correction coils for each turning magnet are preferred and individual correction coils yield the most precise and/or accurate magnetic field in each turning section.
- an individual correction coil is preferably used to compensate for imperfections in the individual magnet of a given turning section.
- corresponding magnetic fields are individually adjustable in a series of feedback loops, via a magnetic field monitoring system, as an independent coil is used for each turning section.
- a multiple magnet correction coil is used to correct the magnetic field for a plurality of turning section magnets.
- FIG. 18A an exemplary proton beam extraction process 1800 from the synchrotron 130 is illustrated.
- FIG. 18 removes elements represented in FIG. 2 , such as the turning magnets, which allows for greater clarity of presentation of the proton beam path as a function of time.
- protons are extracted from the synchrotron 130 by slowing the protons.
- the protons were initially accelerated in a circulating path 264 , which is maintained with a plurality of main bending magnets 250 .
- the circulating path is referred to herein as an original central beamline 264 .
- the protons repeatedly cycle around a central point in the synchrotron 280 .
- the proton path traverses through a radio frequency (RF) cavity system 1910 .
- RF radio frequency
- the first blade 1912 and second blade 1914 are referred to herein as a first pair of blades.
- an RF voltage is applied across the first pair of blades, where the first blade 1912 of the first pair of blades is on one side of the circulating proton beam path 264 and the second blade 1914 of the first pair of blades is on an opposite side of the circulating proton beam path 264 .
- the applied RF field applies energy to the circulating charged-particle beam.
- the applied RF field alters the orbiting or circulating beam path slightly of the protons from the original central beamline 264 to an altered circulating beam path 265 .
- the RF field further moves the protons off of the original proton beamline 264 .
- the altered beamline is slightly elliptical.
- the applied RF field is timed to apply outward or inward movement to a given band of protons circulating in the synchrotron accelerator.
- Each orbit of the protons is slightly more off axis compared to the original circulating beam path 264 .
- Successive passes of the protons through the RF cavity system are forced further and further from the original central beamline 264 by altering the direction and/or intensity of the RF field with each successive pass of the proton beam through the RF field.
- the RF voltage is frequency modulated at a frequency about equal to the period of one proton cycling around the synchrotron for one revolution or at a frequency than is an integral multiplier of the period of one proton cycling about the synchrotron.
- the applied RF frequency modulated voltage excites a betatron oscillation.
- the oscillation is a sine wave motion of the protons.
- the process of timing the RF field to a given proton beam within the RF cavity system is repeated thousands of times with each successive pass of the protons being moved approximately one micrometer further off of the original central beamline 264 . For clarity, the approximately 1000 changing beam paths with each successive path of a given band of protons through the RF field are illustrated as the altered beam path 265 .
- the altered circulating beam path 265 touches and/or traverses a material 1930 , such as a foil or a sheet of foil.
- the foil is preferably a lightweight material, such as beryllium, a lithium hydride, a carbon sheet, or a material having low nuclear charge components.
- a material of low nuclear charge is a material composed of atoms consisting essentially of atoms having six or fewer protons.
- the foil is preferably about 10 to 150 microns thick, is more preferably about 30 to 100 microns thick, and is still more preferably about 40 to 60 microns thick. In one example, the foil is beryllium with a thickness of about 50 microns.
- the reduced radius of curvature 266 path is also referred to herein as a path having a smaller diameter of trajectory or a path having protons with reduced energy.
- the reduced radius of curvature 266 is typically about two millimeters less than a radius of curvature of the last pass of the protons along the altered proton beam path 265 .
- the thickness of the material 1930 is optionally adjusted to created a change in the radius of curvature, such as about 1 ⁇ 2, 1, 2, 3, or 4 mm less than the last pass of the protons 265 or original radius of curvature 264 .
- Protons moving with the smaller radius of curvature travel between a second pair of blades.
- the second pair of blades is physically distinct and/or is separated from the first pair of blades.
- one of the first pair of blades is also a member of the second pair of blades.
- the second pair of blades is the second blade 1914 and a third blade 1916 in the RF cavity system 1910 .
- a high voltage DC signal such as about 1 to 5 kV, is then applied across the second pair of blades, which directs the protons out of the synchrotron through an extraction magnet 292 , such as a Lambertson extraction magnet, into a transport path 268 .
- an extraction magnet 292 such as a Lambertson extraction magnet
- the material 1930 is a set of foils with different foils having different thicknesses.
- a first foil 1932 has a thickness less than a thickness of a second foil 1934 and the second foil 1934 has a thickness less than a thickness of a third foil 1936 .
- Each of the foils 1932 , 1934 , 1936 optionally has any of the properties of the material 1930 , described supra.
- the energy of the charged particles in the altered circulating beam path 265 is preferably in the range of about 70 to 250 MeV.
- a thinner extraction foil is used in the extraction system with lower energy charged particles and a thicker foil is used in the extraction system 1800 with higher energy charged particles.
- the first foil 1932 having a thickness of about 30 to 70 micrometers and preferably about 50 micrometers is used in the extraction of charged particles having energy of about 70 to 150 MeV
- the second foil 1934 having a thickness of about 60 to 140 micrometers and preferably about 100 micrometers is used in the extraction of charged particles having energy of about 150 to 200 MeV
- the third foil having a thickness of about 150 to 250 micrometers and preferably about 200 micrometers is used in the extraction of charged particles having energy of about 70 to 150 MeV.
- Any number of foils are optionally used.
- various members of the set of foils have varying densities.
- a second foil has a density about 110, 120, 130, 150, 200, or 300 percent of a density of a first foil.
- the denser foil is used in extraction of higher energy charged particles.
- the foils vary in both density and thickness.
- each of the foils 1932 , 1934 , 1936 is optionally moved toward or away from the circulating charged particle beam path 264 prior to and/or in the process of charged particle extraction, such as with one or more actuators.
- the foil actuated toward the circulating beam path 264 is selected to have a larger thickness as a function of higher energy of the charged particles in the beam path, as described infra.
- a thinner foil such as the first foil 1932
- a medium thickness foil such as the second foil 1934
- a thicker foil such as the third foil 1936
- a thicker foil is used for higher energy levels charged particles, such as depicted by E 3 to traverse a larger distance through a patient 2130 or a larger distance through tissue to the tumor 2120 .
- Control of acceleration of the charged particle beam path in the synchrotron with the accelerator and/or applied fields of the turning magnets in combination with the above described extraction system allows for control of the intensity of the extracted proton beam, where intensity is a proton flux per unit time or the number of protons extracted as a function of time. For example, when a current is measured beyond a threshold, the RF field modulation in the RF cavity system is terminated or reinitiated to establish a subsequent cycle of proton beam extraction. This process is repeated to yield many cycles of proton beam extraction from the synchrotron accelerator.
- the material 1930 is mechanically moved to the circulating charged particles.
- the material 1930 is mechanically or electromechanically translated into the path of the circulating charged particles to induce the extraction process, described supra.
- the extraction system does not depend on any change in magnetic field properties, it allows the synchrotron to continue to operate in acceleration or deceleration mode during the extraction process. Stated differently, the extraction process does not interfere with synchrotron acceleration.
- traditional extraction systems introduce a new magnetic field, such as via a hexapole, during the extraction process. More particularly, traditional synchrotrons have a magnet, such as a hexapole magnet, that is off during an acceleration stage. During the extraction phase, the hexapole magnetic field is introduced to the circulating path of the synchrotron. The introduction of the magnetic field necessitates two distinct modes, an acceleration mode and an extraction mode, which are mutually exclusive in time. The herein described system allows for acceleration and/or deceleration of the proton during the extraction step without the use of a newly introduced magnetic field, such as by a hexapole magnet.
- Control of applied field such as a radio-frequency (RF) field, frequency and magnitude in the RF cavity system 1910 allows for intensity control of the extracted proton beam, where intensity is extracted proton flux per unit time or the number of protons extracted as a function of time.
- RF radio-frequency
- an intensity control system 1900 is illustrated.
- an intensity control feedback loop is added to the extraction system, described supra.
- the resulting current is converted to a voltage and is used as part of a ion beam intensity monitoring system or as part of an ion beam feedback loop for controlling beam intensity.
- the voltage is optionally measured and sent to the main controller 110 or to an intensity controller subsystem 1940 , which is preferably in communication or under the direction of the main controller 110 .
- protons in the charged particle beam path pass through the material 1930 , some of the protons lose a small fraction of their energy, such as about one-tenth of a percent, which results in a secondary electron. That is, protons in the charged particle beam push some electrons when passing through material 1930 giving the electrons enough energy to cause secondary emission.
- the resulting electron flow results in a current or signal that is proportional to the number of protons going through the target material 1930 .
- the resulting current is preferably converted to voltage and amplified.
- the resulting signal is referred to as a measured intensity signal.
- the amplified signal or measured intensity signal resulting from the protons passing through the material 1930 is optionally used in monitoring the intensity of the extracted protons and is preferably used in controlling the intensity of the extracted protons.
- the measured intensity signal is compared to a goal signal, which is predetermined in an irradiation of the tumor plan.
- the difference between the measured intensity signal and the planned for goal signal is calculated.
- the difference is used as a control to the RF generator.
- the measured flow of current resulting from the protons passing through the material 1930 is used as a control in the RF generator to increase or decrease the number of protons undergoing betatron oscillation and striking the material 1930 .
- the voltage determined off of the material 1930 is used as a measure of the orbital path and is used as a feedback control to control the RF cavity system.
- the intensity controller subsystem 1940 preferably additionally receives input from: (1) a detector 1950 , which provides a reading of the actual intensity of the proton beam and (2) an irradiation plan 1960 .
- the irradiation plan provides the desired intensity of the proton beam for each x, y, energy, and/or rotational position of the patient/tumor as a function of time.
- the intensity controller 1940 receives the desired intensity from the irradiation plan 1950 , the actual intensity from the detector 1950 and/or a measure of intensity from the material 1930 , and adjusts the radio-frequency field in the RF cavity system 1910 to yield an intensity of the proton beam that matches the desired intensity from the irradiation plan 1960 .
- the photons striking the material 1930 is a step in the extraction of the protons from the synchrotron 130 .
- the measured intensity signal is used to change the number of protons per unit time being extracted, which is referred to as intensity of the proton beam.
- the intensity of the proton beam is thus under algorithm control. Further, the intensity of the proton beam is controlled separately from the velocity of the protons in the synchrotron 130 . Hence, intensity of the protons extracted and the energy of the protons extracted are independently variable.
- protons initially move at an equilibrium trajectory in the synchrotron 130 .
- An RF field is used to excite the protons into a betatron oscillation.
- the frequency of the protons orbit is about 10 MHz.
- the first protons hit an outer edge of the target material 130 .
- the specific frequency is dependent upon the period of the orbit.
- the protons push electrons through the foil to produce a current.
- the current is converted to voltage and amplified to yield a measured intensity signal.
- the measured intensity signal is used as a feedback input to control the applied RF magnitude, RF frequency, or RF field.
- the measured intensity signal is compared to a target signal and a measure of the difference between the measured intensity signal and target signal is used to adjust the applied RF field in the RF cavity system 1910 in the extraction system to control the intensity of the protons in the extraction step.
- the signal resulting from the protons striking and/or passing through the material 130 is used as an input in RF field modulation.
- An increase in the magnitude of the RF modulation results in protons hitting the foil or material 130 sooner.
- By increasing the RF more protons are pushed into the foil, which results in an increased intensity, or more protons per unit time, of protons extracted from the synchrotron 130 .
- a detector 1950 external to the synchrotron 130 is used to determine the flux of protons extracted from the synchrotron and a signal from the external detector is used to alter the RF field or RF modulation in the RF cavity system 1910 .
- the external detector generates an external signal, which is used in a manner similar to the measured intensity signal, described in the preceding paragraphs.
- an algorithm or irradiation plan 1960 is used as an input to the intensity controller 1940 , which controls the RF field modulation by directing the RF signal in the betatron oscillation generation in the RF cavity system 1910 .
- the irradiation plan 1960 preferably includes the desired intensity of the charged particle beam as a function of time, energy of the charged particle beam as a function of time, for each patient rotation position, and/or for each x-, y-position of the charged particle beam.
- the RF field modulation in the RF cavity system is terminated or reinitiated to establish a subsequent cycle of proton beam extraction. This process is repeated to yield many cycles of proton beam extraction from the synchrotron accelerator.
- intensity modulation of the extracted proton beam is controlled by the main controller 110 .
- the main controller 110 optionally and/or additionally controls timing of extraction of the charged particle beam and energy of the extracted proton beam.
- the benefits of the system include a multi-dimensional scanning system.
- the system allows independence in: (1) energy of the protons extracted and (2) intensity of the protons extracted. That is, energy of the protons extracted is controlled by an energy control system and an intensity control system controls the intensity of the extracted protons.
- the energy control system and intensity control system are optionally independently controlled.
- the main controller 110 controls the energy control system and the main controller 110 simultaneously controls the intensity control system to yield an extracted proton beam with controlled energy and controlled intensity where the controlled energy and controlled intensity are independently variable.
- the irradiation spot hitting the tumor is under independent control of:
- the patient is optionally independently translated and/or rotated relative to a translational axis of the proton beam at the same time.
- a nozzle 2010 provides an outlet for the second reduced pressure vacuum system initiating at the foil 395 of the tandem accelerator 390 and running through the synchrotron 130 to a nozzle foil 2020 covering the end of the nozzle 2010 .
- the nozzle expands in x-, y-cross-sectional area along the z-axis of the proton beam path 268 to allow the proton beam 268 to be scanned along the x- and y-axes by the vertical control element 142 and horizontal control element 144 , respectively.
- the nozzle foil 2020 is preferably mechanically supported by the outer edges of an exit port of the nozzle 2010 .
- a nozzle foil 2020 is a sheet of about 0.1 inch thick aluminum foil.
- the nozzle foil separates atmosphere pressures on the patient side of the nozzle foil 2020 from the low pressure region, such as about 10 ⁇ 5 to 10 ⁇ 7 torr region, on the synchrotron 130 side of the nozzle foil 2020 .
- the low pressure region is maintained to reduce scattering of the proton beam 264 , 268 .
- the proton beam verification system 2000 is a system that allows for monitoring of the actual proton beam position 268 , 269 in real-time without destruction of the proton beam.
- the proton beam verification system 2000 preferably includes a proton beam position verification layer 2030 , which is also referred to herein as a coating, luminescent, fluorescent, phosphorescent, radiance, or viewing layer.
- the verification layer or coating layer 2030 is preferably a coating or thin layer substantially in contact with an inside surface of the nozzle foil 2020 , where the inside surface is on the synchrotron side of the nozzle foil 2020 .
- the verification layer or coating layer 2030 is substantially in contact with an outer surface of the nozzle foil 2020 , where the outer surface is on the patient treatment side of the nozzle foil 2020 .
- the nozzle foil 2020 provides a substrate surface for coating by the coating layer.
- a binding layer is located between the coating layer 2030 and the nozzle foil 2020 .
- a separate coating layer support element, on which the coating 2030 is mounted, is placed anywhere in the proton beam path 268 .
- the coating 2030 yields a measurable spectroscopic response, spatially viewable by a position dosage detector 2040 or dosage detector camera, as a result of transmission by the proton beam 268 .
- the coating 2030 is preferably a phosphor, but is optionally any material that is viewable or imaged by a detector where the material changes spectroscopically as a result of the proton beam path 268 hitting or transmitting through the coating 2030 .
- a detector or camera views the coating layer 2030 and determines the current position of the charged particle beam 269 by the spectroscopic differences resulting from protons passing through the coating layer.
- the position dosage detector 2040 views the coating surface 2030 as the proton beam 268 is being scanned by the horizontal 144 and vertical 142 beam position control elements during treatment of the tumor 2120 .
- the position dosage detector 2040 is optionally used to determine radiation dosage as a function of tumor position, such as the x-, y-position.
- the position dosage detector 2040 views the current position of the charged particle beam 269 as measured by spectroscopic response.
- the coating layer 2030 is preferably a phosphor or luminescent material that glows or emits photons for a short period of time, such as less than 5 seconds for a 50% intensity, as a result of excitation by the proton beam 268 .
- a plurality of cameras or detector are used, where each detector views all or a portion of the coating layer 2030 .
- two detectors are used where a first detector views a first half of the coating layer and the second detector views a second half of the coating layer.
- at least a portion of the position dosage detector 2040 is mounted into the nozzle 2010 to view the proton beam position after passing through the first axis and second axis controllers 142 , 144 .
- the coating layer 2030 is positioned in the proton beam path 268 in a position prior to the protons striking the patient 2130 .
- a scintillation plate 2050 is optionally positioned in the charged particle beam path, such as within the vacuum chamber 320 .
- the scintillation plate 2050 is thin to allow transmission of the charged particles, such as less than about 1, 2, 3, 5, 10, 20, 50, or 100 micrometers.
- the scintillation plate is about 2.5 micrometers thick.
- a scintillation intensity detector 2054 views photons generated by the charged particles striking the scintillation plate 2050 and generates a corresponding scintillation intensity. The scintillation intensity is proportional or related to the charged particle beam intensity.
- One or more scintillation optics 2052 optionally optically couple the scintillation plate 2050 to the scintillation detector 2054 .
- the scintillation plate 2050 /scintillation detector 2054 which measures charged particle beam intensity, is used in combination with the coating layer 2030 /position dosage detector 2040 , which measures positional dosage of the charge particle beam.
- output from one or both of the position dosage detector 2040 and the scintillation detector 2054 is provided to the main controller 110 , such as for feedback control of the charged particle beam generation, energy, intensity, and/or position.
- the main controller 130 connected to the camera or position dosage detector 2040 output, compares the actual charged particle beam position 269 with the planned proton beam position and/or a calibration reference to determine if the actual charged particle beam position 269 is within tolerance.
- the proton beam verification system 2000 preferably is used in at least two phases, a calibration phase and a proton beam treatment phase.
- the calibration phase is used to correlate, as a function of x-, y-position of the glowing response the actual x-, y-position of the proton beam at the patient interface.
- the proton beam position is monitored and compared to the calibration and/or treatment plan to verify accurate proton delivery to the tumor 2120 and/or as a proton beam shutoff safety indicator.
- the patient is preferably positioned on or within a patient positioning system 2110 that translates, rotates, and/or positions the patient 2130 .
- the patient positioning system 2110 is used to translate the patient and/or rotate the patient into a zone where the proton beam or charged particle beam may scan the tumor using a scanning system 140 or proton targeting system, described infra.
- the patient positioning system 2110 performs large movements of the patient to place the tumor near the center of a proton beam path 268 and the proton scanning or targeting system 140 performs fine movements of the momentary beam position 269 in targeting the tumor 2120 .
- 21A shows the momentary proton beam position 269 and a range of scannable positions 2140 using the proton scanning or targeting system 140 , where the scannable positions 2140 are about the tumor 2120 of the patient 2130 .
- the scannable positions are scanned along the x- and y-axes; however, scanning is optionally simultaneously performed along the z-axis as described infra.
- This illustratively shows that the y-axis movement of the patient occurs on a scale of the body, such as adjustment of about 1, 2, 3, or 4 feet, while the scannable region of the proton beam 268 covers a portion of the body, such as a region of about 1, 2, 4, 6, 8, 10, or 12 inches.
- the patient positioning system and its rotation and/or translation of the patient combines with the proton targeting system to yield precise and/or accurate delivery of the protons to the tumor.
- the patient positioning system 2110 optionally includes a bottom unit 2112 and a top unit 2114 , such as discs or a platform.
- the patient positioning system 2110 is preferably y-axis adjustable 2116 to allow vertical shifting of the patient relative to the proton therapy beam 268 .
- the vertical motion of the patient positioning system 2110 is about 10, 20, 30, or 50 centimeters per minute.
- the patient positioning system 2110 is also preferably rotatable 2117 about a rotation axis, such as about the y-axis running through the center of the bottom unit 2112 or about a y-axis running through the tumor 2120 , to allow rotational control and positioning of the patient relative to the proton beam path 268 .
- the rotational motion of the patient positioning system 2110 is about 360 degrees per minute.
- the patient positioning system 2110 rotates about 45, 90, or 180 degrees.
- the patient positioning system 2110 rotates at a rate of about 45, 90, 180, 360, 720, or 1080 degrees per minute.
- the rotation of the positioning unit 2117 is illustrated about the rotation axis at two distinct times, t 1 and t 2 .
- Protons are optionally delivered to the tumor 2120 at n times where each of the n times represent a different relative direction of the incident proton beam 269 hitting the patient 2130 due to rotation of the patient 2117 about the rotation axis.
- any of the semi-vertical, sitting, or laying patient positioning embodiments described, infra are optionally vertically translatable along the y-axis or rotatable about the rotation or y-axis.
- the top and bottom units 2112 , 2114 move together, such that they rotate at the same rates and translate in position at the same rates.
- the top and bottom units 2112 , 2114 are independently adjustable along the y-axis to allow a difference in distance between the top and bottom units 2112 , 2114 .
- Motors, power supplies, and mechanical assemblies for moving the top and bottom units 2112 , 2114 are preferably located out of the proton beam path 269 , such as below the bottom unit 2112 and/or above the top unit 2114 . This is preferable as the patient positioning system 2110 is preferably rotatable about 360 degrees and the motors, power supplies, and mechanical assemblies interfere with the protons if positioned in the proton beam path 269
- a common X-ray distribution profile 2210 , a proton ion distribution profile 2220 , and a carbon ion distribution profile 2310 is presented.
- X-rays deposit their highest dose near the surface of the targeted tissue and then deposited doses exponentially decrease as a function of tissue depth.
- the deposition of X-ray energy near the surface is non-ideal for tumors located deep within the body, which is usually the case, as excessive damage is done to the soft tissue layers surrounding the tumor 2120 .
- protons deposit most of their energy near the end of the flight trajectory as the energy loss per unit path of the absorber traversed by a proton increases with decreasing particle velocity, giving rise to a sharp maximum in ionization near the end of the range, referred to herein as the Bragg peak. Furthermore, since the flight trajectory of the protons is variable by increasing or decreasing the initial kinetic energy or initial velocity of the proton, then the peak corresponding to maximum energy is movable within the tissue. Thus z-axis control of the proton depth of penetration is allowed by the acceleration/extraction process, described supra.
- a radiation oncologist can optimize dosage to the tumor 2120 while minimizing dosage to surrounding normal tissues.
- the use of heavier ions, such as carbon ions and/or C 6 + yields: (1) a smaller dose delivery percentage in lead-in healthy tissue, (2) a sharper in tumor dose delivery profile, and/or (3) a more rapid fall off in dose delivery at the Bragg limit due to atomic cross-sectional area.
- the term ingress refers to a place charged particles enter into the patient 2130 or a place of charged particles entering the tumor 2120 .
- the ingress region of the Bragg energy profile refers to the relatively flat dose delivery portion at shallow depths of the Bragg energy profile.
- proximal or the clause proximal region refer to the shallow depth region of the tissue that receives the relatively flat radiation dose delivery portion of the delivered Bragg profile energy.
- distal refers to the back portion of the tumor located furthest away from the point of origin where the charged particles enter the tumor. In terms of the Bragg energy profile, the Bragg peak is at the distal point of the profile.
- ventral refers to the front of the patient and the term dorsal refers to the back of the patient.
- the protons ingress through the healthy tissue and if delivered to the far side of the tumor, the Bragg peak occurs at the distal side of the tumor.
- the distal point of the Bragg energy profile is the region of furthest penetration into the tumor.
- the Bragg peak energy profile shows that protons deliver their energy across the entire length of the body penetrated by the proton up to a maximum penetration depth.
- energy is being delivered, in the proximal portion of the Bragg peak energy profile, to healthy tissue, bone, and other body constituents before the proton beam hits the tumor. It follows that the shorter the pathlength in the body prior to the tumor, the higher the efficiency of proton delivery efficiency, where proton delivery efficiency is a measure of how much energy is delivered to the tumor relative to healthy portions of the patient.
- proton delivery efficiency examples include: (1) a ratio of proton energy delivered to the tumor over proton energy delivered to non-tumor tissue; (2) pathlength of protons in the tumor versus pathlength in the non-tumor tissue; and/or (3) damage to a tumor compared to damage to healthy body parts. Any of these measures are optionally weighted by damage to sensitive tissue, such as a nervous system element, heart, brain, or other organ.
- a tumor near the heart would at times be treated with protons running through the head-to-heart path, leg-to-heart path, or hip-to-heart path, which are all inefficient compared to a patient in a sitting or semi-vertical position where the protons are all delivered through a shorter chest-to-heart; side-of-body-to-heart, or back-to-heart path.
- a shorter pathlength through the body to a tumor is provided to a tumor located in the torso or head, which results in a higher or better proton delivery efficiency.
- time efficiency or synchrotron use efficiency which is a fraction of time that the charged particle beam apparatus is in a tumor treating operation mode.
- x-axis scanning of the proton beam is illustrated while z-axis energy of the proton beam undergoes controlled variation 2300 to allow irradiation of slices of the tumor 2120 .
- the simultaneous y-axis scanning that is performed is not illustrated.
- irradiation is commencing with the momentary proton beam position 269 at the start of a first slice.
- the momentary proton beam position is at the end of the first slice.
- the proton beam energy is preferably continuously controlled and changed according to the tissue mass and density in front of the tumor 2120 .
- the variation of the proton beam energy to account for tissue density thus allows the beam stopping point, or Bragg peak, to remain inside the tissue slice.
- the variation of the proton beam energy during scanning or during x-, y-axes scanning is possible due to the acceleration/extraction techniques, described supra, which allow for acceleration of the proton beam during extraction.
- FIGS. 23C, 23D, and 23E show the momentary proton beam position in the middle of the second slice, two-thirds of the way through a third slice, and after finalizing irradiation from a given direction, respectively.
- controlled, accurate, and precise delivery of proton irradiation energy to the tumor 2120 , to a designated tumor subsection, or to a tumor layer is achieved.
- Efficiency of deposition of proton energy to tumor as defined as the ratio of the proton irradiation energy delivered to the tumor relative to the proton irradiation energy delivered to the healthy tissue is further described infra.
- Multi-field irradiation is proton beam irradiation from a plurality of entry points into the body.
- the patient 2130 is rotated and the radiation source point is held constant.
- the patient 2130 is rotated through 360 degrees and proton therapy is applied from a multitude of angles resulting in the ingress or proximal radiation being circumferentially spread about the tumor yielding enhanced proton irradiation efficiency.
- the body is rotated into greater than 3, 5, 10, 15, 20, 25, 30, or 35 positions and proton irradiation occurs with each rotation position. Rotation of the patient is preferably performed using the patient positioning system 2110 and/or the bottom unit 2112 or disc, described supra.
- Rotation of the patient 2130 while keeping the delivery proton beam 268 in a relatively fixed orientation allows irradiation of the tumor 2120 from multiple directions without use of a new collimator for each direction. Further, as no new setup is required for each rotation position of the patient 2130 , the system allows the tumor 2120 to be treated from multiple directions without reseating or positioning the patient, thereby minimizing tumor 2120 regeneration time, increasing the synchrotrons efficiency, and increasing patient throughput.
- the patient is optionally centered on the bottom unit 2112 or the tumor 2120 is optionally centered on the bottom unit 2112 . If the patient is centered on the bottom unit 2112 , then the first axis control element 142 and second axis control element 144 are programmed to compensate for the off central axis of rotation position variation of the tumor 2120 .
- FIGS. 24 A-E an example of multi-field irradiation 2400 is presented.
- five patient rotation positions are illustrated; however, the five rotation positions are discrete rotation positions of about thirty-six rotation positions, where the body is rotated about ten degrees with each position.
- FIG. 24A a range of irradiation beam positions 269 is illustrated from a first body rotation position, illustrated as the patient 2130 facing the proton irradiation beam where the tumor receives the bulk of the Bragg profile energy while a first healthy volume 2411 is irradiated by the less intense ingress portion of the Bragg profile energy.
- the patient 2130 is rotated about forty degrees and the irradiation is repeated.
- the tumor 2120 again receives the bulk of the irradiation energy and a second healthy tissue volume 2412 receives the smaller ingress portion of the Bragg profile energy.
- the patient 2130 is rotated a total of about 90, 130, and 180 degrees, respectively.
- the tumor 2120 receives the bulk of the irradiation energy and the third, fourth, and fifth healthy tissue volumes 2413 , 2414 , 1415 receive the smaller ingress portion of the Bragg peak energy, respectively.
- the rotation of the patient during proton therapy results in the proximal or ingress energy of the delivered proton energy to be distributed about the tumor 2120 , such as to regions one to five 2411 - 2415 , while along a given axis, at least about 75, 80, 85, 90, or 95 percent of the energy is delivered to the tumor 2120 .
- all or part of the tumor is irradiated.
- a distal section or distal slice of the tumor 2120 is irradiated with each rotation position, where the distal section is a section furthest from the entry point of the proton beam into the patient 2130 .
- the distal section is the dorsal side of the tumor when the patient 2130 is facing the proton beam and the distal section is the ventral side of the tumor when the patient 2130 is facing away from the proton beam.
- a second example of multi-field irradiation 2500 is presented where the proton source is stationary and the patient 2130 is rotated.
- the stationary but scanning proton beam path 269 is illustrated as entering the patient 2130 from varying sides at times t 1 , t 2 , t 3 , . . . , t n , t n+1 as the patient is rotated.
- t 1 the ingress side or proximal region of the Bragg peak profile hits a first area, A 1 .
- the proximal end of the Bragg peak profile refers to the relatively shallow depths of tissue where Bragg energy profile energy delivery is relatively flat.
- the patient is rotated and the proton beam path is illustrated at a second time, t 2 , where the ingress energy of the Bragg energy profile hits a second area, A 2 .
- the low radiation dosage of the ingress region of the Bragg profile energy is delivered to the second area.
- the ingress end of the Bragg energy profile hits a third area, A 3 .
- This rotation and irradiation process is repeated n times, where n is a positive number greater than five and preferably greater than about 10, 20, 30, 100, or 300.
- n is a positive number greater than five and preferably greater than about 10, 20, 30, 100, or 300.
- Irradiation is preferably suspended until the sensitive body constituent is rotated out of the scanning proton beam 269 path. Irradiation is resumed at a time, t n+1 , after the sensitive body constituent 2150 is rotated out of the proton beam path. In this manner:
- charged particle or proton delivery efficiency is radiation dose delivered to the tumor compared to radiation dose delivered to the healthy regions of the patient.
- a proton delivery enhancement method is described where proton delivery efficiency is enhanced, optimized, or maximized.
- multi-field irradiation is used to deliver protons to the tumor from a multitude of rotational directions. From each direction, the energy of the protons is adjusted to target the distal portion of the tumor, where the distal portion of the tumor is the volume of the tumor furthest from the entry point of the proton beam into the body.
- the process is described using an example where the outer edges of the tumor are initially irradiated using distally applied radiation through a multitude of rotational positions, such as through 360 degrees. This results in a symbolic or calculated remaining smaller tumor for irradiation. The process is then repeated as many times as necessary on the smaller tumor. However, the presentation is for clarity. In actuality, irradiation from a given rotational angle is performed once with z-axis proton beam energy and intensity being adjusted for the calculated smaller inner tumors during x- and y-axis scanning.
- protons are delivered to the tumor 2120 of the patient 2130 from a first direction.
- the proton beam is scanned 269 across the tumor.
- the energy of the proton beam is adjusted to allow the Bragg peak energy to target the distal portion of the tumor.
- distal refers to the back portion of the tumor located furthest away from where the charged particles enter the tumor.
- the proton beam is scanned along an x-axis across the patient.
- This process allows the Bragg peak energy to fall within the tumor, for the middle area of the Bragg peak profile to fall in the middle and proximal portion of the tumor, and for the small intensity ingress portion of the Bragg peak to hit healthy tissue. In this manner, the maximum radiation dose is delivered to the tumor or the proton dose efficiency is maximized for the first rotational direction.
- the patient After irradiation from the first rotational position, the patient is rotated to a new rotational position. Referring now to FIG. 26B , the scanning of the proton beam is repeated. Again, the distal portion of the tumor is targeted with adjustment of the proton beam energy to target the Bragg peak energy to the distal portion of the tumor. Naturally, the distal portion of the tumor for the second rotational position is different from the distal portion of the tumor for the first rotational position. Referring now to FIG. 26C , the process of rotating the patient and then irradiating the new distal portion of the tumor is further illustrated at an n th rotational position. Preferably, the process of rotating the patient and scanning along the x- and y-axes with the Z-axes energy targeting the new distal portion of the tumor is repeated, such as with more than 5, 10, 20, or 30 rotational positions or with about 36 rotational positions.
- FIGS. 26A-C and FIG. 26 E show the proton beam as having moved, but in actuality, the proton beam is stationary and the patient is rotated, such as via use of rotating the bottom unit 2112 of the patient positioning system 2110 .
- FIGS. 26A-C and FIG. 26E show the proton beam being scanned across the tumor along the x-axis. Though not illustrated for clarity, the proton beam is additionally scanned up and down the tumor along the y-axis of the patient. Combined, the distal portion or volume of the tumor is irradiated along the x- and y-axes with adjustment of the z-axis energy level of the proton beam.
- the tumor is scanned along the x-axis and the scanning is repeated along the x-axis for multiple y-axis positions.
- the tumor is scanned along the y-axis and the scanning is repeated along the y-axis for multiple x-axis positions.
- the tumor is scanned by simultaneously adjusting the x- and y-axes so that the distal portion of the tumor is targeted. In all of these cases, the z-axis or energy of the proton beam is adjusted along the contour of the distal portion of the tumor to target the Bragg peak energy to the distal portion of the tumor.
- the outer tumor perimeter 2122 tumor has been strongly irradiated with peak Bragg profile energy
- the middle of the Bragg peak energy profile energy has been delivered along an inner edge of the heavily irradiated tumor perimeter 2122
- smaller dosages from the ingress portion of the Bragg energy profile are distributed throughout the tumor and into some healthy tissue.
- the delivered dosages or accumulated radiation flux levels are illustrated in a cross-sectional area of the tumor 2120 using an iso-line plot.
- a smaller inner tumor is defined, where the inner tumor is already partially irradiated.
- the smaller inner tumor is indicated by the dashed line 2630 .
- the above process of irradiating the tumor is repeated for the newly defined smaller tumor.
- the proton dosages to the outer or distal portions of the smaller tumor are adjusted to account for the dosages delivered from other rotational positions.
- a yet smaller third tumor is defined. The process is repeated until the entire tumor is irradiated at the prescribed or defined dosage.
- the patient is preferably only rotated to each rotational position once.
- the patient is rotationally positioned, such as through 360 degrees, and the distal portion of the newest smaller tumor is targeted as described, supra.
- the irradiation dosage to be delivered to the second smaller tumor and each subsequently smaller tumor is known a-priori.
- the smaller tumor or multiple progressively smaller tumors are optionally targeted so that the patient is only rotated to the multiple rotational irradiation positions once.
- the goal is to deliver a treatment dosage to each position of the tumor, to preferably not exceed the treatment dosage to any position of the tumor, to minimize ingress radiation dosage to healthy tissue, to circumferentially distribute ingress radiation hitting the healthy tissue, and to further minimize ingress radiation dosage to sensitive areas.
- the Bragg energy profile is known, it is possible to calculated the optimal intensity and energy of the proton beam for each rotational position and for each x- and y-axis scanning position. These calculation result in slightly less than threshold radiation dosage to be delivered to the distal portion of the tumor for each rotational position as the ingress dose energy from other positions bring the total dose energy for the targeted position up to the threshold delivery dose.
- the intensity of the proton beam is preferably adjusted to account for the cross-sectional distance or density of the healthy tissue.
- An example is used for clarity.
- the intensity of the proton beam is preferably increased as relatively less energy is delivered by the ingress portion of the Bragg profile to the healthy tissue.
- the intensity of the proton beam is preferably decreased as a greater fraction the proton dose is delivered to the healthy tissue from this orientation.
- the efficiency of proton dose delivery to the tumor is calculated.
- the intensity of the proton beam is made proportional to the calculated efficiency.
- the intensity is increased and vise-versa.
- the efficiency of irradiating the distal portion by going through the length of the tumor is higher than irradiating a distal region of the tumor by going across the tumor with the Bragg energy distribution.
- the efficiency of radiation dose delivery to the tumor is maximized. More particularly, the ratio of radiation dose delivered to the tumor versus the radiation dose delivered to surrounding healthy tissue approaches a maximum. Further, integrated radiation dose delivery to each x, y, and z-axis volume of the tumor as a result of irradiation from multiple rotation directions is at or near the preferred dose level. Still further, ingress radiation dose delivery to healthy tissue is circumferentially distributed about the tumor via use of multi-field irradiation where radiation is delivered from a plurality of directions into the body, such as more than 5, 10, 20, or 30 directions.
- the particle therapy system with a synchrotron ring diameter of less than six meters includes ability to:
- the main controller 110 rotationally positions the patient 2130 and subsequently irradiates the tumor 2120 . The process is repeated until a multi-field irradiation plan is complete.
- the main controller 110 simultaneously rotates and irradiates the tumor 2120 within the patient 2130 until the multi-field irradiation plan is complete. More particularly, the proton beam irradiation occurs while the patient 2130 is being rotated.
- the 3-dimensional scanning system of the proton spot focal point is preferably combined with a rotation/raster method.
- the method includes layer wise tumor irradiation from many directions.
- the proton beam energy is continuously changed according to the tissue's density in front of the tumor to result in the beam stopping point, defined by the Bragg peak, always being inside the tumor and inside the irradiated slice.
- the novel method allows for irradiation from many directions, referred to herein as multi-field irradiation, to achieve the maximal effective dose at the tumor level while simultaneously significantly reducing possible side-effects on the surrounding healthy tissues in comparison to existing methods.
- the multi-field irradiation system distributes dose-distribution at tissue depths not yet reaching the tumor.
- FIG. 27A a beam delivery and tissue volume scanning system is illustrated.
- the worldwide radiotherapy community uses a method of dose field forming using a pencil beam scanning system.
- FIG. 27 illustrates a spot scanning system or tissue volume scanning system.
- the scanning system is an active system, where the beam is focused into a spot focal point of about one-half, one, two, or three millimeters in diameter.
- the focal point is translated along two axes while simultaneously altering the applied energy of the proton beam, which effectively changes the third dimension of the focal point.
- the system is applicable in combination with the above described rotation of the body, which preferably occurs in-between individual moments or cycles of proton delivery to the tumor.
- the rotation of the body by the above described system occurs continuously and simultaneously with proton delivery to the tumor.
- the spot is translated horizontally, is moved down a vertical y-axis, and is then back along the horizontal axis.
- current is used to control a vertical scanning system having at least one magnet.
- the applied current alters the magnetic field of the vertical scanning system to control the vertical deflection of the proton beam.
- a horizontal scanning magnet system controls the horizontal deflection of the proton beam.
- the degree of transport along each axes is controlled to conform to the tumor cross-section at the given depth. The depth is controlled by changing the energy of the proton beam.
- the proton beam energy is decreased, so as to define a new penetration depth, and the scanning process is repeated along the horizontal and vertical axes covering a new cross-sectional area of the tumor.
- the three axes of control allow scanning or movement of the proton beam focal point over the entire volume of the cancerous tumor.
- the time at each spot and the direction into the body for each spot is controlled to yield the desired radiation does at each sub-volume of the cancerous volume while distributing energy hitting outside of the tumor.
- the focused beam spot volume dimension is preferably tightly controlled to a diameter of about 0.5, 1, or 2 millimeters, but is alternatively several centimeters in diameter.
- Preferred design controls allow scanning in two directions with: (1) a vertical amplitude of about 100 mm amplitude and frequency up to about 200 Hz; and (2) a horizontal amplitude of about 700 mm amplitude and frequency up to about 1 Hz.
- the proton beam is illustrated along a z-axis controlled by the beam energy, the horizontal movement is along an x-axis, and the vertical direction is along a y-axis.
- the distance the protons move along the z-axis into the tissue, in this example, is controlled by the kinetic energy of the proton.
- This coordinate system is arbitrary and exemplary.
- control of the proton beam is controlled in 3-dimensional space using two scanning magnet systems and by simultaneously varying and controlling the kinetic energy of the proton beam.
- the use of the extraction system, described supra, allows for different scanning patterns.
- the system allows simultaneous adjustment of the x-, y-, and z-axes in the irradiation of the solid tumor.
- the system allows for moving along the z-axes while simultaneously adjusting the x- and or y-axes.
- the tumor is optionally irradiated in three simultaneous dimensions. For example, the tumor is irradiated around an outer edge of the tumor in three dimensions. Then the tumor is irradiated around an outer edge of an internal section of the tumor. This process is repeated until the entire tumor is irradiated.
- the outer edge irradiation is preferably coupled with simultaneous rotation of the subject, such as about a vertical y-axis.
- This system allows for maximum efficiency of deposition of protons to the tumor, as defined as the ratio of the proton irradiation energy delivered to the tumor relative to the proton irradiation energy delivered to the healthy tissue.
- the system allows for multi-axes control of the charged particle beam system in a small space with a low or small power supply.
- the system uses multiple magnets where each magnet has at least one edge focusing effect in each turning section of the synchrotron and/or multiple magnets having concentrating magnetic field geometry, as described supra.
- the multiple edge focusing effects in the circulating beam path of the synchrotron combined with the concentration geometry of the magnets and described extraction system yields a synchrotron having:
- the result is a 3-dimensional scanning system, x-, y-, and z-axes control, where the z-axes control resides in the synchrotron and where the z-axes energy is variably controlled during the extraction process inside the synchrotron.
- FIG. 28 an intensity modulated 3-dimensional scanning system 2800 is described.
- a proton beam is being scanned across and x- and/or y-axis as a function of time.
- the z-axis energy is optionally adjusted.
- the energy is increased, and from the third time, t 3 , to the fifth time, t 5 , the energy is decreased.
- the system is scanning in 3-dimensions along the x-, y-, and/or z-axes.
- the radiation energy delivery efficiency is increasing from t 9 to t 3 and decreasing from t 3 to t 5 , where efficiency refers to the percentage of radiation delivered to the tumor.
- efficiency refers to the percentage of radiation delivered to the tumor.
- the Bragg peak energy is located at the distal, or back, portion of the tumor located furthest away from the point of origin where the charged particles enter the tumor 2120 . Delivered Bragg peak energy increases exponentially up to the maximum distance of proton energy penetration into the body.
- the percentage of the delivered Bragg peak energy in the tumor is greatest at the third time period t 3 , which has the largest tumor cross-section pathlength, less at the second and fourth time periods, t 2 and t 4 , and still less at the first and fifth time periods, t 9 and t 5 , which have the smallest tumor cross-section pathlength
- the intensity of the proton beam is also changing with time in a manner correlated with the radiation energy delivery efficiency. In this case, the intensity of the proton beam is greatest at the third time period t 3 , less at the second and fourth time periods, t 2 and t 4 , and still less at the first and fifth time periods, t 9 and t 5 .
- the intensity of the proton beam is adjusted to be more intense when radiation delivery efficiency increases using the proton beam extraction process 1800 and intensity control system 1900 , described supra.
- Intensity is generally positively correlated with tumor cross-sectional pathlength, proton beam energy, and/or radiation delivery efficiency.
- the distal portion of the tumor is targeted with each rotational position of the patient 2130 using the multi-field irradiation 2500 , described supra, allowing repeated use of increased intensity at changing distal portions of the tumor 2120 as the patient 2130 is rotated in the multi-field irradiation system 2500 .
- the intensity controller subsystem 1940 adjusts the radio-frequency field in the RF cavity system 1910 to yield an intensity to correlate with radiation delivery efficiency and/or with the irradiation plan 1960 .
- the intensity controller subsystem adjusts the intensity of the radiation beam using a reading of the actual intensity of the proton beam 1950 or from the feedback current from the extraction material 1930 , which is proportional to the extracted beam intensity, as described supra.
- the intensity of the proton beam is controlled, preferably in coordination with the multi-field irradiation system 2500 , to yield peak intensities with greatest radiation delivery efficiency.
- the independent control of beam parameters allows use of a raster beam scanning system. Often, the greatest radiation delivery efficiency occurs, for a given rotational position of the patient, when the energy of the proton beam is largest. Hence, the intensity of the proton beam optionally correlates with the energy of the proton beam.
- the system is optionally timed with the patient's respiration cycle, as described infra.
- the system optionally operates in a raster beam scanning mode, as described infra.
- An example of a proton scanning or targeting system 140 used to direct the protons to the tumor with 4-dimensional scanning control is provided, where the 4-dimensional scanning control is along the x-, y-, and z-axes along with intensity control, as described supra.
- a fifth controllable axis is time.
- a sixth controllable axis is patient rotation.
- charged particles traveling along the transport path 268 are directed through a first axis control element 142 , such as a vertical control, and a second axis control element 144 , such as a horizontal control and into a tumor 2120 .
- the extraction system also allows for simultaneous variation in the z-axis. Further, as described, supra, the intensity or dose of the extracted beam is optionally simultaneously and independently controlled and varied.
- FIG. 27A instead of irradiating a slice of the tumor, as in FIG. 27A , all four dimensions defining the targeting spot of the proton delivery in the tumor are simultaneously variable.
- the simultaneous variation of the proton delivery spot is illustrated in FIG. 27B by the spot delivery path 269 and in FIG. 28 , where the intensity is controlled as a function of efficiency of radiation delivery.
- the protons are initially directed around an outer edge of the tumor and are then directed around an inner radius of the tumor.
- a multi-field irradiation process is used where a not yet irradiated portion of the tumor is preferably irradiated at the further distance of the tumor from the proton entry point into the body. This yields the greatest percentage of the proton delivery, as defined by the Bragg peak, into the tumor and minimizes damage to peripheral healthy tissue.
- Raster beam scanning is optionally used.
- traditional spot targeting systems a spot of the tumor is targeted, then the radiation beam is turned off, a new spot is targeted, and the radiation beam is turned on. The cycle is repeated with changes in the x- and/or y-axis position.
- the proton beam is scanned from position to position in the tumor without turning off the radiation beam.
- the irradiation is not necessarily turned off between spots, rather the irradiation of the tumor is optionally continuous as the beam scans between 3-dimensional locations in the tumor.
- the velocity of the scanning raster beam is optionally independently controlled. Velocity is change in the x, y, z position of the spot of the scanning beam with time.
- the rate of movement of the proton beam from coordinate to coordinate optionally varies with time or has a mathematical change in velocity with time.
- the movement of the spot of the scanning beam with time is optionally not constant as a function of time.
- the raster beam scanning system optionally uses the simultaneous and/or independent control of the x- and/or y-axes position, energy of the proton beam, intensity of the proton beam, and rotational position of the patient using the acceleration, extraction systems, and rotation systems, described supra.
- a charged particle beam system for irradiation of a tumor of a patient includes: a synchrotron configured with an extraction foil, where a timing controller times the charged particle beam striking the extraction foil in an acceleration period in the synchrotron resulting in extraction of the charged particle beam at a selected energy and a raster beam scanning system configured to scan the charged particle beam across delivery positions while both (1) constantly delivering the charged particle beam at and between the delivery positions and (2) simultaneously varying the selected energy level of the charged particle beam across the delivery positions.
- an intensity controller is used that is configured to measure a current resulting from the charged particle beam striking the extraction foil, the current used as a feedback control to a radio-frequency cavity system, wherein an applied radio frequency, using the feedback control, in the radio-frequency cavity system controls the number of particles in the charged particle beam striking the extraction foil resulting in intensity control of the charged particle beam.
- a velocity controller is configured to change a rate of movement of the charged particle beam between the delivery position along x- and/or y-axes in the tumor as a function of time.
- an X-ray system is used to illustrate an imaging system.
- An X-ray is preferably collected either (1) just before or (2) concurrently with treating a subject with proton therapy for a couple of reasons.
- movement of the body described supra, changes the local position of the tumor in the body relative to other body constituents. If the patient or subject 2130 has an X-ray taken and is then bodily moved to a proton treatment room, accurate alignment of the proton beam to the tumor is problematic. Alignment of the proton beam to the tumor 2120 using one or more X-rays is best performed at the time of proton delivery or in the seconds or minutes immediately prior to proton delivery and after the patient is placed into a therapeutic body position, which is typically a fixed position or partially immobilized position. Second, the X-ray taken after positioning the patient is used for verification of proton beam alignment to a targeted position, such as a tumor and/or internal organ position.
- An X-ray is preferably taken just before treating the subject to aid in patient positioning.
- an X-ray of a large body area is not needed.
- an X-ray of only a local area is collected.
- the X-ray has an X-ray path.
- the proton beam has a proton beam path.
- Overlaying the X-ray path with the proton beam path is one method of aligning the proton beam to the tumor.
- this method involves putting the X-ray equipment into the proton beam path, taking the X-ray, and then moving the X-ray equipment out of the beam path. This process takes time. The elapsed time while the X-ray equipment moves has a couple of detrimental effects.
- the body moves.
- the resulting movement decreases precision and/or accuracy of subsequent proton beam alignment to the tumor.
- the time required to move the X-ray equipment is time that the proton beam therapy system is not in use, which decreases the total efficiency of the proton beam therapy system.
- components in the particle beam therapy system require minimal or no maintenance over the lifetime of the particle beam therapy system.
- electrons are used to create X-rays.
- the electrons are generated at a cathode where the lifetime of the cathode is temperature dependent.
- Analogous to a light bulb, where the filament is kept in equilibrium the cathode temperature is held in equilibrium at temperatures at about 200, 500, or 1000 degrees Celsius. Reduction of the cathode temperature results in increased lifetime of the cathode.
- the cathode used in generating the electrons is preferably held at as low of a temperature as possible. However, if the temperature of the cathode is reduced, then electron emissions also decrease.
- a large cathode is used and the generated electrons are concentrated.
- the process is analogous to compressing electrons in an electron gun; however, here the compression techniques are adapted to apply to enhancing an X-ray tube lifetime.
- Electrons 2920 are generated at a cathode 2910 , focused with a control electrode 2912 , and accelerated with a series of accelerating electrodes 2940 .
- the accelerated electrons 2950 impact an X-ray generation source 2948 resulting in generated X-rays that are then directed along an X-ray path 3070 to the subject 2130 .
- the concentrating of the electrons from a first diameter 2915 to a second diameter 2916 allows the cathode to operate at a reduced temperature and still yield the necessary amplified level of electrons at the X-ray generation source 2948 .
- the X-ray generation source 2948 is the anode coupled with the cathode 2910 and/or the X-ray generation source is substantially composed of tungsten.
- An anode 2914 /cathode 2910 pair is used to generated electrons.
- the electrons 2920 are generated at the cathode 2910 having a first diameter 2915 , which is denoted d 1 .
- the control electrodes 2912 attract the generated electrons 2920 . For example, if the cathode is held at about ⁇ 150 kV and the control electrode is held at about ⁇ 149 kV, then the generated electrons 2920 are attracted toward the control electrodes 2912 and focused.
- a series of accelerating electrodes 2940 are then used to accelerate the electrons into a substantially parallel path 2950 with a smaller diameter 2916 , which is denoted d 2 .
- a first, second, third, and fourth accelerating electrodes 2942 , 2944 , 2946 , 2948 are held at about ⁇ 120, ⁇ 90, ⁇ 60, and ⁇ 30 kV, respectively.
- the cathode 2910 is held at a smaller level, such as about ⁇ 90 kV and the control electrode, first, second, third, and fourth electrode are each adjusted to lower levels.
- the voltage difference from the cathode to fourth electrode is less for a smaller negative voltage at the cathode and vise-versa.
- the accelerated electrons 2950 are optionally passed through a magnetic lens 2960 for adjustment of beam size, such as a cylindrical magnetic lens.
- the electrons are also optionally focused using quadrupole magnets 2970 , which focus in one direction and defocus in another direction.
- the accelerated electrons 2950 which are now adjusted in beam size and focused strike the X-ray generation source 2948 , such as tungsten, resulting in generated X-rays that pass through an optional blocker 3062 and proceed along an X-ray path 3070 to the subject.
- the X-ray generation source 2948 is optionally cooled with a cooling element 2949 , such as water touching or thermally connected to a backside of the X-ray generation source 2948 .
- a cooling element 2949 such as water touching or thermally connected to a backside of the X-ray generation source 2948 .
- the X-ray generation device 2900 produces electrons having initial vectors.
- One or more of the control electrode 2912 , accelerating electrodes 2940 , magnetic lens 2960 , and quadrupole magnets 2970 combine to alter the initial electron vectors into parallel vectors with a decreased cross-sectional area having a substantially parallel path, referred to as the accelerated electrons 2950 .
- the process allows the X-ray generation device 2900 to operate at a lower temperature. Particularly, instead of using a cathode that is the size of the electron beam needed, a larger electrode is used and the resulting electrons 2920 are focused and/or concentrated into the required electron beam needed.
- the concentration of the current density results in a larger lifetime of the X-ray generation device.
- a specific example is provided for clarity. If the cathode has a fifteen mm radius or d 1 is about 30 mm, then the area ( ⁇ r 2 ) is about 225 mm 2 times pi. If the concentration of the electrons achieves a radius of five mm or d 2 is about 10 mm, then the area ( ⁇ r 2 ) is about 25 mm 2 times pi. The ratio of the two areas is about nine (225 ⁇ /25 ⁇ ). Thus, there is about nine times less density of current at the larger cathode compared to the traditional cathode having an area of the desired electron beam.
- the lifetime of the larger cathode approximates nine times the lifetime of the traditional cathode, though the actual current through the larger cathode and traditional cathode is about the same.
- the area of the cathode 2910 is about 2, 4, 6, 8, 10, 15, 20, or 25 times that of the cross-sectional area of the substantially parallel electron beam 2950 .
- the quadrupole magnets 2970 result in an oblong cross-sectional shape of the electron beam 2950 .
- a projection of the oblong cross-sectional shape of the electron beam 2950 onto the X-ray generation source 2948 results in an X-ray beam 3070 that has a small spot in cross-sectional view, which is preferably substantially circular in cross-sectional shape, that is then passed through the patient 2930 .
- the small spot is used to yield an X-ray having enhanced resolution at the patient.
- an X-ray is generated close to, but not in, the proton beam path.
- a proton beam therapy system and an X-ray system combination 3000 is illustrated in FIG. 30 .
- the proton beam therapy system has a proton beam 268 in a transport system after the Lambertson extraction magnet 292 of the synchrotron 130 .
- the proton beam is directed by the scanning/targeting/delivery system 140 to a tumor 2120 of a patient 2130 .
- the X-ray system 3005 includes an electron beam source 2905 generating an electron beam 2950 .
- the electron beam is directed to an X-ray generation source 2948 , such as a piece of tungsten.
- the tungsten X-ray source is located about 1, 2, 3, 5, 10, 15, or 20 millimeters from the proton beam path 268 .
- the electron beam 2950 hits the tungsten, X-rays are generated in all directions. X-rays are blocked with a port 3062 and are selected for an X-ray beam path 3070 .
- the X-ray beam path 3070 and proton beam path 268 run substantially in parallel as they progress to the tumor 2120 .
- the distance between the X-ray beam path 3070 and proton beam path 269 preferably diminishes to near zero and/or the X-ray beam path 3070 and proton beam path 269 overlap by the time they reach the tumor 2120 .
- Simple geometry shows this to be the case given the long distance, of at least a meter, between the tungsten and the tumor 2120 .
- the distance is illustrated as a gap 3080 in FIG. 30 .
- the X-rays are detected at an X-ray detector 3090 , which is used to form an image of the tumor 2120 and/or position of the patient 2130 .
- the system generates an X-ray beam that lies in substantially the same path as the proton therapy beam.
- the X-ray beam is generated by striking a tungsten or equivalent material with an electron beam.
- the X-ray generation source is located proximate to the proton beam path.
- Geometry of the incident electrons, geometry of the X-ray generation material, and/or geometry of the X-ray beam blocker 262 yield an X-ray beam that runs either substantially in parallel with the proton beam or results in an X-ray beam path that starts proximate the proton beam path an expands to cover and transmit through a tumor cross-sectional area to strike an X-ray detector array or film allowing imaging of the tumor from a direction and alignment of the proton therapy beam.
- the X-ray image is then used to control the charged particle beam path to accurately and precisely target the tumor, and/or is used in system verification and validation.
- the electron beam 2950 is shown as an expanded electron beam path 2952 , 2954 .
- the X-ray beam path 3070 is shown as an expanded X-ray beam path 3072 , 3074 .
- an optional system for retracting and repositioning of the X-ray generation source 2948 is illustrated where a flexible bellows 3120 connected to the X-ray generation source 2948 is used to move the X-ray generation source 2948 in an alternating fashion toward the charged particle beam and away from the charged particle beam.
- the flexible bellows 3120 optionally have a metallic surface and/or have an about cylindrical longitudinal shape. Any mechanical means are used to move expand and/or contract the bellows.
- the flexible bellows 3120 is connected to an electron vacuum tube 3110 which maintains a vacuum between the cathode and anode of the X-ray generation device 3000 .
- a 3-dimensional (3-D) X-ray tomography system 3200 is presented.
- the X-ray source and detector rotationally translate about a stationary subject.
- the X-ray source and detector are stationary and the patient 2130 rotates.
- the stationary X-ray source allows a system where the X-ray source 2948 is proximate the proton therapy beam path 268 , as described supra.
- the rotation of the patient 2130 allows the proton dosage to be distributed around the body, rather than being concentrated on one static entrance side of the body.
- the 3-D X-ray tomography system allows for simultaneous updates of the tumor position relative to body constituents in real-time during proton therapy treatment of the tumor 2120 in the patient 2130 .
- the X-ray tomography system is further described, infra.
- a first step of the X-ray tomography system 3200 the patient 2130 is positioned relative to the X-ray beam path 3070 and proton beam path 268 using a patient semi-immobilization/placement system, described infra.
- a series of reference 2-D X-ray images are collected, on a detector array 3090 or film, of the patient 2130 and tumor 2120 as the subject is rotated about a y-axis 2117 .
- a series of about 50, 100, 200, or 400 X-ray images of the patient are collected as the patient is rotated.
- an X-ray image is collected with each n degrees of rotation of the patient 2130 , where n is about 1 ⁇ 2, 1, 2, 3, 5, 10, or 20 degrees of rotation. Preferably, about 200 images are collected during one full rotation of the patient through 360 degrees.
- an algorithm produces a reference 3-D picture of the tumor 2120 relative to the patient's constituent body parts.
- a tumor 2120 irradiation plan is made using the 3-D picture of the tumor 2120 and the patient's constituent body parts. Creation of the proton irradiation plan is optionally performed after the patient has moved from the X-ray imaging area.
- the patient 2130 is repositioned relative to the X-ray beam path 3070 and proton beam path 268 using the patient semi-immobilization/placement system.
- a few comparative X-ray images of the patient 2130 and tumor 2120 are collected at a limited number of positions using the X-ray tomography system 2600 setup. For example, a single X-ray image is collected with the patient positioned straight on, at angles of plus/minus forty-five degrees, and/or at angles of plus/minus ninety degrees relative to the proton beam path 268 .
- the actual orientation of the patient 2130 relative to the proton beam path 268 is optionally any orientation.
- the actual number of comparative X-ray images is also optionally any number of images, though the preferable number of comparative X-ray images is about 2 to 5 comparative images.
- the comparative X-ray images are compared to the reference X-ray images and differences are detected.
- a medical expert or an algorithm determines if the difference between the reference images and the comparative images is significant. Based upon the differences, the medical expert or algorithm determines if: proton treatment should commence, be halted, or adapted in real-time. For example, if significant differences in the X-ray images are observed, then the treatment is preferably halted and the process of collecting a reference 3-D picture of the patient's tumor is reinitiated.
- the proton irradiation plan commences.
- the algorithm or medical expert can adapt the proton irradiation plan in real-time to adjust for differences in tumor location resulting from changes in position of the tumor 2120 in the patient 2130 or from differences in the patient 2130 placement.
- the adaptive proton therapy increases patient throughput and enhances precision and accuracy of proton irradiation of the tumor 2120 relative to the healthy tissue of the patient 2130 .
- Accurate and precise delivery of a proton beam to a tumor of a patient requires: (1) positioning control of the proton beam and (2) positioning control of the patient.
- the proton beam is controlled using algorithms and magnetic fields to a diameter of about 0.5, 1, or 2 millimeters. This section addresses partial immobilization, restraint, and/or alignment of the patient to insure the tightly controlled proton beam efficiently hits a target tumor and not surrounding healthy tissue as a result of patient movement.
- an x-, y-, and z-axes coordinate system and rotation axis is used to describe the orientation of the patient relative to the proton beam.
- the z-axis represent travel of the proton beam, such as the depth of the proton beam into the patient.
- the x-axis refers to moving left or right across the patient and the y-axis refers to movement up or down the patient.
- a first rotation axis is rotation of the patient about the y-axis and is referred to herein as a rotation axis, bottom unit 2112 rotation axis, or y-axis of rotation 2117 .
- tilt is rotation about an axis, such as the x-, y-, and/or z-axes.
- tile is rotation about the x-axis
- yaw is rotation about the y-axis
- roll is rotation about the z-axis.
- the proton beam path 269 optionally runs in any direction.
- the proton beam path running through a treatment room is described as running horizontally through the treatment room.
- a semi-vertical partial immobilization system 3300 (2) a sitting partial immobilization system 3400 ; and (3) a laying positioning system 3500 .
- Elements described for one immobilization system apply to other immobilization systems with small changes.
- a headrest, a head support, or head restraint will adjust along one axis for a reclined position, along a second axis for a seated position, and along a third axis for a laying position.
- the headrest itself is similar for each immobilization position.
- the semi-vertical patient positioning system 3300 is preferably used in conjunction with proton therapy of tumors in the torso.
- the patient positioning and/or immobilization system controls and/or restricts movement of the patient during proton beam therapy.
- the patient is positioned in a semi-vertical position in a proton beam therapy system. As illustrated, the patient is reclining at an angle alpha, ⁇ , about 45 degrees off of the y-axis as defined by an axis running from head to foot of the patient.
- the patient is optionally completely standing in a vertical position of zero degrees off the of y-axis or is in a semi-vertical position alpha that is reclined about 5, 10, 15, 20, 25, 30, 35, 40, 45, 50, 55, 60, or 65 degrees off of the y-axis toward the z-axis.
- Patient positioning constraints 3315 that are used to maintain the patient in a treatment position, include one or more of: a seat support 3320 , a back support 3330 , a head support 3340 , an arm support 3350 , a knee support 3360 , and a foot support 3370 .
- the constraints are optionally and independently rigid or semi-rigid. Examples of a semi-rigid material include a high or low density foam or a visco-elastic foam.
- the foot support is preferably rigid and the back support is preferably semi-rigid, such as a high density foam material.
- One or more of the positioning constraints 3315 are movable and/or under computer control for rapid positioning and/or immobilization of the patient.
- the seat support 3320 is adjustable along a seat adjustment axis 3322 , which is preferably the y-axis;
- the back support 3330 is adjustable along a back support axis 3332 , which is preferably dominated by z-axis movement with a y-axis element;
- the head support 3340 is adjustable along a head support axis 3342 , which is preferably dominated by z-axis movement with a y-axis element;
- the arm support 3350 is adjustable along an arm support axis 3352 , which is preferably dominated by z-axis movement with a y-axis element;
- the knee support 3360 is adjustable along a knee support axis 3362 , which is preferably dominated by z-axis movement with a y-axis element;
- the foot support 3370 is adjustable along a foot support axis 3372 , which is preferably dominated by y-axis movement with a z-axis element.
- An optional camera 3380 is used with the patient immobilization system.
- the camera views the patient/subject 2130 creating a video image.
- the image is provided to one or more operators of the charged particle beam system and allows the operators a safety mechanism for determining if the subject has moved or desires to terminate the proton therapy treatment procedure.
- the operators optionally suspend or terminate the proton therapy procedure. For example, if the operator observes via the video image that the subject is moving, then the operator has the option to terminate or suspend the proton therapy procedure.
- An optional video display or display monitor 3390 is provided to the patient.
- the video display optionally presents to the patient any of: operator instructions, system instructions, status of treatment, or entertainment.
- Motors for positioning the patient positioning constraints 3315 , the camera 3380 , and/or video display 3390 are preferably mounted above or below the proton transport path 268 or momentary proton scanning path 269 .
- Respiration control is optionally performed by using the video display.
- internal and external structures of the body move in both absolute terms and in relative terms.
- the outside of the chest cavity and internal organs both have absolute moves with a breath.
- the relative position of an internal organ relative to another body component such as an outer region of the body, a bone, support structure, or another organ, moves with each breath.
- the proton beam is preferably delivered at a point in time where the position of the internal structure or tumor is well defined, such as at the bottom or top of each breath.
- the video display is used to help coordinate the proton beam delivery with the patient's respiration cycle.
- the video display optionally displays to the patient a command, such as a hold breath statement, a breathe statement, a countdown indicating when a breath will next need to be held, or a countdown until breathing may resume.
- the patient is partially restrained in a seated position 3400 .
- the sitting restraint system uses support structures similar to the support structures in the semi-vertical positioning system, described supra, with an exception that the seat support is replaced by a chair and the knee support is not required.
- the seated restraint system generally retains the adjustable support, rotation about the y-axis, camera, video, and breath control parameters described in the semi-vertical embodiment, described supra.
- the sitting system is preferably used for treatment of head and/or neck tumors.
- the patient is positioned in a seated position on a chair 3410 for particle therapy.
- the patient is further immobilized using any of the: the head support 3340 , the back support 3330 , the hand support 3350 , the knee support 3360 , and the foot support 3370 .
- the supports 3320 , 3330 , 3340 , 3350 , 3360 , 3370 preferably have respective axes of adjustment 3322 , 3332 , 3342 , 3352 , 3362 , 3372 as illustrated.
- the chair 3410 is either readily removed to allow for use of a different patient constraint system or adapts under computer control to a new patient position, such as the semi-vertical system.
- the patient is partially restrained in a laying position.
- the laying positioning system 3500 or laying restraint system has support structures that are similar to the support structures used in the sitting positioning system 3400 and semi-vertical positioning system 3300 , described supra.
- optional restraint, support, or partial immobilization elements include one or more of: the head support 3340 and the back support, hip, and shoulder 3330 support.
- the supports preferably have respective axes of adjustment that are rotated as appropriate for a laying position of the patient.
- the laying position restraint system generally retains the adjustable supports, rotation about the y-axis, camera, video, and breath control parameters described in the semi-vertical embodiment, described supra.
- the support table has a horizontal platform to support the bulk of the weight of the patient.
- the horizontal platform is detachable from a treatment platform.
- the patient is positioned on a platform 3510 , which has a substantially horizontal portion for supporting the weight of the body in a horizontal position.
- Optional hand grips are used, described infra.
- the platform 3510 affixes relative to the table 3520 using a mechanical stop or lock element 3530 and matching key element 3535 and/or the patient 2130 is aligned or positioned relative to a placement element 3560 .
- upper leg support 3544 , lower leg support 3540 , and/or arm support 3550 elements are optionally added to raise, respectively, an arm or leg out of the proton beam path 269 for treatment of a tumor in the torso or to move an arm or leg into the proton beam path 269 for treatment of a tumor in the arm or leg.
- the leg supports 3540 , 3544 and arm support 3550 are each optionally adjustable along support axes or arcs 3542 , 3546 , 3552 .
- One or more leg support elements are optionally adjustable along an arc to position the leg into the proton beam path 269 or to remove the leg from the proton beam path 269 , as described infra.
- An arm support element is preferably adjustable along at least one arm adjustment axis or along an arc to position the arm into the proton beam path 269 or to remove the arm from the proton beam path 269 , as described infra.
- the patient is positioned on the platform 3510 in an area or room outside of the proton beam path 268 and is wheeled or slid into the treatment room or proton beam path area.
- the patient is wheeled into the treatment room on a gurney where the top of the gurney, which is the platform, detaches and is positioned onto a table.
- the platform is preferably lifted onto the table or slid onto the table so that the gurney or bed need not be lifted onto the table.
- the semi-vertical patient positioning system 3300 and sitting patient positioning system 3400 are preferentially used to treatment of tumors in the head or torso due to efficiency.
- the semi-vertical patient positioning system 3300 , sitting patient positioning system 3400 , and laying patient positioning system 3500 are all usable for treatment of tumors in the patient's limbs.
- Positioning constraints 3315 include all elements used to position the patient, such as those described in the semi-vertical positioning system 3300 , sitting positioning system 3400 , and laying positioning system 3500 .
- positioning constraints or support system elements are aligned in positions that do not impede or overlap the proton beam path 269 .
- the positioning constraints are in the proton beam path 269 during at least part of the time of treatment of the patient.
- a positioning constraint element may reside in the proton beam path 269 during part of a time period where the patient is rotated about the y-axis during treatment.
- an upward adjustment of proton beam energy is preferably applied that increases the proton beam energy to offset the positioning constraint element impedance of the proton beam.
- This time period and energy is a function of rotational orientation of the patient.
- the proton beam energy is increased by a separate measure of the positioning constraint element impedance determined during a reference scan of the positioning constraint system element or set of reference scans of the positioning constraint element as a function of rotation about the y-axis.
- the positioning constraints 3315 or support system elements are herein described relative to the semi-vertical positioning system 3300 ; however, the positioning elements and descriptive x-, y-, and z-axes are adjustable to fit any coordinate system, to the sitting positioning system 3400 , or the laying positioning system 3500 .
- the head support system preferably has several head support elements including any of: a back of head support, a right of head alignment element, and a left of head alignment element.
- the back of head support element is preferably curved to fit the head and is optionally adjustable along a head support axis, such as along the z-axis.
- the head supports like the other patient positioning constraints, is preferably made of a semi-rigid material, such as a low or high density foam, and has an optional covering, such as a plastic or leather.
- the right of head alignment element and left of head alignment elements or head alignment elements are primarily used to semi-constrain movement of the head or to fully immobilize the head.
- the head alignment elements are preferably padded and flat, but optionally have a radius of curvature to fit the side of the head.
- the right and left head alignment elements are preferably respectively movable along translation axes to make contact with the sides of the head. Restricted movement of the head during proton therapy is important when targeting and treating tumors in the head or neck.
- the head alignment elements and the back of head support element combine to restrict tilt, rotation or yaw, roll and/or position of the head in the x-, y-, z-axes coordinate system.
- FIG. 36 another example of a head support system 3600 is described for positioning and/or restricting movement of a human head 2102 during proton therapy of a solid tumor in the head or neck.
- the head is restrained using 1, 2, 3, 4, or more straps or belts, which are preferably connected or replaceably connected to a back of head support element 3610 .
- a first strap 3620 pulls or positions the forehead to the head support element 3610 , such as by running predominantly along the z-axis.
- a second strap 3630 works in conjunction with the first strap 3620 to prevent the head from undergoing tilt, yaw, roll or moving in terms of translational movement on the x-, y-, and z-axes coordinate system.
- the second strap 3630 is preferably attached or replaceable attached to the first strap 3620 at or about: (1) a forehead position 3632 ; (2) at a position on one or both sides of the head 3634 ; and/or (3) at or about a position on the support element 3636 .
- a third strap 3640 preferably orientates the chin of the subject relative to the support element 3610 by running dominantly along the z-axis.
- a fourth strap 3650 preferably runs along a predominantly y- and z-axes to hold the chin relative to the head support element 3610 and/or proton beam path.
- the third 3640 strap preferably is attached to or is replaceably attached to the fourth strap 3650 during use at or about the patient's chin position 3642 .
- the second strap 3630 optionally connects 3636 to the fourth strap 3650 at or about the support element 3610 .
- the four straps 3620 , 3630 , 3640 , 3650 are illustrative in pathway and interconnection. Any of the straps optionally hold the head along different paths around the head and connect to each other in separate fashion. Naturally, a given strap preferably runs around the head and not just on one side of the head. Any of the straps 3620 , 3630 , 3640 , and 3650 are optionally used independently or in combinations and permutations with the other straps.
- the straps are optionally indirectly connected to each other via a support element, such as the head support element 3610 .
- the straps are optionally attached to the head support element 3610 using hook and loop technology, a buckle, or fastener. Generally, the straps combine to control position, front-to-back movement of the head, side-to-side movement of the head, tilt, yaw, roll, and/or translational position of the head.
- the straps are preferably of known impedance to proton transmission allowing a calculation of peak energy release along the z-axis to be calculated. For example, adjustment to the Bragg peak energy is made based on the slowing tendency of the straps to proton transport.
- the head support 3340 is preferably curved to fit a standard or child sized head.
- the head support 3340 is optionally adjustable along a head support axis 3342 .
- the head supports like the other patient positioning constraints, is preferably made of a semi-rigid material, such as a low or high density foam, and has an optional covering, such as a plastic or leather.
- the arm support 3350 preferably has a left hand grip 3710 and a right hand grip 3720 used for aligning the upper body of the patient 2130 through the action of the patient 2130 gripping the left and right hand grips 3710 , 3720 with the patient's hands 2134 .
- the left and right hand grips 3710 , 3720 are preferably connected to the arm support 3350 that supports the mass of the patient's arms.
- the left and right hand grips 3710 , 3720 are preferably constructed using a semi-rigid material.
- the left and right hand grips 3710 , 3720 are optionally molded to the patient's hands to aid in alignment.
- the left and right hand grips optionally have electrodes, as described supra.
- a rapid patient positioning system 3800 which facilitates positioning of the patient.
- systems for the partial immobilization, restraint, and/or alignment of the patient were described to ensure the tightly controlled proton beam efficiently hits a target tumor and not surrounding healthy tissue as a result of patient movement.
- the positioning system placing the patient into a laying position was described.
- the patient lays in any position on a flat table.
- the resulting variation in patient placement on the table is necessarily compensated for using methods that require fifteen to twenty minutes.
- many patients have physical and/or health constraints that make it difficult for the patient to climb onto the table.
- an alternative rapid patient positioning system 3800 is provided.
- the rapid patient positioning system 3800 contains several steps including:
- the robot arm is an arm in common with an arm used to move the patient 2130 in traditional proton therapy.
- the robot arm is used to re-orientate the patient 2130 into a substantially vertical orientation at the conclusion of a charged particle therapy session.
- the patient 2130 is positioned relative to a table 3510 in a substantially vertical orientation at a first point in time, t 1 .
- the patient 2130 leans against the table 3510 held in a substantially vertical orientation, such as at an angle ⁇ that is vertical or about 5, 10, 15, 20, 25, or 30 degrees off of vertical.
- Any of the above described positioning constraints 3315 such as the seat support 3320 , the back support 3330 , the head support 3340 , the arm support 3350 , the knee support 3360 , and/or the foot support 3370 are optionally used to position the patient 2130 relative to the substantially vertical table 3510 .
- FIG. 38 illustrates a knee back support 3364 , which is an example of a positioning constraint 3315 .
- the knee back support 3364 supports the back of the knee of the patient 2130 off of the table 3510 .
- one or more of the positioning constraints 3315 substantially align the patient relative to the table 3510 in an orientation that the patient can readily access.
- the foot of the table 3510 is resting on the floor or is within 10, 20, or 30 centimeters of the floor to facilitate the patient stepping onto the foot support 3370 attached to the table 3510 .
- the table 3510 is re-orientated through a semi-vertical orientation by one or more robot arms 3850 , such as a first robot arm positioned near the head of a table 3510 or a second robot arm positioned at a foot of the table 3510 .
- the preferably single robot arm 3850 finalizes orientation of the table 3510 into a substantially horizontal position. In this manner, the patient 2130 is rapidly positioned onto the table 3510 in a fixed position in a time period of less than 1, 2, or 3 minutes.
- the positions of one or more elements of one or more of the positioning constraints 3315 are recorded digitally and are later used in a step of computer controlled repositioning of the patient in the minutes or seconds prior to implementation of the irradiation element of the tumor treatment plan.
- a patient support system 3900 is used to facilitate positioning of the patient 2130 .
- a patient 2130 is illustrated relative to a support 3301 , such as the table 3510 or an element attached to the table 3510 .
- two positioning constraints 3315 are illustrated, an embodiment of the head constraint 3340 and an embodiment of the back constraint 3330 .
- the back constraint 3330 has at least degrees of freedom along the x- and/or z-axes for an arbitrary axis system with the z-axis running through the patient 2130 from front to back and the z-axis running from the patient's left shoulder to right shoulder.
- one or both of the x- and z-axes degrees of freedom are under computer and motor control, as described infra for the positioning constraints 3315 .
- FIG. 39 to illustrate the degrees of freedom of the back constraint 3330 , the patient is illustrated at three points of time, t 1 , t 2 , t 3 , with the back constraint 3330 in varying configurations.
- FIG. 39A at the first time, t 1 , the shoulders of the patient 2130 are observed to not fit into the back constraint 3330 .
- FIG. 39B at the second point in time, t 2 , a left and a right side of the back constraints have been adjusted along the x-axis in opposite directions a first distance, d 1 , to a point where the shoulders fit comfortably but are constrained between the left side and the right side of the back constraint 3330 .
- each of the back constraint 3330 degrees of freedom along the x- and z-axes are independently adjustable.
- the head constraint 3340 is optionally adjustable along the z-axis relative to the back constraint 3330 , which have a common fixed element of the support 3301 or table 3510 , to achieve relaxation and constraint of the head relative to the shoulders of the patient 2130 .
- the back constraint 3330 and head constraint 3340 of the patient support system 3900 allows for a comfortable, computer recorded, and computer adjustable patient support configuration.
- the patient support system 3900 is preferably integrated with the rapid patient positioning system 3800 , described supra, to facilitate rapid, accurate, and/or precise alignment of the patient 2130 relative to the table 3510 in the charged particle therapy system described herein.
- the patient's respiration pattern is monitored.
- a subject or patient 2130 is breathing many portions of the body move with each breath.
- the lungs move as do relative positions of organs within the body, such as the stomach, kidneys, liver, chest muscles, skin, heart, and lungs.
- most or all parts of the torso move with each breath.
- Motion is to be considered in delivery of a proton dose to the body as the protons are preferentially delivered to the tumor and not to surrounding tissue. Motion thus results in an ambiguity in where the tumor resides relative to the beam path.
- protons are preferentially delivered at the same point in each of a series of respiration cycles.
- a rhythmic pattern of breathing of a subject is determined.
- the cycle is observed or measured.
- an X-ray beam operator or proton beam operator can observe when a subject is breathing or is between breaths and can time the delivery of the protons to a given period of each breath.
- the subject is told to inhale, exhale, and/or hold their breath and the protons are delivered during the commanded time period.
- one or more sensors are used to determine the respiration cycle of the individual.
- a respiration monitoring system 4010 Two examples of a respiration monitoring system 4010 are provided: (1) a thermal monitoring system and (2) a force monitoring system.
- a first example of the thermal respiration monitoring system is provided.
- a sensor is placed by the nose and/or mouth of the patient.
- the thermal respiration monitoring system is preferably placed by the patient's nose exhalation path.
- the thermal respiration monitoring system is preferably used when treating a tumor not located in the head or neck, such as a when treating a tumor in the torso or limbs.
- a first thermal resistor 3670 is used to monitor the patient's respiration cycle and/or location in the patient's respiration cycle.
- the first thermal resistor 3670 is placed by the patient's nose, such that the patient exhaling through their nose onto the first thermal resistor 3670 warms the first thermal resistor 3670 indicating an exhale.
- a second thermal resistor 3660 operates as an environmental temperature sensor.
- the second thermal resistor 3660 is preferably placed out of the exhalation path of the patient but in the same local room environment as the first thermal resistor 3670 .
- Generated signal such as current from the thermal resistors 3670 , 3660 , is preferably converted to voltage and communicated with the main controller 110 or a sub-controller of the main controller.
- the second thermal resistor 3660 is used to adjust for the environmental temperature fluctuation that is part of a signal of the first thermal resistor 3670 , such as by calculating a difference between the values of the thermal resistors 3670 , 3660 to yield a more accurate reading of the patient's respiration cycle.
- a second example of a monitoring system is provided.
- a sensor is placed by the torso.
- the force respiration monitoring system is preferably used when treating a tumor located in the head, neck, or limbs.
- a belt or strap 3450 is placed around an area of the patient's torso that expands and contracts with each respiration cycle of the patient.
- the belt 3450 is preferably tight about the patient's chest and is flexible.
- a force meter 3452 is attached to the belt and senses the patients respiration pattern. The forces applied to the force meter 3452 correlate with periods of the respiration cycle.
- the signals from the force meter 3452 are preferably communicated with the main controller 110 or a sub-controller of the main controller.
- charged particle beam control systems described supra, are coordinated for cancer therapy.
- a method of cancer therapy is provided.
- the patient is first positioned 4010 , then the tumor is imaged 4020 , subsequently a charged particle irradiation plan is developed 4030 , and then the charged particle irradiation plan is implemented 4040 .
- the positioning, imaging, and irradiation steps are optionally integrated with patient translation control, patient rotation control, and/or patient respiration control.
- any of the steps described herein are optionally coordinated with charged particle beam generation, acceleration, extraction, and/or delivery.
- any of the steps are optionally coordinated with x-, y-axis beam trajectory control, delivered energy control, delivered intensity control, timing of charged particle delivery, and/or distribution of radiation striking healthy tissue.
- a method of tumor imaging is provided.
- the patient is positioned 4010 , such as with the patient immobilization and/or positioning systems described supra.
- the tumor is imaged 4020 , such as with the imaging/X-ray system described supra.
- each image is a 2-dimensional image.
- the patient is rotated 4020 , such as with the multi-field irradiation rotatable platform described supra. For instance, the image is collected with rotation of the patient about the y-axis 2117 .
- n degrees of rotation of the patient 2130 where n is about 1 ⁇ 2, 1, 2, 3, 5, 10, or 20 degrees
- another image is collected 4020 .
- the imaging 4020 and rotation 4120 processes are repeated until the tumor 2120 is suitably imaged.
- a 3-dimensional image is created 4130 using the two-dimensional images collected as a function of patient rotation.
- a patient is positioned 4010 and once the rhythmic pattern of the subject's breathing or respiration cycle is determined 4210 , a signal is optionally delivered to the patient, such as via the display monitor 3390 , to more precisely control the breathing frequency 4220 .
- the display screen 3390 is placed in front of the patient and a message or signal is transmitted to the display screen 3390 directing the subject when to hold their breath and when to breathe.
- a respiration control module uses input from one or more of the respiration sensors. For example, the input is used to determine when the next breath exhale is to complete.
- the control module displays a hold breath signal to the subject, such as on a monitor, via an oral signal, digitized and automatically generated voice command, or via a visual control signal.
- a display monitor 3390 is positioned in front of the subject and the display monitor displays breathing commands to the subject.
- the subject is directed to hold their breath for a short period of time, such as about 1 ⁇ 2, 1, 2, 3, 5, or 10 seconds.
- the period of time the breath is held is preferably synchronized to the delivery time of the proton beam to the tumor, which is about 1 ⁇ 2, 1, 2, or 3 seconds. While delivery of the protons at the bottom of the breath is preferred, protons are optionally delivered at any point in the respiration cycle, such as upon full inhalation.
- the respiration control module Delivery at the top of the breath or when the patient is directed to inhale deeply and hold their breath by the respiration control module is optionally performed as at the top of the breath the chest cavity is largest and for some tumors the distance between the tumor and surrounding tissue is maximized or the surrounding tissue is rarefied as a result of the increased volume. Hence, protons hitting surrounding tissue is minimized.
- the display screen tells the subject when they are about to be asked to hold their breath, such as with a 3, 2, 1, second countdown so that the subject is aware of the task they are about to be asked to perform.
- X-ray images are collected in synchronization with patient respiration.
- the synchronization enhances X-ray image clarity by removing position ambiguity due to the relative movement of body constituents during a patient respiration cycle.
- an X-ray system is orientated to provide X-ray images of a patient in the same orientation as viewed by a proton therapy beam, is synchronized with patient respiration, is operable on a patient positioned for proton therapy, and does not interfere with a proton beam treatment path.
- the synchronized system is used in conjunction with a negative ion beam source, synchrotron, and/or targeting method and apparatus to provide an X-ray timed with patient respiration.
- X-ray images are collected immediately prior to and/or concurrently with particle beam therapy irradiation to ensure targeted and controlled delivery of energy relative to a patient position resulting in efficient, precise, and/or accurate in-vivo treatment of a solid cancerous tumor with minimization of damage to surrounding healthy tissue.
- An X-ray delivery control algorithm is used to synchronize delivery of the X-rays to the patient 2130 within a given period of each breath, such as at the top or bottom of a breath, and/or when the subject is holding their breath.
- the patient is preferably both accurately positioned and precisely aligned relative to the X-ray beam path 3070 .
- the X-ray delivery control algorithm is preferably integrated with the respiration control module.
- the X-ray delivery control algorithm knows when the subject is breathing, where in the respiration cycle the subject is, and/or when the subject is holding their breath. In this manner, the X-ray delivery control algorithm delivers X-rays at a selected period of the respiration cycle. Accuracy and precision of patient alignment allow for (1) more accurate and precise location of the tumor 2120 relative to other body constituents and (2) more accurate and precise combination of X-rays in generation of a 3-dimensional X-ray image of the patient 2130 and tumor 2120 .
- an example of generating an X-ray image of the patient 2130 and tumor 2120 using the X-ray generation device 3000 or 3-dimensional X-ray generation device 3000 as a known function of time of the patient's respiration cycle is provided.
- the main controller 110 instructs, monitors, and/or is informed of patient positioning 4010 .
- the automated patient positioning system described supra, under main controller 110 control, is used to align the patient 2130 relative to the X-ray beam path 3070 .
- the main controller 110 is told via sensors or human input that the patient 2130 is aligned.
- patient respiration is then monitored 4210 , as described infra.
- respiration monitoring an X-ray is collected 4230 at a known point in the patient respiration cycle.
- the patient's respiration cycle is first controlled in a third step of controlling patient respiration 4220 and then as a fourth step an X-ray is collected 4230 at a controlled point in the patient respiration cycle.
- the cycle of patient positioning 4010 , patient respiration monitoring 4210 , patient respiration control 4220 , and collecting an X-ray 4230 is repeated with different patient positions.
- the patient 2130 is rotated about an axis 2117 and X-rays are collected as a function of the rotation.
- a 3-dimensional X-ray image 4240 is generated of the patient 2130 , tumor 2120 , and body constituents about the tumor using the collected X-ray images, such as with the 3-dimensional X-ray generation device 3000 , described supra.
- the patient respiration monitoring and control steps are further described, infra.
- An X-ray timed with patient respiration where the X-ray is preferably collected immediately prior to and/or concurrently with particle beam therapy irradiation to ensure targeted and controlled delivery of energy relative to a patient position resulting in efficient, precise, and/or accurate treatment of a solid cancerous tumor with minimization of damage to surrounding healthy tissue in a patient using the proton beam position verification system.
- charged particle therapy and preferably multi-field proton therapy is coordinated and synchronized with patient respiration via use of the respiration feedback sensors, described supra, used to monitor and/or control patient respiration.
- the charged particle therapy is performed on a patient in a partially immobilized and repositionable position and the proton delivery to the tumor 2120 is timed to patient respiration via control of charged particle beam injection, acceleration, extraction, and/or targeting methods and apparatus.
- the synchronization enhances proton delivery accuracy by removing position ambiguity due to the relative movement of body constituents during a patient respiration cycle. Synchrotron control to deliver protons at a desired point in the respiration cycle is described infra.
- the X-ray system in a second embodiment, is used to provide X-ray images of a patient in the same orientation as viewed by a proton therapy beam and both the X-ray system and the proton therapy beam are synchronized with patient respiration.
- synchrotron control to deliver protons at a desired point in the respiration cycle is described infra.
- a proton delivery control algorithm is used to synchronize delivery of the protons to the tumor within a given period of each breath, such as at the top of a breath, at the bottom of a breath, and/or when the subject is holding their breath.
- the proton delivery control algorithm is preferably integrated with the respiration control module.
- the proton delivery control algorithm knows when the subject is breathing, where in the respiration cycle the subject is, and/or when the subject is holding their breath.
- the proton delivery control algorithm controls when protons are injected and/or inflected into the synchrotron, when an RF signal is applied to induce an oscillation, as described supra, and when a DC voltage is applied to extract protons from the synchrotron, as described supra.
- the proton delivery control algorithm initiates proton inflection and subsequent RF induced oscillation before the subject is directed to hold their breath or before the identified period of the respiration cycle selected for a proton delivery time.
- the proton delivery control algorithm delivers protons at a selected period of the respiration cycle by simultaneously or nearly simultaneously delivering the high DC voltage to the second pair of plates, described supra, which results in extraction of the protons from the synchrotron and subsequent delivery to the subject at the selected time point. Since the period of acceleration of protons in the synchrotron is constant or known for a desired energy level of the proton beam, the proton delivery control algorithm is used to set an AC RF signal that matches the respiration cycle or directed respiration cycle of the subject.
- the above described charged particle therapy elements are combined in combinations and/or permutations in developing and implementing a tumor treatment plan, described infra.
- the multi-axis and/or multi-field charged particle cancer therapy system elements described herein are preferably coordinated with charged particle delivery 4300 .
- hydrogen is injected 4315 into the negative ion source 310
- plasma is generated 4320
- a negative ion is extracted 4325
- the negative ion is accelerated 4330 , converted into a positive ion 4340 , and injected into the synchrotron 4345 .
- the positive ion is accelerated 4350 , extraction is initiated 4355 , intensity of the irradiation beam is controlled 4360 , extraction of the charged particle beam is performed 4365 , and the tumor is irradiated 4370 .
- one or more elements of the charged particle delivery 4300 system are timed with patient respiration.
- the patient is preferably rotated 4120 and the irradiation sequence is repeated yielding multi-field irradiation of the tumor 2120 .
- the entire sequence is optionally performed using the intensity modulated 3-dimensional scanning system 2800 , described supra.
- a multi-axis charged particle beam therapy system where multi-axis refers to independent control of: x-axis beam control, y-axis beam control, delivered beam energy, and/or delivered beam intensity.
- the multi-axis control is preferably implemented with multi-field charge particle irradiation, such as via use of independent control of rotation and/or translation of the patient.
- the main controller 110 independently adjusts x-axis targeting of the proton beam 4410 , y-axis targeting of the proton beam 4420 , rotational position of the patient 4430 , delivered energy of the proton beam 4440 , and/or delivered intensity of the proton beam in the step of irradiating the tumor 4040 .
- the process is optionally repeated or iterated using a continuously irradiating and scanning charged particle irradiation system as described using the 3-dimensional scanning system 2800 .
- a series of steps are performed to design and execute a radiation treatment plan for treating a tumor 2120 in a patient 2130 .
- the steps include one or more of:
- FIG. 45 an overview of a system for development of an irradiation plan and subsequent implementation of the irradiation plan 4500 is provided.
- all elements of the positioning, respiration monitoring, imaging, and tumor irradiation system 4500 are under main controller 110 control.
- the tumor containing volume of the patient 2130 is positioned and immobilized 4010 in a controlled and reproducible position.
- the process of positioning and immobilizing 4010 the patient 2310 is preferably iterated 4512 until the position is accepted.
- the position is preferably digitally recorded 4515 and is later used in a step of computer controlled repositioning of the patient 4517 in the minutes or seconds prior to implementation of the irradiation element 4040 of the tumor treatment plan.
- the process of positioning the patient in a reproducible fashion and reproducibly aligning the patient 2310 to the controlled position is further described, infra.
- Multi-field images of the tumor are then collected 4540 in the controlled, immobilized, and reproducible position.
- multi-field X-ray images of the tumor 2120 are collected using the X-ray source proximate the proton beam path, as described supra.
- the multi-field images are optionally from three or more positions and/or are collected while the patient is rotated, as described supra.
- the patient 2130 is either maintained in the treatment position or is allowed to move from the controlled treatment position while an oncologist processes the multi-field images 4545 and generates a tumor treatment plan 4550 using the multi-field images.
- the tumor irradiation plan is implemented 4040 at this point in time.
- the patient 2130 is repositioned 4517 .
- the patient's respiration cycle is again monitored 4212 and/or controlled 4022 , such as via use of the thermal monitoring respiration sensors, force monitoring respiration sensor, and/or via commands sent to the display monitor 3390 , described supra.
- verification images are collected 4560 , such as X-ray location verification images from 1, 2, or 3 directions. For example, verification images are collected with the patient facing the proton beam and at rotation angles of 90, 180, and 270 degrees from this position.
- the algorithm or preferably the oncologist determines if the tumor 2120 is sufficiently repositioned 4565 relative to other body parts to allow for initiation of tumor irradiation using the charged particle beam.
- the step of accepting the final position of the patient 4565 is a safety feature used to verify that that the tumor 2120 in the patient 2130 has not shifted or grown beyond set specifications.
- the charged particle beam therapy commences 4040 .
- the patient's respiration is monitored 4214 and/or controlled 4224 , as described supra, prior to commencement of the charged particle beam treatment 4040 .
- simultaneous X-ray imaging 4590 of the tumor 2120 is performed during the multi-field proton beam irradiation procedure and the main controller 110 uses the X-ray images to adapt the radiation treatment plan in real-time to account for small variations in movement of the tumor 2120 within the patient 2130 .
- the steps of monitoring 4210 , 4212 , 4214 and controlling 4220 , 4222 , 4224 the patient's respiration are optional, but preferred.
- the steps of monitoring and controlling the patient's respiration are performed before and/or during the multi-filed imaging 4540 , position verification 4560 , and/or tumor irradiation 4040 steps.
- the patient positioning 4010 and patient repositioning 4517 steps are further described, infra.
- the charged particle accelerator is synchronized to the patient's respiration cycle. More particularly, synchrotron acceleration cycle usage efficiency is enhanced by adjusting the synchrotron's acceleration cycle to correlate with a patient's respiration rate.
- efficiency refers to the duty cycle, the percentage of acceleration cycles used to deliver charged particles to the tumor, and/or the fraction of time that charged particles are delivered to the tumor from the synchrotron.
- the system senses patient respiration and controls timing of negative ion beam formation, injection of charged particles into a synchrotron, acceleration of the charged particles, and/or extraction to yield delivery of the particles to the tumor at a predetermine period of the patient's respiration cycle.
- one or more magnetic fields in the synchrotron 130 are stabilized through use of a feedback loop, which allows rapid changing of energy levels and/or timing of extraction from pulse to pulse. Further, the feedback loop allows control of the acceleration/extraction to correlate with a changing patient respiration rate. Independent control of charged particle energy and intensity is maintained during the timed irradiation therapy. Multi-field irradiation ensures efficient delivery of Bragg peak energy to the tumor while spreading ingress energy about the tumor.
- a sensor such as the first thermal sensor 3670 or the second thermal sensor 3660 , is used to monitor a patient's respiration.
- a controller such as the main controller 110 , then controls charged particle formation and delivery to yield a charged particle beam delivered at a determined point or duration period of the respiration cycle, which ensures precise and accurate delivery of radiation to a tumor that moves during the respiration process.
- Optional charged particle therapy elements controlled by the controller include the injector 120 , accelerator 132 , and/or extraction 134 system.
- Elements optionally controlled in the injector system 120 include: injection of hydrogen gas into a negative ion source 310 , generation of a high energy plasma within the negative ion source, filtering of the high energy plasma with a magnetic field, extracting a negative ion from the negative ion source, focusing the negative ion beam 319 , and/or injecting a resulting positive ion beam 262 into the synchrotron 130 .
- Elements optionally controlled in the accelerator 132 include: accelerator coils, applied magnetic fields in turning magnets, and/or applied current to correction coils in the synchrotron.
- Elements optionally controlled in the extraction system 134 include: radio-frequency fields in an extraction element and/or applied fields in an extraction process.
- the period of delivery of the charged particle to the tumor is adjustable to a varying respiration rate.
- the charged particle beam is delivered to the tumor with each breath of the patient regardless of the patient's changing respiration rate.
- the current is stabilized.
- a problem with current stabilized accelerators is that the magnets used have memories in terms of both magnitude and amplitude of a sine wave.
- the magnetic field controlling the circulation of the charged particles about the synchrotron is stabilized.
- the magnetic field is stabilized through use of: (1) magnetic field sensors 1650 sensing the magnetic field about the circulating charged particles and (2) a feedback loop through a controller or main controller 110 controlling the magnetic field about the circulating charged particles.
- the feedback loop is optionally used as a feedback control to the first winding coil 1250 and the second winding coil 1260 .
- the feedback loop is used to control the correction coils 1510 , 1520 , described supra.
- the frequency and energy level of the synchrotron are rapidly adjustable and the problem is overcome.
- the use of the smaller correction coils 1510 , 1520 allows for rapid adjustment of the accelerator compared to the use of the larger winding coils 1250 , 1260 , described supra.
- the feedback control allows an adjustment of the accelerator energy from pulse to pulse in the synchrotron 130 .
- the first example yielded delivery of the charged particle beam during a particular period of the patient's respiration cycle even if the patient's respiration period is varying.
- the second example used a magnetic field sensor 1650 and a feedback loop to the correction coils 1510 , 1520 to rapidly adjust the energy of the accelerator from pulse to pulse.
- the respiration sensor of the first example is combined with the magnetic field sensor of the second example to control both the timing of the delivery of the charged particle beam from the accelerator and the energy of the charged particle beam from the accelerator. More particularly, the timing of the charged particle delivery is controlled using the respiration sensor, as described supra, and the energy of the charged particle beam is controlled using the magnetic field sensors and feedback loop, as described supra.
- a magnetic field controller such as the main controller 110 , takes the input from the respiration sensor and uses the input as: (1) a feedback control to the magnetic fields controlling the circulating charged particles energy and (2) as a feedback control to time the pulse of the charged particle accelerator to the respiration cycle of the patient.
- This combination allows delivery of the charged particle beam to the tumor with each breath of the patient even if the breathing rate of the patient varies.
- the accelerator efficiency is increased as the cancer therapy system does not need to lose cycles when the patient's breathing is not in phase with the synchrotron charged particle generation rate.
- the main controller 110 controls the injection system 120 , charged particle acceleration system 132 , extraction system 134 , and targeting/delivery system 140 .
- the previously described respiration monitoring system 4610 of the patient interface module 150 is used as an input to a magnetic field controller 4620 .
- a second input to the magnetic field controller 4620 is a magnetic field sensor 1650 .
- the respiration rates from the respiration monitoring system 4610 are fed to the main controller 130 , which controls the injection system 120 and/or components of the acceleration system 132 to yield a charged particle beam at a chosen period of the respiration cycle, as described supra.
- the respiration data from the respiration monitoring system is used as an input to the magnetic field controller 4620 .
- the magnetic field controller also receives feedback input from the magnetic field sensor 1650 .
- the magnetic field controller thus times charged particle energy delivery to correlate with sensed respiration rates and delivers energy levels of the charged particle beam that are rapidly adjustable with each pulse of the accelerator using the feedback loop through the magnetic field sensor 1650 .
- a respiratory sensor 4610 senses the respiration cycle of the patient.
- the respiratory sensor sends the patient's respiration pattern or information to an algorithm in the magnetic field controller 4620 , typically via the patient interface module 150 and/or via the main controller 110 or a subcomponent thereof.
- the algorithm predicts and/or measures when the patient is at a particular point in the respiration cycle, such as at the top or bottom of a breath.
- One or more magnetic field sensors 1650 are used as inputs to the magnetic field controller 4620 , which controls a magnet power supply for a given magnetic, such as within a first turning magnet 1010 of a synchrotron 130 .
- the control feedback loop is thus used to dial the synchrotron to a selected energy level and to deliver protons with the desired energy at a selected point in time, such as at a particular point in the respiration cycle.
- the selected point in the respiration cycle is optionally anywhere in the respiration cycle and/or for any duration during the respiration cycle.
- the selected time period is at the top of a breath for a period of about 0.1, 0.5, 1 seconds.
- the main controller 110 controls injection of hydrogen into the injection system, formation of the negative ion 310 , controls extraction of negative ions from negative ion source 310 , controls injection 120 of protons into the synchrotron 130 , and/or controls acceleration of the protons in a manner that combined with extraction 134 delivers the protons 140 to the tumor at a selected point in the respiration cycle.
- Intensity of the proton beam is also selectable and controllable by the main controller 130 at this stage, as described supra.
- the feedback control from the magnetic field controller 4620 is optionally to a power or power supplies for one or both of the main bending magnet 250 , described supra, or to the correction coils 1520 within the main bending magnet 250 .
- the correction coils 1510 , 1520 are rapidly adjustable to a newly selected acceleration frequency or corresponding charged particle energy level.
- the magnetic field controller 4620 alters the applied fields to the main bending magnets or correction coils that are tied to the patient's respiration cycle. This system is in stark contrast to a system where the current is stabilized and the synchrotron delivers pulses with a fixed period.
- the feedback of the magnetic field design coupled with the correction coils allows for the extraction cycle to match the varying respiratory rate of the patient, such as where a first respiration period 4710 , P 1 , does not equal a second respiration period 4720 , P 2 .
- a main controller receives input from one, two, three, or four of a respiration monitoring and/or controlling controller 4810 , a beam controller 4815 , a rotation controller 4850 , and/or a timing to a time period in a respiration cycle controller 4860 .
- the beam controller 4815 preferably includes one or more or a beam energy controller 4820 , the beam intensity controller 1940 , a beam velocity controller 4830 , and/or a horizontal/vertical beam positioning controller 4840 .
- the main controller 110 controls any element of the injection system 120 ; the synchrotron 130 ; the scanning/targeting/delivery system 140 ; the patient interface module 150 ; the display system 160 ; and/or the imaging system 170 .
- the respiration monitoring/controlling controller 4810 controls any element or method associated with the respiration of the patient; the beam controller 4815 controls any of the elements controlling acceleration and/or extraction of the charged particle beam; the rotation controller 4850 controls any element associated with rotation of the patient 2130 or an element moved by a gantry; and the timing to a period in respiration cycle controller 4860 controls any aspects affecting delivery time of the charged particle beam to the patient.
- the beam controller 4815 optionally controls any magnetic and/or electric field about any magnet in the charged particle cancer therapy system 100 .
- One or more of the patient positioning unit components and/or one of more of the patient positioning constraints are preferably under computer control.
- the computer records or controls the position of the patient positioning elements 3315 , such as via recording a series of motor positions connected to drives that move the patient positioning elements 3315 .
- the patient is initially positioned 4010 and constrained by the patient positioning constraints 3315 .
- the position of each of the patient positioning constraints is recorded and saved by the main controller 110 , by a sub-controller of the main controller 110 , or by a separate computer controller.
- imaging systems are used to locate the tumor 2120 in the patient 2130 while the patient is in the controlled position of final treatment.
- multi-field imaging is performed, as described herein.
- the imaging system 170 includes one or more of: MRI's, X-rays, CT's, proton beam tomography, and the like. Time optionally passes at this point while images from the imaging system 170 are analyzed and a proton therapy treatment plan is devised.
- the patient optionally exits the constraint system during this time period, which may be minutes, hours, or days.
- the computer Upon, and preferably after, return of the patient and initial patient placement into the patient positioning unit, the computer returns the patient positioning constraints to the recorded positions.
- This system allows for rapid repositioning of the patient to the position used during imaging and development of the multi-field charged particle irradiation treatment plan, which minimizes setup time of patient positioning and maximizes time that the charged particle beam system 100 is used for cancer treatment.
- a region of the patient 2130 about the tumor 2120 is reproducibly positioned and immobilized, such as with the motorized patient translation and rotation positioning system 2110 and/or with the patient positioning constraints 3315 .
- the above described positioning systems such as (1) the semi-vertical partial immobilization system 3300 ; (2) the sitting partial immobilization system 3400 ; or (3) the laying positioning system 3500 is used in combination with the patient translation and rotation system 2110 to position the tumor 2120 of the patient 2130 relative to the proton beam path 268 .
- the position and immobilization system controls position of the tumor 2120 relative to the proton beam path 268 , immobilizes position of the tumor 2120 , and facilitates repositioning the tumor 2120 relative to the proton beam path 268 after the patient 2130 has moved away from the proton beam path 268 , such as during development of the irradiation treatment plan 4545 .
- the tumor 2120 of the patient 2130 is positioned in terms of 3-D location and in terms of orientation attitude.
- 3-D location is defined in terms of the x-, y-, and z-axes and orientation attitude is the state of pitch, yaw, and roll.
- Roll is rotation of a plane about the z-axis
- pitch is rotation of a plane about the x-axis
- yaw is the rotation of a plane about the y-axis.
- Tilt is used to describe both roll and pitch.
- the positioning and immobilization system controls the tumor 2120 location relative to the proton beam path 268 in terms of at least three of and preferably in terms of four, five, or six of: pitch, yaw, roll, x-axis location, y-axis location, and z-axis location.
- the patient positioning and immobilization system 4200 is further described using a chair positioning example. For clarity, a case of positioning and immobilizing a tumor in a shoulder is described using chair positioning.
- the patient is generally positioned using the seat support 3320 , knee support 3360 , and/or foot support 3370 .
- a motor in the back support 3330 pushes against the torso of the patient.
- Additional arm support 3350 motors align the arm, such as by pushing with a first force in one direction against the elbow of the patient and the wrist of the patient is positioned using a second force in a counter direction. This restricts movement of the arm, which helps to position the shoulder.
- the head support is positioned to further restrict movement of the shoulder by applying tension to the neck.
- the patient positioning constraints 3315 control position of the tumor 2120 of the patient 2130 in at least three dimensions and preferably control position of the tumor 2120 in terms of all of yaw, roll, and pitch movement as well as in terms of x-, y-, and z-axis position.
- the patient positioning constraints position the tumor 2120 and restricts movement of the tumor, such as by preventing patient slumping.
- sensors in one or more of the patient positioning constraints 3315 record an applied force.
- the seat support senses weight and applies a force to support a fraction of the patient's weight, such as about 50, 60, 70, or 80 percent of the patient's weight.
- a force applied to the neck, arm, and/or leg is recorded.
- the patient positioning and immobilization system 4200 removes movement degrees of freedom from the patient 2130 to accurately and precisely position and control the position of the tumor 2120 relative to the X-ray beam path 3070 , proton beam path 268 , and/or an imaging beam path. Further, once the degrees of freedom are removed, the motor positions for each of the patient positioning constraints are recorded and communicated digitally to the main controller 110 . Once the patient moves from the immobilization system 4200 , such as when the irradiation treatment plan is generated 4550 , the patient 2130 must be accurately repositioned in a patient repositioning system 4500 before the irradiation plan is implemented.
- the patient 2130 sits generally in the positioning device, such as the chair, and the main controller sends the motor position signals and optionally the applied forces back to motors controlling each of the patient positioning constraints 3315 and each of the patient positioning constraints 3315 are automatically moved back to their respective recorded positions.
- the main controller sends the motor position signals and optionally the applied forces back to motors controlling each of the patient positioning constraints 3315 and each of the patient positioning constraints 3315 are automatically moved back to their respective recorded positions.
- re-positioning and re-immobilizing the patient 2130 is accomplished from a time of sitting to fully controlled position in less than about 10, 30, 60, 120, or 600 seconds.
- the patient is re-positioned in the positioning and immobilization system 4500 using the recalled patient positioning constraint 3315 motor positions; the patient 2130 is translated and rotated using the patient translation and rotation system 2120 relative to the proton beam 268 ; and the proton beam 268 is scanned to its momentary beam position 269 by the main controller 110 , which follows the generated irradiation treatment plan 4550 .
- Cancer is typically treated using charged particles to directly ablate the whole tumor.
- cancer is indirectly treated by ablating the periphery of the tumor and/or the healthy tissue proximately contacting the tumor, which reduces/prevents nutrient delivery to the tumor.
- peripheral tumor treatment is further described, infra.
- a tumor sealing system 4900 for treating a tumor 2120 is illustrated using the charged particle beam system 100 .
- the tumor 2120 is illustrated at a first pint in time, t 1 , with an outer periphery 2122 .
- the tumor periphery 2122 is illustrated in two-dimensions as a perimeter of the tumor.
- the periphery includes all of the outer edge/outer surface area of the tumor 2120 and/or the healthy tissue proximately contacting the outer surface of the tumor 2120 .
- the tumor periphery 2122 of the tumor 2120 refers to the outer portions of the tumor proximate healthy tissue and/or portions of the healthy tissue proximately surrounding/contacting the tumor 2120 .
- the tumor treatment is illustrated at a second point in time, t 2 , and third point in time, t 3 , where the charged particle beam system 100 has treated a portion of the tumor periphery 2122 to form a sealing layer 2126 .
- Treatment voxels are preferably: (1) adjacent and/or (2) overlapped, such as to yield an approximately uniform dose as a function of 3-dimensional position about an edge of the tumor 2120 .
- the sealing layer 2126 is a physical barrier to nutrient flow, such as caused by localized heating, scarring, and/or ablation.
- the sealing layer 2126 functions to hinder and/or prevent delivery of nutrients to the tumor 2120 by the body. For example, tumor growth is hindered, retarded, stopped, and/or reversed through lack of nutrients, such as glucose, oxygen, proteins, fats, minerals, and/or vitamins. Similarly, the sealing layer 2126 functions to hinder removal of metabolic waste product(s) from the tumor, such as carbon dioxide and urea.
- the lack of nutrient delivery to the tumor and/or the lack of metabolic waste removal from the tumor causes natural death/necrosis of the tumor and the natural decay and/or release of natural products back into the body that, if passed by the sealing layer 2126 , are recognized and dealt with by the body, such as through the circulatory, lymphatic, digestive, kidney, and/or liver systems.
- the total treated volume of the tumor 2120 treated directly by the charged particle beam system 100 is reduced relative to the total volume of the tumor as preferably only the surface of the tumor 2120 is treated and the internal sections of the tumor 2120 are relatively untreated.
- At least 50, 60, 70, 80, 90, 95, 98, 99 percent of the surface area of the tumor is treated with the charged particle beam of the charged particle therapy system 100 .
- the amount of negative side products resultant from tumor treatment with charged particles is reduced as is treatment time.
- the tail of the Bragg peak is delivered into the tumor, as described supra, and illustrated in FIG. 49B and FIG. 49C .
- a three-dimensional tumor perimeter treatment system 5000 is illustrated, which is an example of the tumor sealing system 4900 .
- the tumor periphery 2122 of the tumor 2120 is illustrated in a partially completed three-dimensional tumor sealing layer 2126 .
- the three-dimensional surface of the tumor 2120 is treated in any order.
- the treatment forms a series of perimeters along an offset-axis to form a series of concentric and/or eccentric treatment perimeters, such as formed through one or more revolutions of the patient support system relative to the beam delivery angle from the gantry, an element held or suspended by the gantry, or nozzle of the charged particle therapy system 100 .
- a layered treatment system 5100 of the tumor is illustrated using the charged particle treatment system 100 .
- treatment of the tumor periphery 2122 of the tumor 2120 is illustrated at a first time, t 1 , and at a second time, t 2 .
- voxels of the tumor 2120 are treated: (1) along a first axis at a first time with movement of the current position of the proton beam 269 relative to the patient 2130 and (2) optionally along a second axis at a second time to form a multiply treated voxel zone 2128 or volume.
- the first and second axis are about perpendicular and/or form an acute angle relative to each other of greater than about 20, 40, 60, 70, 80, or 85 degrees.
- the multiply treated voxel zone 2128 is optionally reinforced with a reinforcement sealing layer, such as illustrated at the third time, t 3 .
- the treatment at the third time treats an inner layer of the tumor 2120 proximate the multiply treated voxel zone 2128 ; however, the reinforcement layer is optionally overlapped with the multiply treated voxel zone 2128 and/or is on any side of the multiple treated voxel zone 2128 , which again if leaks or channels are present, the channels are blocked by the roughly orthogonal treatment layers.
- the periphery of the tumor 2120 is optionally treated by sweeping the current position of the proton beam 269 , or carbon ion beam, across the tumor/healthy tissue boundary, as illustrated at the fifth point in time, t 5 , across the x- and y-axes and at the sixth point in time, t 6 , across the z-axis.
- the tumor/healthy tissue boundary or tumor penumbra is sealed using the charged particle beam system 100 by treating the periphery of the tumor 2120 of the patient 2130 with one or more overlapped, inter-stitched, interwoven, and/or adjacent sets of tissue volume or tissue voxels to hinder nutrient delivery to the tumor 2120 and/or waste product removal from the tumor 2120 .
- inner volumes of the tumor 2120 are not treated with the charged particle therapy system 100 and/or are treated with a dosage less than 100 percent of full treatment dosage, such as less than 80, 60, 40, or 20 percent of full dosage.
- the tumor 2120 is optionally retreated, as needed, to treat tumor growths through the tumor sealing layer 2126 and/or new tumor growth.
- a fast magnet 5210 is illustrated as part of the charged particle beam system 110 .
- the fast magnet 5210 is any magnet where a current, such as in a winding coil about the magnet, is rapidly changed.
- the rapid change in current results in a rapid change in a magnetic field, such as a magnetic field passing through a charged particle beam path anywhere in the charged particle beam system 110 .
- the change in magnetic field redirects the charged particles, such as away from the patient 2130 to a charged particle beam stop 5212 .
- the fast magnet 5210 is a separate magnet about the beam path in the beam line (1) after the first Lambertson extraction magnet 292 between two turning magnets 1010 , 1040 , and (2) prior to a second Lambertson extraction magnet 293 , where the two Lambertson extraction magnets 292 , 293 move the charged particle beam from a circulating beam plane 267 to an about parallel second plane along the beam transport path 268 .
- the inventor has determined that placing the fast magnet 5210 between the two planes is preferable to reduce divergence of the charged particle beam.
- the fast magnet 5210 is optionally positioned anywhere in the charged particle beam system 110 , such as within the synchrotron 130 or in one or more beam transport lines and/or beamline arc 5340 line(s) from the synchrotron to the patient 2130 .
- the rapid change in current is applied to any coil or inductor described herein and/or is applied to an additional safety coil wrapped about any magnet core described herein as any part of the charge particle beam system 110 .
- the charged particle beam is redirected from the patient 2130 very rapidly, such as in less than about 25, 50, 100, 200, 500, 750, 1,000, or 5,000 microseconds.
- the charged particle beam is redirected, through use of the main controller 110 , on a time scale between delivery of individual pulses of the charged particle beam, on a time scale between treatment of individual tumor voxels, and/or on a time scale of a flinch of the patient 2130 .
- Two exemplary methods for rapidly altering current in the coil are described, infra.
- the second Lambertson extraction magnet redirects the charged particle beam in the beam transport path 268 along a horizontal plane 5320 at the base of a beamline arc 5340 .
- FIG. 52B and FIG. 52C a first method of rapidly increasing current to a coil of the fast magnet 5210 is presented.
- a low voltage system 5220 is illustrated.
- FIG. 52B illustrates that as voltage is increased, the current increases, as potential is related to current and resistance.
- FIG. 52B illustrates that a time to increase the current is substantial with low applied voltages 5222 and that reaching a threshold current sufficient to, through change in the magnetic field, redirect the charged particle beam away from the patient 2130 may take considerable time, such as much more than 50 microseconds.
- FIG. 52C a high voltage power system 5230 is illustrated.
- a time to increase the current to the threshold current using the high applied voltage 5232 is considerably faster, such as within 50 microseconds.
- the inventor has discovered, to achieve the faster solution a separate power supply is required.
- a pulse to the separate power supply such as to greater than 100, 200, 300, or 400 volts, and preferably to 500 volts, the corresponding current rises rapidly to the threshold, such as within 50 microseconds.
- a separate magnet about the beam path controlled with a separate current supplied by a separate high voltage power supply to a separate coil about the core of the separate magnet is preferred.
- FIG. 52D and FIG. 52E a second method of rapidly decreasing current to a coil of the fast magnet 5210 is presented.
- a current control circuit 5240 is illustrated.
- the inductor 5242 or coil is electrically connected to a resistor 5244 and switch 5246 , where the resistor 5244 and switch 5246 are wired electrically in parallel at a first point in time.
- a decreasing current system 5248 is illustrated. In the decreasing voltage system 5248 , at a first point in time a voltage and current, such as a steady state current and voltage, are applied to the inductor 5242 .
- the current applied to the inductor is rapidly reduced as the current must now run through the resistor 5244 , which is optionally a large resistor, such as greater than about 0.05, 0.1, 0.2, 0.4, or 0.6 Ohms.
- the power supply is of fixed polarity, and/or resistors are used with an applied negative voltage system.
- the charged particle beam is redirected by changing the applied current to the magnet, which alters the magnetic field and hence charged particle beam path, through use of the main controller 110 , as described supra.
- Targeting the tumor 2120 of the patient 2130 optionally uses beam control of one or more of: x-, y-axes position, energy, and intensity control. Additionally, targeting the tumor 2120 of the patient 2130 optionally controls timing of the beam relative to patient translation and/or rotation position and/or relative to physiological movement of the patient, such as flinching and/or respiration.
- a new combination of beam/patient control is presented to target the tumor 2120 in 2.5 or 3-dimensions. Examples presented herein use a dual rotation system 5360 for positioning of the patient 2130 and an optional rotatable targeting magnet system 5300 . For clarity of presentation, non-limiting examples are provided, infra, to illustrate the combined rotatable targeting magnet system 5300 and the dual rotation system 5360 of the patient.
- the charged particle beam system 100 contains a beamline that transports the charged particles from the accelerator, such as the synchrotron 130 , to the tumor 2120 of the patient 2130 .
- the beamline contains a beamline arc 5340 that arcs above and/or above and to the side of a horizontal plane 5320 at the base of a beamline arc 5340 .
- the beamline arc 5340 generally contains turning or bending magnets used to direct the charged particle beam first up and/or away from the horizontal plane 5320 and then down and/or toward the patient 2130 .
- the beamline arc 5340 terminates along a downward z-axis axis with two magnets: an x-axis scanning magnet and a y-axis scanning magnet. Scanning both the x-axis scanning magnet and the y-axis scanning magnet allows scanning of the proton beam along an x/y plane.
- an optional rotatable targeting magnet 5310 replaces one and preferably both of the x-axis scanning magnet and the y-axis scanning magnet at a termination of the beamline arc 5340 .
- Replacement of the x-axis scanning magnet and/or the y-axis scanning magnet has multiple benefits, including:
- a first benefit is weight reduction.
- many tons of magnets in the beamline arc 5340 such as 25, 50, 75, or 100 tons, need be supported by a beamline gantry.
- the extreme weight introduces binding errors in re-positioning/movement of the beamline arc 5340 , that is significantly reduced with reduction of beamline arc weight, such as by removal of the x-axis scanning magnet and/or the y-axis scanning magnet.
- a second benefit is that termination of the beamline arc 5340 before a terminal vertical orientation allows coupling with the dual rotation system 5360 of the patient 2130 and allows tumor treatment from multiple incident angles through the patient 2130 with simple rotation of the patient 2130 using a first patient rotation platform 2113 rotating, translating, and/or moving around the rotatable targeting magnet 5310 and/or use of a second patient rotation platform 2115 mounted on the first patient rotation platform 2113 , as described supra, where the first patient rotation platform 2113 and second patient rotation platform 2115 are optionally sub-units of the patient positioning system 2110 .
- a third benefit is that the rotatable targeting magnet 5310 design allows closer positioning of the patient 2130 to the end of the beamline arc 5340 , which reduced beam spread, ⁇ . Referring now to FIG.
- a physics limitation of a charged particle beam is beam spread, ⁇ .
- the patient position is optionally maintained on the first patient rotation platform 2113 at a fixed distance from the rotatable targeting magnet 5310 as the beamline arc 5340 is repositioned. Accordingly, the patient/beamline arc termination distance, distance 1, using the rotatable targeting magnet 5310 is less than prior art patient/beamline arc termination distance, distance 2, where the x- and y-axes scanning magnets must be moved with movement of the beamline arc 5340 forcing repositioning the patient 2130 with different beamline arc positions. The forced repositioning of the patient with beamline arc changes causes distance 2 to be greater than distance 1.
- the smaller distance 1 which is optionally a constant and hence an accurate, precise, and reproducible distance, results in a smaller beam spread, ⁇ 1 compared to the physics based necessarily larger beam spread, ⁇ 2 , using the traditional x- and y-scanning magnets.
- the constant distance 1 removes re-positioning error inherent in movement of the patient relative to the termination of the beamline arc using a traditional patient “couch”.
- a third benefit of termination of the beamline arc 5340 at least 10, 20, 22.5, 30, 40, or 45 degrees before arcing down to a vertical beam is the reduction in the number of beamline turning magnets as the beamline arc 5340 need not turn the beam ninety degrees, but need only turn the beam a smaller amount, such as 45 degrees relying on the rotatable targeting magnet for directing the beam the last 0 to 45 degrees.
- a traditional arc may use nine turning magnets, while termination of the arc at less than 90 degrees or before vertical allows fewer turning magnets in the arc, such as seven turning magnets.
- the dual rotation system 5360 an illustrative and non-limiting example of the dual rotation system 5360 is provided.
- the patient 2130 is rotated on the first patient rotation platform 2113 .
- the entire person rotates around a central region where the rotatable targeting magnet 5310 rotates and/or moves.
- the patient 2130 is orientated on the sitting partial immobilization system 3400 , but is optionally laying or in any position.
- the patient 2130 is rotated on a path around the rotatable targeting magnet, is rotated in place, or is rotated “in place” while translating along the circular path, which is a combination of the first and second case.
- the charged particle beam is optionally scanned along any vector, such as a single vector, horizontally, or preferably vertically, by varying the current in the rotatable targeting magnet 5310 and the charged particle beam is rotated across the tumor by physical rotation of the rotatable targeting magnet, rotation of the patient 2130 on the first patient rotation platform 2113 , rotation of the patient on the second patient rotation platform 2115 , or through rotation of the patient relative to the charged particle beam through rotation of two or all of the rotatable targeting magnet 5310 , the first patient rotation platform 2113 , and the second patient rotation platform 2115 .
- any vector such as a single vector, horizontally, or preferably vertically
- the patient rotates in a circular path on the first patient rotation platform 2113 .
- the patient 2130 would also be facing the center of the first patient rotation platform 2113 as a function of rotations, such as at the 3, 6, and 9 o'clock positions.
- the momentary beam 269 would always enter the same side of the patient 2130 in route to the tumor 2120 .
- the tumor 2120 is treated vertically through changing current to the rotatable targeting magnet and is treated horizontally through mechanical movement of one or both of the rotatable targeting magnet 5310 and the first patient rotation platform 2113 .
- the patient 2130 rotates in place on the second patient rotation platform 2115 without movement of the first patient rotation platform 2113 .
- the rotatable targeting magnet 5310 mechanically moves axially across the tumor 2120 of the patient 2130 , such as in the x/y plane, by rotating a few degrees across the tumor while variations of current provided to the rotatable targeting magnet target the tumor in various z-axis positions.
- the rotation of the patient 2130 on the second patient rotation platform distributes trailing edges of the Bragg peak curve around the tumor, reducing effects of the charged particles on healthy tissue of the patient 2130 .
- the patient 2130 rotates on a path, such as a circular path, on the first patient rotation platform 2113 around the rotatable targeting magnet 5310 while also rotating on the second patient rotation platform 2115 , simultaneously or not, “in-place” on a given position of the first patient rotation platform 2113 .
- the second patient rotation platform 2115 not illustrated, resides under the patient 2130 .
- the ventral, V e , sinister side, S i , dorsal side, D o , and dexter side, D e , of the patient are sequentially in the charged particle beam path; as illustrated at the 6, 3, 12, and 9 o'clock positions respectively, which distributes the charged particle beam tail energy about the tumor.
- the patient 2130 is illustrated at two opposite clock positions at a first time, t 1 , and second time, t 2 , respectively.
- the illustrated case shows the dorsal, Do, side of the tumor 2120 toward the charged particle beam at the first time and the ventral, Ve, side of the patient toward the charged particle beam at the second time.
- FIG. 53D illustrates the two-dimensional slice: (1) at a given rotation point along a rotation plane, defined by two x-axis rotation times/positions, (2) with delivery of the charged particle beam depth into the tumor 2120 along the z-axis through variation of beam energy, and (3) with vertical scanning of the tumor 2120 , through variation of applied current to the rotatable turning magnet 5310 , moving the charged particle beam along the y-axis.
- FIG. 53E yet another representation of the tumor 2120 moving around the rotatable targeting magnet 5310 on the first patient rotation platform 2113 while also rotating on the second patient rotation platform 2115 is provided.
- the representation is from the point of view of the tumor 2120 .
- the ventral side of the tumor 2120 is treated, as represent by along a first x/y-plane (x 1 , y 1 ), and with a first variation in charged particle beam energy, z 1 .
- a vertical plane of the tumor 2120 would treated at the first time.
- the x/y plane at the first time is used to represent, with the expanding ovals, that with the addition of a second scanning magnet, such as an x-axis scanning magnet and/or a y-axis scanning magnet, more than one plane is optionally scanned at a first rotation position.
- a first single treatment plane of the tumor 2120 is treated at the first rotation position, represented at the first time and a second single treatment plane of the tumor 2120 is treated at the second rotation position at a second time.
- the ventral, dexter, dorsal, and sinister side entry points of the patient 2130 or tumor 2120 are treated at four times, t 1 , t 2 , t 3 , t 4 , with individual treatment planes, that optionally overlap, to form a three-dimensional treatment volume with n rotation points of the patient 2130 .
- treatment of the tumor 2120 occurs at n times and/or at n rotational positions, where n is a positive integer equal to or greater than 2, 3, 5, 10, 25, 50, or 100, to treat a three-dimensional volume with the charged particles.
- the first patient rotation platform 2113 need not be a complete disk, but instead need only hold the patient 2130 , such as on a platform translatable in an arc, perimeter, or geometric path about the rotatable targeting magnet.
- the patient 2130 is optionally held on the patient positioning system 2110 .
- the rotatable targeting magnet 5310 is further described herein.
- the rotatable targeting magnet 5310 includes a core 5312 about a gap through which the charged particle beam passes.
- One or more coils 5315 wrap around the core.
- Application of a current through the coil 5315 induces and/or changes a magnetic field crossing the gap.
- Driving the current one way or another, such as positive or negative, alters strength and/or direction of the magnetic field, which redirects the momentary beam position 269 .
- the current switches to a positive current to move the beam more than 10, 20, 22.5, 30, 40, or 45 degrees in one direction and to a negative (reverse) current to move the beam more than 10, 20, 22.5, 30, 40, or 45 degrees in the opposite direction.
- the charged particle beam is directed up and down for a given position of the patient 2130 and tumor 2120 on the first and/or second patient rotation platforms 2113 , 2115 .
- the rotatable targeting magnet 5310 rotates about an axis separate from a plane defined by the beamline arc 5340 or movement of the beamline arc 5340 .
- the rotatable targeting magnet 5310 is optionally supported on an independent gantry from the beamline gantry and/or is supported from above, such as from a ceiling mount.
- the rotatable targeting magnet 5310 preferably:
- the rotatable targeting magnet is not attached to the end of the beamline arc 5340 .
- the patient 2130 As the patient 2130 rotates on the first patient rotation platform 2113 , the patient 2130 is simultaneously additionally rotated on the second patient rotation platform 2115 .
- the dual rotation allows different sides of the patient to face the charged particle beam directed by the rotatable targeting magnet 5310 as a function of time.
- the dorsal side, Do of the patient 2130 is illustrated toward the center of the first patient rotation platform 2113 at a first point in time, t 1
- the dorsal side of the patient is illustrated toward the outer edge of the first patient rotation platform 2113 after rotation of the first patient rotation platform through 180 degrees at a second point in time, t 2 .
- ventral side, Ve of the patient 2130 is respectively illustrated away from and toward the center of the first patient rotation platform 2113 at the first and second times, t 1 , t 2 .
- a sinister side of the patient is toward the center of the first patient rotation platform 2113 at a first point in time, t 1
- a dexter side of the patient is toward the center of the first rotation platform 2113 after 180 degrees of rotation of the first rotation platform 2113 at a second point in time, t 2 .
- the patient 2130 is tilted during and/or between treatment of one or more tissue voxels.
- tilt refers to rotation of the patient 2130 about a longitudinal axis of the body of the patient 2130 , such as about a horizontal axis or an axis within 5, 10, 15, 20, or 25 degrees of horizontal.
- the patient is optionally in any orientation, such as vertical, sitting, and/or semi-vertical, more generally tilt refers to rotation of the patient about any one or more axes.
- a patient side/back support system 5400 is figuratively illustrated, which is an example of the back support 3330 and/or an example of the laying positioning system 3500 .
- a side/back support 5410 comprises a backside support 5410 and a side support 5412 .
- the backside support 5410 continues, directly and/or indirectly, from the back of the patient 2130 around at least a portion of a side of the patient 2130 .
- the side support 5412 constrains radial movement of the patient 2130 and when the patient is tilted, constrains sliding of the patient 2130 on the backside support 5410 , as illustrated in FIG. 54C .
- the backside support 5410 is optionally expanded or contracted along the y-axis or radial axis of the patient 2130 to fit the patient 2130 , such as in a manner described for the back support 3330 supra.
- the patient 2130 is illustrated as laying on the laying positioning system 3500 .
- the laying positioning system 3500 incorporates the patient side/back support system 5400 .
- the laying positioning system 3500 provides a support for the patient side/back support system 5400 .
- the patient side/back support system 5400 is used in place of the laying positioning system 3500 .
- the momentary charged particle path 269 is used to treat one or more voxels of the tumor 2120 of the patient 2130 at various points in time.
- the patient 2139 is rotated about a vertical axis as a function of time.
- the momentary charged particle beam 269 at a first point in time, t 1 comes down to the tumor, along an incident angle relative to the longitudinal axis of the patient, over a first portion of the patient, such as over the patient's head.
- the patient 2130 is rotated, such as about the vertical axis through an angle, + ⁇ , and the incident angle comes down to the tumor 2120 over a second portion of the patient, such as the patient's right shoulder.
- the patient 2130 is rotated, such as about the vertical axis through an angle, ⁇ , and the incident angle comes down to the tumor over a third portion of the patient, such as the patient's left shoulder.
- the momentary charged particle beam 269 comes at an angle down to the tumor of the patient and the charged particles enter the patient from a variety of angles through the tissue.
- the charged particles optionally enters the patient 2130 toward and/or near the about ventral, about dexter, about dorsal, or about ventral side of the patient with a vector toward the tumor.
- the charged particle beam optionally enter the patient from various angles relative to a horizontal axis and for any given fixed incident angle, the charged particles enter the patient through series of angles forming a cone with rotation of the patient 2130 about a vertical axis.
- the momentary charged particle beam position 269 enters the patient from a variety of angles, such as forming an expanding cone as a function of rotation of the patient for a given scanning angle; the given scanning angle formed by the rotatable targeting magnet 5310 or the first and second axis control 142 , 144 .
- the patient 2130 is optionally tilted, such as relative to a horizontal axis. As illustrated, the patient is tilted through an angle gamma, y, such as from 0 to ⁇ 15 degrees relative to the horizontal plane at less than 0.2, 0.4, 0.6, 0.8, 1, 2, or 3 degree step intervals.
- the side support 5412 which is optionally formed to the individual user, is used to constrain radial movement of the patient. Particularly, a left side support is optionally formed to any portion of the patient's left side, left torso, and/or left leg and a right side support is optionally formed to any portion of the patient's right side, right torso, and/or right leg.
- the left and right side supports are asymmetrical, such as where one of the supports is preformed to a side of a partial or total amputee.
- the side support 5412 is integrated with the backside support 5410 and/or is connected to the backside support with a curved inner radius to fit the rounded joining of a backside and side of a patient or a particular shape of a patient.
- the side supports 5412 are optionally pro-molded to the patient and/or are formed out of generally incompressible material under standard gravitational forces of a tilted patient.
- the patient is horizontal at the first time, t 1 , described in the preceding paragraph and is tilted to the patient's left and right, + ⁇ and ⁇ respectively, at the first rotation time, t 1 , before rotation of the patient through angle ⁇ .
- any angle (A) of (1) rotation, ⁇ , and (2) tilt, ⁇ are used with any (3) momentary charged particle beam 269 treatment angle directed by the rotatable targeting magnet 5310 , the first axis control 142 , and/or the second axis control 144 in combination with (B) any orientation of the patient 2130 on the first patient rotation platform 2113 to yield set of a 2.5 or 3-dimensional incident treatment angles of the charged particle beam into the patient 2130 and/or into the tumor 2120 , as illustrated in FIG. 54D at six treatment times of n treatment times where n is a positive number.
- a gantry is used to support, hold, and/or move any element of the beamline between the accelerator, such as the synchrotron, and the patient 2130 .
- the gantry is used to support, hold momentarily in position, and reposition an end of the beamline arc 5340 , an output nozzle, or final element(s) of the beamline to aim and/or orient the momentary charged particle path 269 at a voxel of the tumor 2120 of the patient 2130 .
- the gantry optionally suspends at least a portion of the beamline arc 5340 and/or supports a portion of the beamline arc 5340 .
- the gantry re-orientates at least one magnet of the beamline arc 5340 , where the reorientation is used as a part of targeting the tumor of the patient.
- an X-ray imaging system 5500 which is an example of the imaging system 170 , that co-moves: (1) the imaging system imaging beam or beams, such as an X-ray beam, and (2) a positively charged particle beam, such as from the synchrotron and guided using a beamline, such as the beamline arc 5340 , or gantry, is provided.
- the imaging system imaging beam or beams such as an X-ray beam
- a positively charged particle beam such as from the synchrotron and guided using a beamline, such as the beamline arc 5340 , or gantry
- the alignment is optionally performed using software aligning at least a portion of an image with at least a position of one or more reference images.
- a physical connection is used to connect at least a part of the imaging system 170 and part of the beamline from the accelerator to the patient and/or beamline arc 5340 .
- the physical connection which preferably controls co-movement of: (1) the X-ray beam or imaging beam and (2) the positively charged particle beam, maintains alignment of the imaging beam and positively charged particle beam, such that the same voxel or volume of the tumor is imaged, provided to the main controller 110 , and/or treated by the charged particle beam system 100 .
- Two non-limiting examples are provided, infra, to further illustrate the imaging system 170 . While a non-limiting X-ray system for imaging is illustrated in the examples, generally the imaging system 170 uses any form or forms of electromagnetic radiation and/or a positively or negatively charged particle.
- an X-ray source 5510 is physically affixed using an imaging system mount 5520 to at least one of the beamline, the beamline arc 5340 , a terminal magnet of the beamline, the nozzle 2010 , the first or second axis control 142 , 144 , and/or the rotatable alignment magnet 5510 .
- the imaging system mount 5520 aligns one or more of: the imaging system 170 , an element of the imaging system, the X-ray source 5510 , and/or an element, magnet, and/or alignment element of the X-ray source with any one or more elements of: the beamline, the beamline arc 5340 , the nozzle 2010 , the first axis control 142 , the second axis control 144 , and/or the gantry used to move any element of the beamline, the beamline arc 5340 , the nozzle 2010 , the first axis control 142 , and/or the second axis control 144 .
- an X-ray detector 5530 a digital X-ray detector, and/or an X-ray film in the form of a linear X-ray detector 5552 or preferably a two-dimensional array of X-ray detectors detects X-rays from the X-ray source 5510 , such as after passing through the tumor 2120 .
- the X-ray detector is rotatable about the X-ray beam 5512 , about an axis aligned with the momentary proton beam position 269 , and/or about a fixed point in space, which yields a set of x-vectors, x 1 , x 2 , . . .
- the charged particle beam or momentary proton beam position 269 is scanned along an axis, such as a vertical axis or an axis perpendicular to the x-axis, y n .
- a final guiding element 5342 of the beamline where the final guiding element 5342 is proximate a final element of the beamline, such as an exit foil, vacuum barrier element, or axial beamline element, is used to form the final momentary beam position 269 of the positively charged particle beam, such as from the synchrotron 130 , and to direct the charged particle beam to a voxel of the tumor 2120 .
- a final element of the beamline such as an exit foil, vacuum barrier element, or axial beamline element
- the X-ray source 5510 generates an X-ray beam 5512 and directs the X-ray beam 5512 through the tumor 5512 , where the X-ray beam 5510 is detected by the X-ray detector 5530 .
- the X-ray beam 5342 is at least about parallel to the momentary beam position 269 and preferably is less than 3, 2, 1, or 0.5 millimeters from an axial center of the momentary beam position 269 . More preferably, a radial cross-section of the X-ray beam overlaps at least a portion of the momentary beam position 269 of the charged particle beam along the final beam path from the beamline 2340 to the tumor 2120 and/or within an imaged voxel of the tumor 2120 .
- the X-ray beam 5512 passes through the final guiding element 5342 of the beamline, such as through a hole in the metal core of the final magnet, between windings about at least a portion of the final magnet, through an aperture or central aperture, such as the gap 1110 of the final magnet, and/or through a housing of the final magnet.
- the X-ray beam source 5510 is affixed and/or integrated into the final guiding element 5342 .
- the X-ray beam source is rigidly attached, directly or indirectly, to the final guiding element 5342 .
- a third example is provided of a source element 172 of the imaging system 170 that is fixed in position by the imaging system mount 5520 to one or more elements held, guided, and/or repositioned by the gantry, such as any element of the beam line arc 5340 .
- the second axis control 144 element directs the momentary beam position 269 of the positively charged particle beam.
- any beam guiding or scanning element is optionally used in place of the second axis control 144 .
- An imaging detector 174 such as a digital imaging detector, an X-ray film, a tomography detector, a proton detector, a cation detector, and/or a C 6+ detector is used to detect electromagnetic energy or particles from the imaging system 170 .
- the imaging source is held away from the element being positioned by the gantry, but the imaging source moves with the element as the element is repositioned and/or positioned using the gantry.
- the X-ray detector 5530 is always on the opposite side of the patient 2130 from the X-ray source 5510 .
- the resultant signal is optionally used to form a 3-dimensional image of a section of the patient 2130 and/or the tumor 2120 , as in a corner beam CT.
- the physical connection and/or imaging system mount 5520 semi-permanently used to maintain alignment, excepting initial alignment and/or dynamic control elements, of an imaging beam originating in the imaging source with the positively charged particles exiting the beamline is optionally: (1) integrated into any element held and moved by the gantry, (2) is semi-integrated into any element held and moved by the gantry, and/or (3) is rigidly aligned using the imaging system mount to any element held and moved by the gantry.
- the rigid/fixed alignment of the imaging and treatment beams preferably controls co-movement, co-translation, and/or co-rotation of: (1) the X-ray beam or imaging beam and the positively charged particle beam, such that the same voxel or volume of the tumor is imaged and/or treated by the charged particle beam system 100 .
- the charged particle tomography apparatus is used to image a tumor in a patient.
- the charged particle tomography apparatus is used in combination with a charged particle cancer therapy system using common elements.
- tomographic imaging of a cancerous tumor is performed using charged particles generated with an injector, accelerator, and guided with a delivery system that are part of the cancer therapy system, described supra.
- the tomography imaging system is optionally simultaneously operational with a charged particle cancer therapy system using common elements, allows tomographic imaging with rotation of the patient, is operational on a patient in an upright, semi-upright, and/or horizontal position, is simultaneously operational with X-ray imaging, and/or allows use of adaptive charged particle cancer therapy.
- the common tomography and cancer therapy apparatus elements are optionally operational in a multi-axis and/or multi-field raster beam mode.
- the radiation source is a charged particle, such as a proton ion beam or a carbon ion beam.
- a proton beam is used herein to describe the tomography system, but the description applies to a heavier ion beam, such as a carbon ion beam.
- the radiation source is preferably stationary while the patient is rotated.
- the tomography system 5600 uses elements in common with the charged particle beam system 100 , including elements of one or more of the injection system 120 , accelerator or synchrotron 130 , targeting/delivery system 140 , patient interface module 150 , display system 160 , and/or imaging system 170 , such as the X-ray imaging system.
- a scintillation plate 5610 such as a scintillating plastic is positioned behind the patient 2130 relative to the targeting/delivery system 140 elements.
- the charged particle beam system 100 as described has proven operation at up to and including 330 MeV, which is sufficient to send protons through the body and into contact with the scintillation material.
- the intensity or count of protons hitting the plate as a function of position is used to create an image.
- the patient 2130 is rotated 2117 about the y-axis and a new image is collected.
- a new image is collected with about every one degree of rotation of the patient resulting in about 360 images that are combined into a tomogram using tomographic reconstruction software.
- the tomographic reconstruction software uses overlapping rotationally varied images in the reconstruction.
- a new image is collected at about every 2, 3, 4, 5, 10, 15, 30, or 45 degrees of rotation of the patient.
- a tomogram or an individual tomogram section image is collected at about the same time as cancer therapy occurs using the charged particle beam system.
- an tomogram is collected and cancer therapy is subsequently performed: without the patient moving from the positioning systems, such as the above described semi-vertical partial immobilization system 3300 , the sitting partial immobilization system 3400 , or the a laying positioning system 3500 .
- an individual tomogram slice is collected using a first cycle of the accelerator or synchrotron 130 and using a following cycle of the accelerator or synchrotron 130 , the tumor 2120 is irradiated, such as within about 1, 2, 5, 10, 15 or 30 seconds.
- about 2, 3, 4, or 5 tomogram slices are collected using 1, 2, 3, 4, or more rotation positions of the patient 2130 within about 5, 10, 15, 30, or 60 seconds of subsequent tumor irradiation therapy.
- the independent control of the tomographic imaging process and X-ray collection process allows simultaneous single and/or multi-field collection of X-ray images and tomographic images easing interpretation of multiple images.
- the X-ray and tomographic images are optionally overlaid to from a hybrid X-ray/proton beam tomographic image as the patient is optionally in the same position for each image.
- the tomogram is collected with the patient 2130 in the about the same position as when the patient's tumor is treated using subsequent irradiation therapy.
- the patient being positioned in the same upright or semi-upright position allows the tumor 2120 to be separated from surrounding organs or tissue of the patient 2130 better than in a laying position.
- Positioning of the scintillation plate 5610 behind the patient 2130 allows the tomographic imaging to occur while the patient is in the same upright or semi-upright position.
- tomographic imaging uses common elements in the tomographic imaging and in the charged particle cancer therapy to optionally be used with the tomographic imaging, such as proton beam x-axis control, proton beam y-axis control, control of proton beam energy, control of proton beam intensity, timing control of beam delivery to the patient, rotation control of the patient, and control of patient translation all in a raster beam mode of proton energy delivery.
- benefits of the cancer therapy described supra, to optionally be used with the tomographic imaging, such as proton beam x-axis control, proton beam y-axis control, control of proton beam energy, control of proton beam intensity, timing control of beam delivery to the patient, rotation control of the patient, and control of patient translation all in a raster beam mode of proton energy delivery.
- a three-dimensional tomographic proton based reference image is collected, such as with hundreds of individual rotation images of the tumor 2120 and patient 2130 .
- just a few 2-dimensional control tomographic images of the patient are collected, such as with a stationary patient or at just a few rotation positions, such as an image straight on to the patient, with the patient rotated about 45 degrees each way, and/or the patient rotated about 90 degrees each way about the y-axis.
- the individual control images are compared with the 3-dimensional reference image.
- An adaptive proton therapy is subsequently performed where: (1) the proton cancer therapy is not used for a given position based on the differences between the 3-dimensional reference image and one or more of the 2-dimensional control images and/or (2) the proton cancer therapy is modified in real time based on the differences between the 3-dimensional reference image and one or more of the 2-dimensional control images
- Still yet another embodiment includes any combination and/or permutation of any of the elements described herein.
- the terms “comprises”, “comprising”, or any variation thereof, are intended to reference a non-exclusive inclusion, such that a process, method, article, composition or apparatus that comprises a list of elements does not include only those elements recited, but may also include other elements not expressly listed or inherent to such process, method, article, composition or apparatus.
- Other combinations and/or modifications of the above-described structures, arrangements, applications, proportions, elements, materials or components used in the practice of the present invention, in addition to those not specifically recited, may be varied or otherwise particularly adapted to specific environments, manufacturing specifications, design parameters or other operating requirements without departing from the general principles of the same.
Landscapes
- Health & Medical Sciences (AREA)
- Engineering & Computer Science (AREA)
- Biomedical Technology (AREA)
- Pathology (AREA)
- Nuclear Medicine, Radiotherapy & Molecular Imaging (AREA)
- Radiology & Medical Imaging (AREA)
- Life Sciences & Earth Sciences (AREA)
- Animal Behavior & Ethology (AREA)
- General Health & Medical Sciences (AREA)
- Public Health (AREA)
- Veterinary Medicine (AREA)
- Radiation-Therapy Devices (AREA)
Abstract
A patient positioning/constraint apparatus and method of use thereof is described in combination with a charged particle cancer therapy system. In one embodiment, a patient is tilted about a longitudinal axis, such as rotation about a head-to-foot axis of the patient where the head-to-foot axis of the patient is horizontal. Optional side support constraints are optionally used to constrain radial movement of the patient on the tilted patient support. The side support constraints are optionally pre-formed to or coupled to a radially outer shape of an individual patient, such as the dexter or sinister side of the individual's head, arm, torso, hip, and/or leg. Patient tilt is optionally combined with rotation of the patient about a vertical axis, rotation of the entire patient about an axis not overlapped by the patient, and/or dynamic control of angles of incident charged particles directed by beamline magnets of the charged particle therapy system.
Description
- This application is a continuation of U.S. patent application Ser. No. 14/293,861, filed Jun. 2, 2014, which is a continuation-in-part of U.S. patent application Ser. No. 14/216,788 filed Mar. 17, 2014, which
- is a continuation-in-part of U.S. patent application Ser. No. 13/572,542 filed Aug. 10, 2012, which is a continuation-in-part of U.S. patent application Ser. No. 12/425,683 filed Apr. 17, 2009, which claims the benefit of:
-
- U.S. provisional patent application No. 61/055,395 filed May 22, 2008, now U.S. Pat. No. 7,939,809 B2;
- U.S. provisional patent application No. 61/137,574 filed Aug. 1, 2008;
- U.S. provisional patent application No. 61/192,245 filed Sep. 17, 2008;
- U.S. provisional patent application No. 61/055,409 filed May 22, 2008;
- U.S. provisional patent application No. 61/203,308 filed Dec. 22, 2008;
- U.S. provisional patent application No. 61/188,407 filed Aug. 11, 2008;
- U.S. provisional patent application No. 61/188,406 filed Aug. 11, 2008;
- U.S. provisional patent application No. 61/189,815 filed Aug. 25, 2008;
- U.S. provisional patent application No. 61/201,731 filed Dec. 15, 2008;
- U.S. provisional patent application No. 61/205,362 filed Jan. 12, 2009;
- U.S. provisional patent application No. 61/134,717 filed Jul. 14, 2008;
- U.S. provisional patent application No. 61/134,707 filed Jul. 14, 2008, now U.S. Pat. No. 7,940,894 B2;
- U.S. provisional patent application No. 61/201,732 filed Dec. 15, 2008, now U.S. Pat. No. 7,953,205 B2;
- U.S. provisional patent application No. 61/198,509 filed Nov. 7, 2008;
- U.S. provisional patent application No. 61/134,718 filed Jul. 14, 2008;
- U.S. provisional patent application No. 61/190,613 filed Sep. 2, 2008;
- U.S. provisional patent application No. 61/191,043 filed Sep. 8, 2008;
- U.S. provisional patent application No. 61/192,237 filed Sep. 17, 2008;
- U.S. provisional patent application No. 61/201,728 filed Dec. 15, 2008;
- U.S. provisional patent application No. 61/190,546 filed Sep. 2, 2008;
- U.S. provisional patent application No. 61/189,017 filed Aug. 15, 2008;
- U.S. provisional patent application No. 61/198,248 filed Nov. 5, 2008, now U.S. Pat. No. 7,943,913 B2;
- U.S. provisional patent application No. 61/198,508 filed Nov. 7, 2008;
- U.S. provisional patent application No. 61/197,971 filed Nov. 3, 2008;
- U.S. provisional patent application No. 61/199,405 filed Nov. 17, 2008;
- U.S. provisional patent application No. 61/199,403 filed Nov. 17, 2008; and
- U.S. provisional patent application No. 61/199,404 filed Nov. 17, 2008;
- is a continuation-in-part of U.S. patent application Ser. No. 12/687,387 filed Jan. 14, 2010, which
-
- is a continuation-in-part of U.S. patent application Ser. No. 12/425,683 filed Apr. 17, 2009;
- claims the benefit of U.S. provisional patent application No. 61/209,529 filed Mar. 9, 2009;
- claims the benefit of U.S. provisional patent application No. 61/208,182 filed Feb. 23, 2009;
- claims the benefit of U.S. provisional patent application No. 61/208,971 filed Mar. 3, 2009; and claims the benefit of U.S. provisional patent application No. 61/270,298, filed Jul. 7, 2009;
- is a continuation-in-part of U.S. patent application Ser. No. 12/985,039 filed Jan. 5, 2011, which
-
- claims the benefit of U.S. provisional patent application No. 61/308,621, filed Feb. 26, 2010;
- claims the benefit of U.S. provisional patent application No. 61/309,651, filed Mar. 2, 2010; and
- claims the benefit of U.S. provisional patent application No. 61/324,776, filed Apr. 16, 2010;
- claims the benefit of U.S. provisional patent application No. 61/936,100 filed Feb. 5, 2014;
- claims the benefit of U.S. provisional patent application No. 61/937,312 filed Feb. 7, 2014;
- claims the benefit of U.S. provisional patent application No. 61/937,325 filed Feb. 7, 2014;
- claims the benefit of U.S. provisional patent application No. 61/941,968 filed Feb. 19, 2014;
- claims the benefit of U.S. provisional patent application No. 61/947,072 filed Mar. 3, 2014;
- claims the benefit of U.S. provisional patent application No. 61/948,301 filed Mar. 5, 2014; and
- claims the benefit of U.S. provisional patent application No. 61/948,335 filed Mar. 5, 2014;
- claims the benefit of U.S. provisional patent application No. 61/954,425 filed Mar. 17, 2014; and
- claims the benefit of U.S. provisional patent application No. 61/954,447 filed Mar. 17, 2014,
- all of which are incorporated herein in their entirety by this reference thereto.
- Field of the Invention
- This invention relates generally to a patient positioning/constraint system.
- Discussion of the Prior Art
- Proton therapy works by aiming energetic ionizing particles, such as protons accelerated with a particle accelerator, onto a target tumor. These particles damage the DNA of cells, ultimately causing their death. Cancerous cells, because of their high rate of division and their reduced ability to repair damaged DNA, are particularly vulnerable to attack on their DNA.
- Patents related to the current invention are summarized here.
- F. Cole, et. al. of Loma Linda University Medical Center “Multi-Station Proton Beam Therapy System”, U.S. Pat. No. 4,870,287 (Sep. 26, 1989) describe a proton beam therapy system for selectively generating and transporting proton beams from a single proton source and accelerator to a selected treatment room of a plurality of patient treatment rooms.
- There exists in the art of charged particle cancer therapy a need to effectively position a tumor of a patient relative to charged particles from the cancer therapy system.
- The invention comprises a patient positioning/constraint apparatus and method of use thereof.
- A more complete understanding of the present invention is derived by referring to the detailed description and claims when considered in connection with the Figures, wherein like reference numbers refer to similar items throughout the Figures.
-
FIG. 1 illustrates component connections of a charged particle beam therapy system; -
FIG. 2 illustrates a charged particle therapy system; -
FIG. 3 illustrates an ion beam generation system; -
FIG. 4A andFIG. 4B illustrate negative ion beam sources; -
FIG. 5 illustrates an ion beam focusing system; -
FIGS. 6 (A-D) illustrate focusing electrodes about a negative ion beam path; -
FIG. 7A illustrates a negative ion beam path vacuum system,FIG. 7B illustrates a support structure,FIG. 7C illustrates a foil, andFIG. 7D illustrates a carbon ion beam injector; -
FIG. 8 is a particle beam therapy control flowchart; -
FIG. 9 illustrates straight and turning sections of a synchrotron -
FIG. 10 illustrates bending magnets of a synchrotron; -
FIG. 11 provides a perspective view of a bending magnet; -
FIG. 12 illustrates coil geometry about a bending magnet; -
FIG. 13 illustrates a cross-sectional view of a bending magnet; -
FIG. 14 illustrates magnetic field concentration in a bending magnet; -
FIG. 15 illustrates correction coils in a bending magnet; -
FIG. 16 illustrates a magnetic turning section of a synchrotron; -
FIG. 17A andFIG. 17B illustrate an RF accelerator and an RF accelerator subsystem, respectively; -
FIG. 18A illustrates a charged particle extraction system andFIG. 18B andFIG. 18C illustrate charged particles with different energy levels penetrating different distances into a body; -
FIG. 19 illustrates a charged particle extraction and intensity control system; -
FIG. 20A andFIG. 20B illustrate proton beam position verification systems; -
FIG. 21A andFIG. 21B respectively illustrate a patient positioning system from: (A) a front view and (B) a top view; -
FIG. 22 provides X-ray, proton, and carbon beam dose distributions; -
FIGS. 23 (A-E) illustrate controlled scanning and depth of focus irradiation; -
FIGS. 24 (A-E) illustrate multi-field irradiation; -
FIG. 25 illustrates dose efficiency enhancement via use of multi-field irradiation; -
FIGS. 26 (A-C) andFIG. 26E illustrate distal irradiation of a tumor from varying rotational directions andFIG. 26D illustrates integrated radiation resulting from distal radiation; -
FIG. 27A andFIG. 27B illustrate multi-dimensional scanning of a charged particle beam spot scanning system operating on (A) a 2-D slice or (B) a 3-D volume of a tumor, respectively; -
FIG. 28A illustrates irradiating varying depths within a tumor andFIG. 28B illustrates changes in irradiation intensity correlating with the varying depths in the tumor; -
FIG. 29 illustrates an electron gun source used in generating X-rays coupled with a particle beam therapy system; -
FIG. 30 illustrates an X-ray source proximate a particle beam path; -
FIG. 31 illustrates an expanded X-ray beam path; -
FIG. 32 provides an X-ray tomography system; -
FIG. 33 illustrates a semi-vertical patient positioning system; -
FIG. 34 provides an example of a sitting patient positioning system; -
FIG. 35 illustrates a laying patient positioning system; -
FIG. 36 illustrates a head restraint system; -
FIG. 37 illustrates hand and head supports; -
FIG. 38 illustrates a rapid patient positioning system; -
FIGS. 39 (A-C) illustrate a patient constraint system; -
FIG. 40 provides a method of positioning, imaging, and irradiating a tumor; -
FIG. 41 provides a method of imaging a tumor with rotation of the patient; -
FIG. 42 provides a method of coordinating X-ray collection with patient respiration; -
FIG. 43 provides a method of charged particle beam control; -
FIG. 44 provides a method of multi-axis charged particle beam irradiation control; -
FIG. 45 illustrates a patient positioning, immobilization, and repositioning system; -
FIG. 46 shows particle field acceleration timed to a patient's respiration cycle; -
FIG. 47 illustrates adjustable particle field acceleration timing; -
FIG. 48 illustrates charged particle cancer therapy controllers; -
FIGS. 49 (A-D) illustrate searing a tumor perimeter with time; -
FIG. 50 illustrates search offset concentric tumor perimeters; -
FIG. 51A andFIG. 51B illustrate overlapping and interwoven searing layers; -
FIG. 52A illustrates a fast magnet,FIG. 52B andFIG. 52C illustrate low and high voltage control, respectively; andFIG. 52D andFIG. 52E illustrate a circuit switch and corresponding current control, respectively; -
FIGS. 53 (A-F) illustrate a rotatable beamline magnet relative to a rotatable patient positioning system; -
FIGS. 54 (A-C) illustrate a tiltable patient side/back support system andFIG. 54D illustrates multiple treatment angles of a tumor using the side/back support system; -
FIGS. 55 (A-C) illustrate co-movement of an imaging beam path and a positively charged particle beam path with gantry movement; and -
FIG. 56 illustrates a charged particle tomography system. - Elements and steps in the figures are illustrated for simplicity and clarity and have not necessarily been rendered according to any particular sequence. For example, steps that are performed concurrently or in different order are illustrated in the figures to help improve understanding of embodiments of the present invention.
- The invention comprises a patient positioning/constraint apparatus and method of use thereof.
- In one embodiment, a patient is tilted about a longitudinal axis, such as rotation about a head-to-foot axis of the patient where the head-to-foot axis of the patient is horizontal. Optional side support constraints are optionally used to constrain radial movement of the patient on the tilted patient support. The side support constraints are optionally formed to or coupled to a radially outer shape of an individual patient, such as the dexter or sinister side of the individual's head, arm, torso, hip, and/or leg. Patient tilt is optionally combined with rotation of the patient about a vertical axis, rotation of the entire patient about an axis not overlapped by the patient, and/or control angles of the charged particle beam through use of guiding magnets in a beamline of the charged particle therapy system.
- Used in combination with the invention, novel design features of a charged particle beam cancer therapy system are described. Particularly, a negative ion beam source with novel features in the negative ion source, ion source vacuum system, ion beam focusing lens, and tandem accelerator is described. Additionally, the synchrotron includes: turning magnets, edge focusing magnets, magnetic field concentration magnets, winding and correction coils, flat magnetic field incident surfaces, and extraction elements, which minimize the overall size of the synchrotron, provide a tightly controlled proton beam, directly reduce the size of required magnetic fields, directly reduce required operating power, and allow continual acceleration of protons in a synchrotron even during a process of extracting protons from the synchrotron. The ion beam source system and synchrotron are preferably computer integrated with a patient imaging system and a patient interface including respiration monitoring sensors and patient positioning elements. Further, the system is integrated with intensity control of a charged particle beam, acceleration, extraction, and/or targeting method and apparatus. More particularly, intensity, energy, and timing control of a charged particle stream of a synchrotron is coordinated with patient positioning and tumor treatment. The synchrotron control elements allow tight control of the charged particle beam, which compliments the tight control of patient positioning to yield efficient treatment of a solid tumor with reduced tissue damage to surrounding healthy tissue. In addition, the system reduces the overall size of the synchrotron, provides a tightly controlled proton beam, directly reduces the size of required magnetic fields, directly reduces required operating power, and allows continual acceleration of protons in a synchrotron even during a process of extracting protons from the synchrotron. All of these systems are preferably used in conjunction with an X-ray system capable of collecting X-rays of a patient: (1) in a positioning, immobilization, and automated repositioning system for proton treatment; (2) at a specified moment of the patient's respiration cycle; and (3) using coordinated translation and rotation of the patient. Combined, the systems provide for efficient, accurate, and precise noninvasive tumor treatment with minimal damage to surrounding healthy tissue.
- In various embodiments, the charged particle cancer therapy system incorporates any of:
-
- an injection system having a central magnetic member and a magnetic field separating high and low temperature plasma regions;
- a dual vacuum system creating a first partial pressure region on a plasma generation system side of a foil in a tandem accelerator and a second lower partial pressure region on the synchrotron side of the foil;
- a negative ion beam focusing system having a conductive mesh axially crossing the negative ion beam;
- a synchrotron having four straight sections and four turning sections;
- a synchrotron having no hexapole magnets;
- four bending magnets in each turning section of the synchrotron;
- a winding coil wrapping multiple bending magnets;
- a plurality of bending magnets that are beveled and charged particle focusing in each turning section;
- a magnetic field concentrating geometry approaching the gap through which the charged particles travel;
- correction coils for rapid magnetic field changes;
- magnetic field feedback sensors providing signal to the correction coils;
- integrated RF-amplifier microcircuits providing currents through loops about accelerating coils;
- a low density foil for charged particle extraction;
- a feedback sensor for measuring particle extraction allowing intensity control;
- a synchrotron independently controlling charged particle energy and intensity;
- a layer, after synchrotron extraction and before the tumor, for imaging the particle beam x-, y-axis position;
- a rotatable platform for turning the subject allowing multi-field imaging and/or multi-field proton therapy;
- a radiation plan dispersing ingress
Bragg profile energy 360 degrees about the tumor; - a long lifetime X-ray source;
- an X-ray source proximate the charged particle beam path;
- a multi-field X-ray system;
- positioning, immobilizing, and repositioning systems;
- respiratory sensors;
- simultaneous and independent control of:
- x-axis beam control;
- y-axis beam control;
- irradiation beam energy;
- irradiation beam intensity;
- patient translation; and/or
- patient rotation; and
- a system timing charged particle therapy to one or more of:
- patient translation;
- patient rotation; and
- patient respiration.
- In another embodiment, safety systems for a charged particle system are implemented. For example, the safety system includes any of: multiple X-ray images from multiple directions, a three-dimensional X-ray image, a proton beam approximating a path of an X-ray beam, tight control of a proton beam cross-sectional area with magnets, ability to control proton beam energy, ability to control proton beam energy, a set of patient movement constrains, a patient controlled charged particle interrupt system, distribution of radiation around a tumor, and timed irradiation in terms of respiration.
- In yet another embodiment, the tumor is imaged from multiple directions in phase with patient respiration. For example, a plurality of two-dimensional pictures are collected that are all in the about the same phase of respiration. The two-dimensional pictures are combined to produce a three-dimensional picture of the tumor relative to the patient. One or more safety features are optionally used in the charged particle cancer therapy system independently and/or in combination with the three-dimensional imaging system, as described infra.
- In still yet another embodiment, the system independently controls patient translation position, patient rotation position, two-dimensional beam trajectory, delivered radiation beam energy, delivered radiation beam intensity, timing of charged particle delivery, beam velocity, and/or distribution of radiation striking healthy tissue. The system operates in conjunction with a negative ion beam source, synchrotron, patient positioning, imaging, and/or targeting method and apparatus to deliver an effective and uniform dose of radiation to a tumor while distributing radiation striking healthy tissue.
- Throughout this document, a charged particle beam therapy system, such as a proton beam, hydrogen ion beam, or carbon ion beam, is described. Herein, the charged particle beam therapy system is described using a proton beam. However, the aspects taught and described in terms of a proton beam are not intended to be limiting to that of a proton beam and are illustrative of a charged particle beam system. Any of the techniques described herein are equally applicable to any charged particle beam system.
- Referring now to
FIG. 1 , a chargedparticle beam system 100 is illustrated. The charged particle beam preferably comprises a number of subsystems including any of: amain controller 110; aninjection system 120; asynchrotron 130 that typically includes: (1) anaccelerator system 132 and (2) anextraction system 134; a scanning/targeting/delivery system 140; apatient interface module 150; adisplay system 160; and/or animaging system 170. - An exemplary method of use of the charged
particle beam system 100 is provided. Themain controller 110 controls one or more of the subsystems to accurately and precisely deliver protons to a tumor of a patient. For example, themain controller 110 obtains an image, such as a portion of a body and/or of a tumor, from theimaging system 170. Themain controller 110 also obtains position and/or timing information from thepatient interface module 150. Themain controller 110 then optionally controls theinjection system 120 to inject a proton into asynchrotron 130. The synchrotron typically contains at least anaccelerator system 132 and anextraction system 134. Themain controller 110 preferably controls the proton beam within the accelerator system, such as by controlling speed, trajectory, and timing of the proton beam. The main controller then controls extraction of a proton beam from the accelerator through theextraction system 134. For example, the controller controls timing, energy, and/or intensity of the extracted beam. Thecontroller 110 also preferably controls targeting of the proton beam through the scanning/targeting/delivery system 140 to thepatient interface module 150. One or more components of thepatient interface module 150, such as translational and rotational position of the patient, are preferably controlled by themain controller 110. Further, display elements of thedisplay system 160 are preferably controlled via themain controller 110. Displays, such as display screens, are typically provided to one or more operators and/or to one or more patients. In one embodiment, themain controller 110 times the delivery of the proton beam from all systems, such that protons are delivered in an optimal therapeutic manner to the tumor of the patient. - Herein, the
main controller 110 refers to a single system controlling the chargedparticle beam system 100, to a single controller controlling a plurality of subsystems controlling the chargedparticle beam system 100, or to a plurality of individual controllers controlling one or more sub-systems of the chargedparticle beam system 100. - Referring now to
FIG. 2 , an illustrative exemplary embodiment of one version of the chargedparticle beam system 100 is provided. The number, position, and described type of components is illustrative and non-limiting in nature. In the illustrated embodiment, theinjection system 120 or ion source or charged particle beam source generates protons. The protons are delivered into a vacuum tube that runs into, through, and out of the synchrotron. The generated protons are delivered along aninitial path 262. Focusingmagnets 230, such as quadrupole magnets or injection quadrupole magnets, are used to focus the proton beam path. A quadrupole magnet is a focusing magnet. Aninjector bending magnet 232 bends the proton beam toward the plane of thesynchrotron 130. The focused protons having an initial energy are introduced into aninjector magnet 240, which is preferably an injection Lambertson magnet. Typically, theinitial beam path 262 is along an axis off of, such as above, a circulating plane of thesynchrotron 130. Theinjector bending magnet 232 andinjector magnet 240 combine to move the protons into thesynchrotron 130. Main bending magnets, dipole magnets, turning magnets, or circulatingmagnets 250 are used to turn the protons along a circulatingbeam path 264. A dipole magnet is a bending magnet. Themain bending magnets 250 bend theinitial beam path 262 into a circulatingbeam path 264. In this example, themain bending magnets 250 or circulating magnets are represented as four sets of four magnets to maintain the circulatingbeam path 264 into a stable circulating beam path. However, any number of magnets or sets of magnets are optionally used to move the protons around a single orbit in the circulation process. The protons pass through anaccelerator 270. The accelerator accelerates the protons in the circulatingbeam path 264. As the protons are accelerated, the fields applied by the magnets are increased. Particularly, the speed of the protons achieved by theaccelerator 270 are synchronized with magnetic fields of themain bending magnets 250 or circulating magnets to maintain stable circulation of the protons about a central point orregion 280 of the synchrotron. At separate points in time theaccelerator 270/main bending magnet 250 combination is used to accelerate and/or decelerate the circulating protons while maintaining the protons in the circulating path or orbit. An extraction element of the inflector/deflector system 290 is used in combination with aLambertson extraction magnet 292 to remove protons from their circulatingbeam path 264 within thesynchrotron 130. One example of a deflector component is a Lambertson magnet. Typically the deflector moves the protons from the circulating plane to an axis off of the circulating plane, such as above the circulating plane. Extracted protons are preferably directed and/or focused using anextraction bending magnet 237 andextraction focusing magnets 235, such as quadrupole magnets along atransport path 268 into the scanning/targeting/delivery system 140. Two components of ascanning system 140 or targeting system typically include afirst axis control 142, such as a vertical control, and asecond axis control 144, such as a horizontal control. In one embodiment, thefirst axis control 142 allows for about 100 mm of vertical or y-axis scanning of theproton beam 268 and thesecond axis control 144 allows for about 700 mm of horizontal or x-axis scanning of theproton beam 268. Anozzle system 146 is used for imaging the proton beam and/or as a vacuum barrier between the low pressure beam path of the synchrotron and the atmosphere. Protons are delivered with control to thepatient interface module 150 and to a tumor of a patient. All of the above listed elements are optional and may be used in various permutations and combinations. Each of the above listed elements are further described, infra. - An ion beam generation system generates a negative ion beam, such as a hydrogen anion or H− beam; preferably focuses the negative ion beam; converts the negative ion beam to a positive ion beam, such as a proton or H+ beam; and injects the
positive ion beam 262 into thesynchrotron 130. Portions of the ion beam path are preferably under partial vacuum. Each of these systems are further described, infra. - Referring now to
FIG. 3 , an exemplary ionbeam generation system 300 is illustrated. As illustrated, the ionbeam generation system 300 has four major subsections: anegative ion source 310, a firstpartial vacuum system 330, an optional ionbeam focusing system 350, and atandem accelerator 390. - Still referring to
FIG. 3 , thenegative ion source 310 preferably includes aninjection port 312, for injection of hydrogen gas or methane gas, into a hightemperature plasma chamber 314. In one embodiment, the plasma chamber includes amagnetic material 316, which provides amagnetic field 317 between the hightemperature plasma chamber 314 and a low temperature plasma region on the opposite side of the magnetic field barrier. An extraction pulse is applied to a negativeion extraction electrode 318 to pull the negative ion beam into a negativeion beam path 319, which proceeds through the firstpartial vacuum system 330, through the ionbeam focusing system 350, and into thetandem accelerator 390. Examples of negative ions in the negative ion beam path include H−, C−, or any anion. - Still referring to
FIG. 3 , the firstpartial vacuum system 330 is an enclosed system running from theinjection port 312 to afoil 395 in thetandem accelerator 390. Thefoil 395 is preferably sealed directly or indirectly to the edges of thevacuum tube 320 providing for a higher pressure, such as about 10−5 torr, to be maintained on the first partial vacuum system side of thefoil 395 and a lower pressure, such as about 10−7 torr, to be maintained on the synchrotron side of the foil. By only pumping firstpartial vacuum system 330 and by only semi-continuously operating the ion beam source vacuum based on sensor readings, the lifetime of the semi-continuously operating pump is extended. The sensor readings are further described, infra. - Still referring to
FIG. 3 , the firstpartial vacuum system 330 preferably includes: afirst pump 332, such as a continuously operating pump and/or a turbo molecular pump; alarge holding volume 334; and asemi-continuously operating pump 336. Preferably, apump controller 340 receives a signal from apressure sensor 342 monitoring pressure in thelarge holding volume 334. Upon a signal representative of a sufficient pressure in thelarge holding volume 334, thepump controller 340 instructs anactuator 345 to open avalve 346 between the large holding volume and thesemi-continuously operating pump 336 and instructs the semi-continuously operating pump to turn on and pump to atmosphere residual gases out of thevacuum line 320 about the charged particle stream. In this fashion, the lifetime of the semi-continuously operating pump is extended by only operating semi-continuously and as needed. In one example, thesemi-continuously operating pump 336 operates for a few minutes every few hours, such as 5 minutes every 4 hours, thereby extending a pump with a lifetime of about 2,000 hours to about 96,000 hours. - Further, by isolating the inlet gas from the synchrotron vacuum system, the synchrotron vacuum pumps, such as turbo molecular pumps can operate over a longer lifetime as the synchrotron vacuum pumps have fewer gas molecules to deal with. For example, the inlet gas is primarily hydrogen gas but may contain impurities, such as nitrogen and carbon dioxide. By isolating the inlet gases in the negative
ion source system 310, firstpartial vacuum system 330, ionbeam focusing system 350, and negative ion beam side of thetandem accelerator 390, the synchrotron vacuum pumps can operate at lower pressures with longer lifetimes, which increases operating efficiency of thesynchrotron 130. - Still referring to
FIG. 3 , the optimal ionbeam focusing system 350 preferably includes two or more electrodes where one electrode of each electrode pair partially obstructs the ion beam path withconductive paths 372, such as a conductive mesh. In the illustrated example, two ion beam focusing system sections are illustrated, a two electrode ionbeam focusing section 360 and a three electrode ionbeam focusing section 370. For a given electrode pair, electric field lines, running between the conductive mesh of a first electrode and a second electrode, provide inward forces focusing the negative ion beam. Multiple such electrode pairs provide multiple negative ion beam focusing regions. Preferably the two electrodeion focusing section 360 and the three electrodeion focusing section 370 are placed after the negative ion source and before the tandem accelerator and/or cover a space of about 0.5, 1, or 2 meters along theion beam path 319. Ion beam focusing systems are further described, infra. - Still referring to
FIG. 3 , thetandem accelerator 390 preferably includes afoil 395, such as a carbon foil. The negative ions in the negativeion beam path 319 are converted to positive ions, such as protons, and the initialion beam path 262 results. Thefoil 395 is preferably sealed directly or indirectly to the edges of thevacuum tube 320 providing for a higher pressure, such as about 10−5 torr, to be maintained on the side of thefoil 395 having the negativeion beam path 319 and a lower pressure, such as about 10−7 torr, to be maintained on the side of thefoil 390 having the protonion beam path 262. Having thefoil 395 physically separating thevacuum chamber 320 into two pressure regions allows for a system having fewer and/or smaller pumps to maintain the lower pressure system in thesynchrotron 130 as the inlet hydrogen and its residuals are extracted in a separate contained and isolated space by the firstpartial vacuum system 330. - An example of the
negative ion source 310 is further described herein. Referring now toFIG. 4A andFIG. 4B , cross-sections of two exemplary negative ion source systems are provided. Referring now toFIG. 4A , a first negativeion source system 400 is illustrated for the formation of a H−; however, the first negativeion source system 400 is optionally used to generate any negative ion, such as C. Referring now toFIG. 4B , a second negativeion source system 405 is illustrated for the formation of as C−; however, the second negativeion source system 405 is optionally used to generate any negative ion, such as H−. The first and second negativeion source systems - Referring still to
FIG. 4A andFIG. 4B , thenegative ion beam 319 is created in multiple stages. During an initial stage, an element source such as hydrogen gas or methane gas is injected into a chamber. During an intermediate stage, a negative ion is created by application of a first high voltage pulse, which creates a plasma about the hydrogen gas or methane gas to create negative ions. During a final stage, the negative ions are extracted from the plasma region by application of a second high voltage pulse. Each of the stages are further described, infra. While the chamber is illustrated as a cross-section of a cylinder, the cylinder is exemplary only and any geometry applies to the outer housing and central chamber. - Referring now to
FIG. 4A , the first negativeion source system 400 is illustrated for ease of presentation using hydrogen gas to create a H− ion beam. More generally, an element in a molecule is injected and an ion of the element is extracted. - In a first stage,
gas 440, such as hydrogen gas, is injected through theinjection port 312 into a hightemperature plasma region 490. Theinjection port 312 is open for a short period of time, such as less than about 1, 5, or 10 microseconds to minimize vacuum pump requirements to maintainvacuum chamber 320 requirements. The high temperature plasma region is maintained at reduced pressure by thepartial vacuum system 330. The injection of the hydrogen gas is optionally controlled by themain controller 110, which is responsive toimaging system 170 information andpatient interface module 150 information, such as patient positioning and period in a respiration cycle. - In a second stage, a high temperature plasma region is created by applying a first high voltage pulse across a
first electrode 422 and asecond electrode 424. For example a 5 kV pulse is applied for about 20 microseconds with 5 kV at thesecond electrode 424 and about 0 kV applied at thefirst electrode 422. Hydrogen in the chamber is broken, in the hightemperature plasma region 490, into component parts, such as any of: atomic hydrogen, H0, a proton, H+, an electron, e−, and a hydrogen anion, H−. - In a third stage, the high
temperature plasma region 490 is at least partially separated from a lowtemperature plasma region 493 by themagnetic field 317 or in this specific example amagnetic field barrier 430. High energy electrons are restricted from passing through themagnetic field barrier 430. In this manner, themagnetic field barrier 430 acts as a filter between, zone A and zone B, in the negative ion source. Preferably, a centralmagnetic material 410, which is an example of themagnetic material 316, is placed within the hightemperature plasma region 490, such as along a central axis of the hightemperature plasma region 490. Preferably, thefirst electrode 422 andsecond electrode 424 are composed of magnetic materials, such as iron. Preferably, theouter walls 450 of the high temperature plasma region, such as cylinder walls, are composed of a magnetic material, such as a permanent magnet, ferric or iron based material, or a ferrite dielectric ring magnet. In this manner a magnetic field loop is created by: the centralmagnetic material 410,first electrode 422, theouter walls 450, thesecond electrode 424, and themagnetic field barrier 430. Again, themagnetic field barrier 430 restricts high energy electrons from passing through themagnetic field barrier 430. Low energy electrons interact with atomic hydrogen, H0, to create a hydrogen anion, H−, in the lowtemperature plasma region 493. - In a fourth stage, a second high voltage pulse or extraction pulse is applied at a
third electrode 426. The second high voltage pulse is preferentially applied during the later period of application of the first high voltage pulse. For example, an extraction pulse of about 25 kV is applied for about the last 5 microseconds of the first creation pulse of about 20 microseconds. The potential difference, of about 20 kV, between thethird electrode 426 andsecond electrode 424 extracts the negative ion, H−, from the lowtemperature plasma region 493 and initiates thenegative ion beam 319, from zone B to zone C. - The
magnetic field barrier 430 is optionally created in a number of ways. An example of creation of themagnetic field barrier 430 using coils is provided. In this example, the elements described, supra, in relation toFIG. 4A are maintained with several differences. First, the magnetic field is created using coils. An isolating material is preferably provided between thefirst electrode 422 and thecylinder walls 450 as well as between thesecond electrode 424 and thecylinder walls 450. Thecentral material 410 and/orcylinder walls 450 are optionally metallic. In this manner, the coils create a magnetic field loop through thefirst electrode 422, isolating material,outer walls 450,second electrode 424,magnetic field barrier 430, and thecentral material 410. Essentially, the coils generate a magnetic field in place of production of the magnetic field by themagnetic material 410. Themagnetic field barrier 430 operates as described, supra. Generally, any manner that creates themagnetic field barrier 430 between the hightemperature plasma region 490 and lowtemperature plasma region 493 is functionally applicable to the ionbeam extraction system 400, described herein. - Referring now to
FIG. 4B , the second negativeion source system 405 is illustrated for ease of presentation using methane gas to create a C− ion beam. As with the first negative ion source system, more generally an element in molecular, ionic, or elemental form is injected into the second negativeion source system 405 and an ion of the element is extracted from the second negativeion source system 405. Generally, the second negativeion source system 405 generates an anion in a hightemperature plasma region 490 as described, supra, for the first negativeion source system 400 and electrodes, such as thefirst electrode 422 and thesecond electrode 424, are used to extract the anion. Differences between the first and second negativeion source systems - First, the
injection port 312 of the second negativeion source system 405 is illustrated as leading through aninjection passage 482 or plenum of acentral member 480 to an opening proximate the center of the hightemperature plasma region 490. However, as with the first negativeion source system 400, the gas inlet opening to the high temperature plasma region is optionally any point connected to the hightemperature plasma region 490. Thecentral member 480 is preferably a non-magnetic material and is preferably a rod or tube of any cross-sectional shape, where a circular cross-sectional shape is preferred. Thecentral member 480 is held at a low potential relative to thesecond electrode 424, is electrically connected to a first containment wall, described infra, and/or is maintained at about zero volts. - Second, in the second negative
ion source system 405, the hightemperature plasma region 490 includes a zone between afirst containment wall 460 and thesecond electrode 424. Preferably, thefirst containment wall 460 and the second electrode comprise a magnetic material, such as a ferromagnetic material. Thefirst containment wall 460 and the second electrode are separated by a non-conductive material, such as stainless steel. As illustrated, the non-conductive material comprises a set of four stainless steel rings, though any number of rings is optionally used and the geometry is optionally of any shape separating the voltage difference between ends of the hightemperature plasma region 490 along the x-axis. - Third, within the high
temperature plasma region 490 is anon-magnetic anode 484, preferably connected to thesecond electrode 424 or an end of the hightemperature plasma region 490 opposite to the first containment wall. The non-magnetic anode is optionally of any geometry, but a solid elongated cross-section, tube, or 3-D tube is preferred. - In use, the second negative ion source uses an electric field pulse crossing a magnetic field, to form conditions used to create a magnetron discharge, to break apart the element source, such as CH4, to form the negative ion, such as C−, where the second and
third electrodes negative ion beam 319 or C− from the hightemperature plasma region 490, as described supra, but without themagnetic field barrier 430. More particularly, a magnetic field, which is preferably a uniformmagnetic field 491, is maintained along the x-axis in the hightemperature plasma region 490 between thefirst containment wall 460 and thesecond electrode 424 by a maintained or pulsed voltage difference between thesecond electrode 424 and thefirst containment wall 460. Simultaneously, an electric field, which is preferably a uniformelectric field 492 is maintained or pulsed across the hightemperature plasma region 490 between the non-magneticcentral member 480 and thenon-magnetic anode 484. Pulse times are optionally as described, supra, for the first negativeion source system 400. Preferably the about uniformmagnetic field 491 along the x-axis crosses the about uniformelectric field 492 along any combination of the y- and z-axes at about a right angle. Within the hightemperature plasma region 490, the illustrated methane source is broken down into: (1) hydrogen constituents, such as atomic hydrogen, H0, a proton, H+, an electron, e−, and a hydrogen anion, H− and (2) carbon constituents, such as atomic carbon, C0, various carbon cations, electrons, e−, and various forms of carbon anions, such as C. The C− ion is extracted from the hightemperature plasma region 490 by the second andthird electrodes synchrotron 130 using the ionbeam focusing system 350 and/or thetandem accelerator 390, as described infra. - Referring now to
FIG. 5 , the ionbeam focusing system 350 is further described. In this example, three electrodes are used. In this example, afirst electrode 510 andthird electrode 530 are both negatively charged and each is a ring electrode circumferentially enclosing or at least partially enclosing the negativeion beam path 319. Asecond electrode 520 is positively charged and is also a ring electrode at least partially and preferably substantially circumferentially enclosing the negative ion beam path. In addition, the second electrode includes one ormore conducting paths 372 running through the negativeion beam path 319. For example, the conducting paths are a wire mesh, a conducting grid, or a series of substantially parallel conducting lines running across the second electrode. In use, electric field lines run from the conducting paths of the positively charged electrode to the negatively charged electrodes. For example, in use theelectric field lines 540 run from the conductingpaths 372 in the negativeion beam path 319 to the negatively chargedelectrodes ray trace lines ray trace line 550, the negative ion beam encounters a first electric field line at point M. Negatively charged ions in thenegative ion beam 550 encounter forces running up theelectric field line 572, illustrated with anx-axis component vector 571. The x-axiscomponent force vectors 571 alters the trajectory of the first ray trace line to a inwardfocused vector 552, which encounters a second electric field line at point N. Again, thenegative ion beam 552 encounters forces running up theelectric field line 574, illustrated as having an inward force vector with anx-axis component 573, which alters the inwardfocused vector 552 to a more inwardfocused vector 554. Similarly, in the secondray trace line 560, the negative ion beam encounters a first electric field line at point O. Negatively charged ions in the negative ion beam encounter forces running up theelectric field line 576, illustrated as having a force vector with anx-axis force 575. Theinward force vector 575 alters the trajectory of the secondray trace line 560 to an inwardfocused vector 562, which encounters a second electric field line at point P. Again, the negative ion beam encounters forces running up theelectric field line 578, illustrated as having force vector with an x-axis component 577, which alters the inwardfocused vector 562 to a more inwardfocused vector 564. The net result is a focusing effect on the negative ion beam. Each of theforce vectors - Still referring to
FIG. 5 , optionally any number of electrodes are used, such as 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, 7, 8, or 9 electrodes, to focus the negative ion beam path where every other electrode, in a given focusing section, is either positively or negatively charged. For example, three focusing sections are optionally used. In the firstion focusing section 360, a pair of electrodes is used where the first electrode encountered along the negative ion beam path is negatively charged and the second electrode is positively charged, resulting in focusing of the negative ion beam path. In the secondion focusing section 370, two pairs of electrodes are used, where a common positively charged electrode with a conductive mesh running through the negativelyion beam path 319 is used. Thus, in the secondion focusing section 370, the first electrode encountered along the negative ion beam path is negatively charged and the second electrode is positively charged, resulting in focusing of the negative ion beam path. Further, in the second ion focusing section, moving along the negative ion beam path, a second focusing effect is observed between the second positively charged electrode and a third negatively charged electrode. In this example, a third ion focusing section is used that again has three electrodes, which acts in the fashion of the second ion focusing section, described supra. - Referring now to
FIG. 6 , the central region of the electrodes in the ionbeam focusing system 350 is further described. Referring now toFIG. 6A , the central region of the negatively chargedring electrode 510 is preferably void of conductive material. Referring now toFIGS. 6B-D , the central region of positively chargedelectrode ring 520 preferably containsconductive paths 372. Preferably, theconductive paths 372 or conductive material within the positively chargedelectrode ring 520 blocks about 1, 2, 5, or 10 percent of the area and more preferably blocks about five percent of the cross-sectional area of the negativeion beam path 319. Referring now toFIG. 6B , one option is aconductive mesh 610. Referring now toFIG. 6C , a second option is a series ofconductive lines 620 running substantially in parallel across the positively chargedelectrode ring 520 that surrounds a portion of the negativeion beam path 319. Referring now toFIG. 6D , a third option is to have afoil 630 or metallic layer cover all of the cross-sectional area of the negative ion beam path with holes punched through the material, where the holes take up about 90-99 percent and more preferably about 95 percent of the area of the foil. More generally, the pair ofelectrodes negative ion beam 319 when the ions in thenegative ion beam 319 translate through the electric field lines, as described supra. - In an example of a two electrode negative beam ion focusing system having a first cross-sectional diameter, d1, the negative ions are focused to a second cross-sectional diameter, d2, where d1>d2. Similarly, in an example of a three electrode negative beam ion focusing system having a first ion beam cross-sectional diameter, d1, the negative ions are focused using the three electrode system to a third negative ion beam cross-sectional diameter, d3, where d1>d3. For like potentials on the electrodes, the three electrode system provides tighter or stronger focusing compared to the two-electrode system, d3<d2.
- In the examples provided, supra, of a multi-electrode ion beam focusing system, the electrodes are rings. More generally, the electrodes are of any geometry sufficient to provide electric field lines that provide focusing force vectors to the negative ion beam when the ions in the
negative ion beam 319 translate through the electric field lines, as described supra. For example, one negative ring electrode is optionally replaced by a number of negatively charged electrodes, such as about 2, 3, 4, 6, 8, 10, or more electrodes placed about the outer region of a cross-sectional area of the negative ion beam probe. Generally, more electrodes are required to converge or diverge a faster or higher energy beam. - In another embodiment, by reversing the polarity of electrodes in the above example, the negative ion beam is made to diverge. Thus, the negative
ion beam path 319 is optionally focused and/or expanded using combinations of electrode pairs. For example, if the electrode having the mesh across the negative ion beam path is made negative, then the negative ion beam path is made to defocus. Hence, combinations of electrode pairs are used for focusing and defocusing a negative ion beam path, such as where a first pair includes a positively charged mesh for focusing and a where a second pair includes a negatively charged mesh for defocusing. - Referring now to
FIG. 7A andFIG. 7D , thetandem accelerator 390 is further described in terms of acceleration of H− and C−, respectively. The tandem accelerator accelerates ions using a series ofelectrodes ion beam path 319 are accelerated using a series of electrodes having progressively higher voltages relative to the voltage of the extraction electrode orthird electrode 426, of the negativeion beam source 310. For instance, for H−, thetandem accelerator 390 optionally has electrodes ranging from the 25 kV of the extraction electrode to about 525 kV near thefoil 395 in thetandem accelerator 390 while for C− the potential of the electrodes increase to about 3 MV or 3 MeV near thefoil 395. - Referring now to
FIGS. 7A-D , the tandem accelerator is illustrated in conjunction with electron stripping devices, such as a carbonfoil stripping system 705 and/or a hydrogengas stripping system 760. For proton formation, a strippingfoil 395 is optionally used. For carbon cation formation, the strippingfoil 395 is optionally used in conjunction with a hydrogen gas injected chamber. Both the proton and carbon ion beam formation systems are further described, infra. - Referring now to
FIG. 7A-C , carbonfoil stripping system 705 and the proton ion beam formation is further described. For the proton injector, upon passing through thefoil 395, the negative ion, H−, loses two electrons to yield a proton, H+, according toequation 1. -
H+→H++2e − (eq. 1) - The proton is further accelerated in the tandem accelerator using appropriate voltages at a multitude of
further electrodes synchrotron 130 as described, supra. - Referring again to
FIGS. 7A-D , thefoil 395 in thetandem accelerator 390 is further described. Thefoil 395 is preferably a very thin carbon film of about thirty to two hundred angstroms in thickness. The foil thickness is designed to both: (1) not block the ion beam and (2) allow the transfer of electrons. For example, the transfer of electrons yields theproton beam path 262. Similarly, the transfer of electrons yields the C6+ beam path 263. For clarity of presentation, the proton beam path is used in subsequent illustrations and explanations; however, the C6+ beam path 263 is optionally used in place of theproton beam path 262. Thefoil 395 is preferably substantially in contact with asupport layer 720, such as a support grid. Thesupport layer 720 provides mechanical strength to thefoil 395 to combine to form avacuum blocking element 725. Thefoil 395 blocks nitrogen, carbon dioxide, hydrogen, and other gases, such as neutrally charged gases, from passing and thus acts as a vacuum barrier. In one embodiment, thefoil 395 is preferably sealed directly or indirectly to the edges of thevacuum tube 320 providing for a higher pressure, such as about 10−5 torr, to be maintained on the side of thefoil 395 having the negativeion beam path 319 and a lower pressure, such as about 10−7 torr, to be maintained on the side of thefoil 395 having the protonion beam path 262 or carboncation beam path 263. Having thefoil 395 physically separating thevacuum chamber 320 into two pressure regions allows for a vacuum system having fewer and/or smaller pumps to maintain the lower pressure system in thesynchrotron 130 as the inlet hydrogen and its residuals are extracted in a separate contained and isolated space by the firstpartial vacuum system 330. Thefoil 395 andsupport layer 720 are preferably attached to thestructure 750 of thetandem accelerator 390 orvacuum tube 320 to form a pressure barrier using any mechanical means, such as a metal, plastic, orceramic ring 730 compressed to the walls with anattachment screw 740. Any mechanical means for separating and sealing the two vacuum chamber sides with thefoil 395 are equally applicable to this system. Referring now toFIG. 7B andFIG. 7C , examples of thesupport structure 720 and foil 395 are individually viewed in the x-, y-plane, respectively. - Referring now to
FIG. 7D , the carbon ion accelerator is further described. Generally, a carbon anion, such as C−, is initially converted into a multiply charged cation, a trivalent cation, a quadrivalent cation, a polyvalent cation, C3+, and/or C4+ through stripping of electrons from the carbon anion, such as C−, by rapidly injected hydrogen gas, according toequations -
C−→C3++4e − (eq. 2) -
C−→C4++5e − (eq. 3) - The hydrogen gas, H2(g), is injected into a
vacuum tube 320 orsecondary vacuum tube 762 passing through theprimary vacuum tube 320 through use of a veryfast switch 764 with anoptional exit port 766. Subsequently, for the carbon ion injector, the C3+ cation, the C4+ cation, or any cation of carbon retaining electrons is then passed through thefoil 395, where the carbon cations, such as C4+ and C3+, lose additional electrons, such as two or three electrons, respectively, to yield a C6+ cation, according toequations -
C3+→C6++3e − (eq. 4) -
C4+→C6++2e − (eq. 5) - Optionally, stripping of the carbon anion, such as stripping of C−, uses either the hydrogen
gas stripping system 760, the carbonfoil stripping system 705, or the hydrogengas stripping system 760 in combination with the carbonfoil stripping system 705 to form the carbon cation accelerated in thesynchrotron 130, which is subsequently used for carbon ion therapy of thetumor 2120. Optionally, the carbon cation is not fully stripped of electrons. Particularly, C+, C2+, C3+, C4+, and/or C5+ are optionally accelerated in thesynchrotron 130 and used to target thetumor 2120 using the chargedparticle therapy system 100. Similarly, the carbonfoil stripping system 705 and/or the hydrogengas stripping system 760 are optionally used to form cations of any element, such as any element with an atomic number up to twenty-six. - Referring now to
FIG. 8 , another exemplary method of use of the chargedparticle beam system 100 is provided. Themain controller 110, or one or more sub-controllers, controls one or more of the subsystems to accurately and precisely deliver protons to a tumor of a patient. For example, the main controller sends a message to the patient indicating when or how to breathe. Themain controller 110 obtains a sensor reading from the patient interface module, such as a temperature breath sensor or a force reading indicative of where in a respiration cycle the subject is. Coordinated at a specific and reproducible point in the respiration cycle, the main controller collects an image, such as a portion of a body and/or of a tumor, from theimaging system 170. Themain controller 110 also obtains position and/or timing information from thepatient interface module 150. Themain controller 110 then optionally controls theinjection system 120 to inject hydrogen gas into a negativeion beam source 310 and controls timing of extraction of the negative ion from the negativeion beam source 310. Optionally, the main controller controls ion beam focusing using the ion beam focusinglens system 350; acceleration of the proton beam with thetandem accelerator 390; and/or injection of the proton into thesynchrotron 130. The synchrotron typically contains at least anaccelerator system 132 and anextraction system 134. The synchrotron preferably contains one or more of: turning magnets, edge focusing magnets, magnetic field concentration magnets, winding and correction coils, and flat magnetic field incident surfaces, some of which contain elements under control by themain controller 110. The main controller preferably controls the proton beam within the accelerator system, such as by controlling speed, trajectory, and/or timing of the proton beam. The main controller then controls extraction of a proton beam from the accelerator through theextraction system 134. For example, the controller controls timing, energy, and/or intensity of the extracted beam. Themain controller 110 also preferably controls targeting of the proton beam through the targeting/delivery system 140 to thepatient interface module 150. One or more components of thepatient interface module 150 are preferably controlled by themain controller 110, such as vertical position of the patient, rotational position of the patient, and patient chair positioning/stabilization/immobilization/control elements. Further, display elements of thedisplay system 160 are preferably controlled via themain controller 110. Displays, such as display screens, are typically provided to one or more operators and/or to one or more patients. In one embodiment, themain controller 110 times the delivery of the proton beam from all systems, such that protons are delivered in an optimal therapeutic manner to the tumor of the patient. - Herein, the term synchrotron is used to refer to a system maintaining the charged particle beam in a circulating path. Further, the charged particle beam is referred to herein as circulating along a circulating path about a central point of the synchrotron. The circulating path is alternatively referred to as an orbiting path; however, the orbiting path does not refer to a perfect circle or ellipse, rather it refers to cycling of the protons around a central point or
region 280. - Referring now to
FIG. 9 , thesynchrotron 130 preferably comprises a combination ofstraight sections 910 and ionbeam turning sections 920. Hence, the circulating path of the protons is not circular in a synchrotron, but is rather a polygon with rounded corners. - In one illustrative embodiment, the
synchrotron 130, which is also referred to as an accelerator system, has four straight sections or elements and four turning sections. Examples ofstraight sections 910 include the:inflector 240,accelerator 270,extraction system 290, anddeflector 292. Along with the four straight sections are four ionbeam turning sections 920, which are also referred to as magnet sections or turning sections. Turning sections are further described, infra. - Referring still to
FIG. 9 , an exemplary synchrotron is illustrated. In this example, protons delivered along the initialproton beam path 262 are inflected into the circulating beam path with theinflector 240 and after acceleration are extracted via adeflector 292 to thebeam transport path 268. In this example, thesynchrotron 130 comprises fourstraight sections 910 and four bending or turningsections 920 where each of the four turning sections use one or more magnets to turn the proton beam about ninety degrees. As is further described, infra, the ability to closely space the turning sections and efficiently turn the proton beam results in shorter straight sections. Shorter straight sections allow for a synchrotron design without the use of focusing quadrupoles in the circulating beam path of the synchrotron. The removal of the focusing quadrupoles from the circulating proton beam path results in a more compact design. In this example, the illustrated synchrotron has about a five meter diameter versus eight meter and larger cross-sectional diameters for systems using a quadrupole focusing magnet in the circulating proton beam path. - Referring now to
FIG. 10 , additional description of the first bending or turningsection 920 is provided. Each of the turning sections preferably comprise multiple magnets, such as about 2, 4, 6, 8, 10, or 12 magnets. In this example, four turningmagnets first turning section 920 are used to illustrate key principles, which are the same regardless of the number of magnets in aturning section 920. The turningmagnets magnets 250. - In physics, the Lorentz force is the force on a point charge due to electromagnetic fields. The Lorentz force is given by equation 6 in terms of magnetic fields with the electron field terms not included.
-
F=q(v×B) (eq. 6) - In equation 6, F is the force in Newtons; q is the electric charge in coulombs; B is the magnetic field in Teslas; and v is the instantaneous velocity of the particles in meters per second.
- Referring now to
FIG. 11 , an example of a single magnet bending orturning section 1010 is expanded. The turning section includes agap 1110 through which protons circulate. Thegap 1110 is preferably a flat gap, allowing for a magnetic field across thegap 1110 that is more uniform, even, and intense. A magnetic field enters thegap 1110 through a magnetic field incident surface and exits thegap 1110 through a magnetic field exiting surface. Thegap 1110 runs in a vacuum tube between two magnet halves. Thegap 1110 is controlled by at least two parameters: (1) thegap 1110 is kept as large as possible to minimize loss of protons and (2) thegap 1110 is kept as small as possible to minimize magnet sizes and the associated size and power requirements of the magnet power supplies. The flat nature of thegap 1110 allows for a compressed and more uniform magnetic field across thegap 1110. One example of a gap dimension is to accommodate a vertical proton beam size of about two centimeters with a horizontal beam size of about five to six centimeters. - As described, supra, a larger gap size requires a larger power supply. For instance, if the
gap 1110 size doubles in vertical size, then the power supply requirements increase by about a factor of four. The flatness of thegap 1110 is also important. For example, the flat nature of thegap 1110 allows for an increase in energy of the extracted protons from about 250 to about 330 MeV. More particularly, if thegap 1110 has an extremely flat surface, then the limits of a magnetic field of an iron magnet are reachable. An exemplary precision of the flat surface of thegap 1110 is a polish of less than about five microns and preferably with a polish of about one to three microns. Unevenness in the surface results in imperfections in the applied magnetic field. The polished flat surface spreads unevenness of the applied magnetic field. - Still referring to
FIG. 11 , the charged particle beam moves through thegap 1110 with an instantaneous velocity, v. A firstmagnetic coil 1120 and a secondmagnetic coil 1130 run above and below thegap 1110, respectively. Current running through thecoils magnet turning section 1010. In this example, the magnetic field, B, runs upward, which results in a force, F, pushing the charged particle beam inward toward a central point of the synchrotron, which turns the charged particle beam in an arc. - Still referring to
FIG. 11 , a portion of an optional second magnet bending orturning section 1020 is illustrated. Thecoils return elements magnet turning section 1010. The turns 1140, 1150 take space. The space reduces the percentage of the path about one orbit of the synchrotron that is covered by the turning magnets. This leads to portions of the circulating path where the protons are not turned and/or focused and allows for portions of the circulating path where the proton path defocuses. Thus, the space results in a larger synchrotron. Therefore, the space betweenmagnet turning sections 1160 is preferably minimized. The second turning magnet is used to illustrate that thecoils space 1160 between two turning section magnets. - Still referring to
FIG. 12 , an optional embodiment of the secondmagnetic coil 1130 is further described. Generally, a singlemain bending magnet 250 has a top half and a bottom half. InFIG. 12 , only the bottom halves of two sequentialmain bending magnets 250 are illustrated. The top halves, not illustrated for clarity of presentation, are essentially a repeat of the bottom halves rotated one hundred eighty degrees about the x-axis. Thegap 1110 runs between the two halves. - Referring now to only the left side of
FIG. 12 , a bottom half of a first main bending magnet using an optional flattenedmagnetic coil system 1200 is illustrated. A shapedcoil 1132, which is an example of the first windingcoil 1250 and is further an example of the secondmagnetic coil 1130, is wrapped about acentral metal member 1211, such as thefirst magnet 1210, and betweenyoke members 1212, which are also referred to as return yoke members of afirst magnet 1210. Thegap 1110 runs directly above thecentral metal member 1211. The shapedcoil 1132 has a first width, w1, and a first thickness, t1, along the x-axis along the length of the magnet. Herein, the length of the magnet is along the axis of the circulating charged particle. The shapedcoil 1132 has a second width, w2, and a second thickness, t2, along the y-axis at the end of thecentral metal member 1211. The first width, w1, is larger than the second width, w2. The smaller second width, w2, allows a smaller distance, d1, between the firstmagnet turning section 1010 and the secondmagnet turning section 1020. For example, the first width, w1, is more than about 1.1, 1.2, 1.3, 1.5, 1.75, 2.0, 2.25, or 2.5 times the second width, w2. Similarly, the second thickness, t2, is more than about 1.1, 1.2, 1.3, 1.5, 1.75, 2.0, 2.25, or 2.5 times the first thickness, t1. The second thickness, t2, of thecoil 1130 along the y-axis at the end of the firstmagnet turning section 1010 or similarly at the end ofcentral metal member 1211 is larger than the first thickness, t1, of the shapedcoil 1132 along the x-axis between theyoke members 1212, which allows a current along the x-axis length of thecoil 1130 to be maintained when running along the y-axis as the end of thecoil 1130 as a first cross-sectional area (w1×t1) and a second cross-sectional area (w2×t2) are preferably about equal, such as within less than a 2, 5, 10, or 15 percent different. In practice, the dimension of the first width, w1, optionally tapers into the dimension of the second width, w2, and the dimension of the first thickness, t1, optionally tapers into the second thickness, t2. Optionally, sections of thecoil 1130 are welded together, such as where the length of the coil meets the end of the coil. As illustrated, thegap 1110 runs above thecentral metal member 1211. A top half of a first main bending magnet using an optional flattened magnetic coil system is substantially the same as the herein described bottom half, is rotated one hundred eighty degrees about the x-axis and is positioned above thegap 1110. - Still referring to
FIG. 12 and referring now to only the right side ofFIG. 12 , asecond coil 1134 is illustrated wrapped between twosecond yoke members 1292 and around asecond metal member 1291 in the secondmagnet turning section 1020. The second coil 1131 and its matching top half preferably has the design characteristics of thefirst coil 1132, described herein. - Referring now to
FIGS. 13 and 14 , two illustrative 90 degree rotated cross-sections of single magnet bending or turningsections 1010 are presented. The magnet assembly has afirst magnet 1210 and asecond magnet 1220. A magnetic field induced by coils, described infra, runs between thefirst magnet 1210 to thesecond magnet 1220 across thegap 1110. Return magnetic fields run through afirst yoke 1212 andsecond yoke 1222. The combined cross-section area of the return yokes roughly approximates the cross-sectional area of thefirst magnet 1210 orsecond magnet 1220. The charged particles run through the vacuum tube in thegap 1110. As illustrated, protons run intoFIG. 14 through thegap 1110 and the magnetic field, illustrated as vector B, applies a force F to the protons pushing the protons towards the center of the synchrotron, which is off page to the right inFIG. 14 . The magnetic field is created using windings. A first coil is used to form a first windingcoil 1250 and a second coil of wire is used to form a second windingcoil 1260. Isolating or concentratinggaps gap 1110. Thegap 1110 is approximately flat to yield a uniform magnetic field across thegap 1110, as described supra. - Still referring to
FIG. 13 , the ends of a single bending or turning magnet are preferably beveled. Nearly perpendicular or right angle edges of aturning magnet 1010 are represented by dashedlines 1374, 1384. The dashedlines 1374, 1384 intersect at apoint 1390 beyond the center of thesynchrotron 280. Preferably, the edge of the turning magnet is beveled at angles alpha, α, and beta, β, which are angles formed by afirst line turning magnet 1010 and thecenter 280 and asecond line 1374, 1384 going from the same edge of the turning magnet and theintersecting point 1390. The angle alpha is used to describe the effect and the description of angle alpha applies to angle beta, but angle alpha is optionally different from angle beta. The angle alpha provides an edge focusing effect. Beveling the edge of theturning magnet 1010 at angle alpha focuses the proton beam. - Multiple turning magnets provide multiple magnet edges that each have edge focusing effects in the
synchrotron 130. If only one turning magnet is used, then the beam is only focused once for angle alpha or twice for angle alpha and angle beta. However, by using smaller turning magnets, more turning magnets fit into the turningsections 920 of thesynchrotron 130. For example, if four magnets are used in aturning section 920 of the synchrotron, then for a single turning section there are eight possible edge focusing effect surfaces, two edges per magnet. The eight focusing surfaces yield a smaller cross-sectional beam size, which allows the use of a smaller gap. - The use of multiple edge focusing effects in the turning magnets results in not only a
smaller gap 1110, but also the use of smaller magnets and smaller power supplies. For asynchrotron 130 having four turningsections 920 where each turning sections has four turning magnets and each turning magnet has two focusing edges, a total of thirty-two focusing edges exist for each orbit of the protons in the circulating path of thesynchrotron 130. Similarly, if 2, 6, or 8 magnets are used in a given turning section, or if 2, 3, 5, or 6 turning sections are used, then the number of edge focusing surfaces expands or contracts according toequation 7. -
- where TFE is the number of total focusing edges, NTS is the number of turning sections, M is the number of magnets, and FE is the number of focusing edges. Naturally, not all magnets are necessarily beveled and some magnets are optionally beveled on only one edge.
- The inventors have determined that multiple smaller magnets have benefits over fewer larger magnets. For example, the use of 16 small magnets yields 32 focusing edges whereas the use of 4 larger magnets yields only 8 focusing edges. The use of a synchrotron having more focusing edges results in a circulating path of the synchrotron built without the use of focusing quadrupole magnets. All prior art synchrotrons use quadrupoles in the circulating path of the synchrotron. Further, the use of quadrupoles in the circulating path necessitates additional straight sections in the circulating path of the synchrotron. Thus, the use of quadrupoles in the circulating path of a synchrotron results in synchrotrons having larger diameters, larger circulating beam pathlengths, and/or larger circumferences.
- In various embodiments of the system described herein, the synchrotron has any combination of:
-
- at least four and preferably six, eight, ten, or more edge focusing edges per 90 degrees of turn of the charged particle beam in a synchrotron having four turning sections;
- at least about sixteen and preferably about twenty-four, thirty-two, or more edge focusing edges per orbit of the charged particle beam in the synchrotron;
- only four turning sections where each of the turning sections includes at least four and preferably eight edge focusing edges;
- an equal number of straight sections and turning sections;
- exactly four turning sections;
- at least four focusing edges per turning section;
- no quadrupoles in the circulating path of the synchrotron;
- a rounded corner rectangular polygon configuration;
- a circumference of less than sixty meters;
- a circumference of less than sixty meters and thirty-two edge focusing surfaces; and/or
- any of about eight, sixteen, twenty-four, or thirty-two non-quadrupole magnets per circulating path of the synchrotron, where the non-quadrupole magnets include edge focusing edges.
- While the gap surface is described in terms of the
first turning magnet 1010, the discussion applies to each of the turning magnets in the synchrotron. Similarly, while thegap 1110 surface is described in terms of the magneticfield incident surface 1270, the discussion additionally optionally applies to the magneticfield exiting surface 1280. - Referring again to
FIG. 12 , the incidentmagnetic field surface 1270 of thefirst magnet 1210 is further described.FIG. 12 is not to scale and is illustrative in nature. Local imperfections or unevenness in quality of the finish of theincident surface 1270 results in inhomogeneities or imperfections in the magnetic field applied to thegap 1110. The magneticfield incident surface 1270 and/or exitingsurface 1280 of thefirst magnet 1210 is preferably about flat, such as to within about a zero to three micron finish polish or less preferably to about a ten micron finish polish. By being very flat, the polished surface spreads the unevenness of the applied magnetic field across thegap 1110. The very flat surface, such as about 0, 1, 2, 4, 6, 8, 10, 15, or 20 micron finish, allows for a smaller gap size, a smaller applied magnetic field, smaller power supplies, and tighter control of the proton beam cross-sectional area. - Referring now to
FIG. 14 , additional optional magnet elements, of the magnet cross-section illustratively represented inFIG. 12 , are described. Thefirst magnet 1210 preferably contains an initialcross-sectional distance 1410 of the iron based core. The contours of the magnetic field are shaped by themagnets yokes cross-sectional distance 1420. The shape of themagnetic field vector 1440 is illustrative only. The magnetic field in the magnet preferentially stays in the iron based core as opposed to thegaps cross-sectional distance 1410 to the finalcross-sectional distance 1420, the magnetic field concentrates. The change in shape of the magnet from thelonger distance 1410 to thesmaller distance 1420 acts as an amplifier. The concentration of the magnetic field is illustrated by representing an initial density ofmagnetic field vectors 1430 in theinitial cross-section 1410 to a concentrated density ofmagnetic field vectors 1440 in thefinal cross-section 1420. The concentration of the magnetic field due to the geometry of the turning magnets results in fewer windingcoils - In one example, the
initial cross-section distance 1410 is about fifteen centimeters and thefinal cross-section distance 1420 is about ten centimeters. Using the provided numbers, the concentration of the magnetic field is about 15/10 or 1.5 times at theincident surface 1270 of thegap 1110, though the relationship is not linear. Thetaper 1460 has a slope, such as about twenty, forty, or sixty degrees. The concentration of the magnetic field, such as by 1.5 times, leads to a corresponding decrease in power consumption requirements to the magnets. - Referring now to
FIG. 15 , an additional example of geometry of the magnet used to concentrate the magnetic field is illustrated. As illustrated inFIG. 14 , thefirst magnet 1210 preferably contains an initialcross-sectional distance 1410 of the iron based core. The contours of the magnetic field are shaped by themagnets yokes cross-sectional distance 1420 with a smaller angle theta, θ. As described, supra, the magnetic field in the magnet preferentially stays in the iron based core as opposed to thegaps cross-sectional distance 1410 to the finalcross-sectional distance 1420, the magnetic field concentrates. The smaller angle, theta, results in a greater amplification of the magnetic field in going from thelonger distance 1410 to thesmaller distance 1420. The concentration of the magnetic field is illustrated by representing an initial density ofmagnetic field vectors 1430 in theinitial cross-section 1410 to a concentrated density ofmagnetic field vectors 1440 in thefinal cross-section 1420. The concentration of the magnetic field due to the geometry of the turning magnets results in fewer windingcoils coils - Still referring to
FIG. 15 ,optional correction coils coils coils coils - Referring now to
FIG. 16 , an example of windingcoils 1630 andcorrection coils 1620 about a plurality of turningmagnets beam turning section 920 is illustrated. The winding coils preferably cover 1, 2, or 4 turning magnets. One or more high precisionmagnetic field sensors 1650 are placed into the synchrotron and are used to measure the magnetic field at or near the proton beam path. For example, the magnetic sensors are optionally placed between turning magnets and/or within a turning magnet, such as at or near thegap 1110 or at or near the magnet core or yoke. The sensors are part of a feedback system to the correction coils, which is optionally run by the main controller. Thus, the system preferably stabilizes the magnetic field in the synchrotron rather than stabilizing the current applied to the magnets. Stabilization of the magnetic field allows the synchrotron to come to a new energy level quickly. This allows the system to be controlled to an operator or algorithm selected energy level with each pulse of the synchrotron and/or with each breath of the patient. - The winding and/or correction coils correct one, two, three, or four turning magnets, and preferably correct a magnetic field generated by two turning magnets. Optionally, a
correction coil 1640 winds asingle magnet section 1010 or acorrection coil 1620 winds two or moremagnet turning sections -
Space 1160 at the end of aturning magnets - Referring now to
FIG. 17A andFIG. 17B , theaccelerator system 270, such as a radio-frequency (RF) accelerator system, is further described. The accelerator includes a series of coils 1710-1719, such as iron or ferrite coils, each circumferentially enclosing thevacuum system 320 through which theproton beam 264 passes in thesynchrotron 130. Referring now toFIG. 17B , thefirst coil 1710 is further described. A loop ofstandard wire 1730 completes at least one turn about thefirst coil 1710. The loop attaches to amicrocircuit 1720. Referring again toFIG. 17A , anRF synthesizer 1740, which is preferably connected to themain controller 110, provides a low voltage RF signal that is synchronized to the period of circulation of protons in theproton beam path 264. TheRF synthesizer 1740,microcircuit 1720,loop 1730, andcoil 1710 combine to provide an accelerating voltage to the protons in theproton beam path 264. For example, theRF synthesizer 1740 sends a signal to themicrocircuit 1720, which amplifies the low voltage RF signal and yields an acceleration voltage, such as about 10 volts. The actual acceleration voltage for a single microcircuit/loop/coil combination is about five, ten, fifteen, or twenty volts, but is preferably about ten volts. Preferably, the RF-amplifier microcircuit and accelerating coil are integrated. - Still referring to
FIG. 17A , the integrated RF-amplifier microcircuit and accelerating coil presented inFIG. 17B is repeated, as illustrated as the set of coils 1711-1719 surrounding thevacuum tube 320. For example, the RF-synthesizer 1740, undermain controller 130 direction, sends an RF-signal to the microcircuits 1720-1729 connected to coils 1710-1719, respectively. Each of the microcircuit/loop/coil combinations generates a proton accelerating voltage, such as about ten volts each. Hence, a set of five coil combinations generates about fifty volts for proton acceleration. Preferably about five to twenty microcircuit/loop/coil combinations are used and more preferably about nine or ten microcircuit/loop/coil combinations are used in theaccelerator system 270. - As a further clarifying example, the
RF synthesizer 1740 sends an RF-signal, with a period equal to a period of circulation of a proton about thesynchrotron 130, to a set of ten microcircuit/loop/coil combinations, which results in about 100 volts for acceleration of the protons in theproton beam path 264. The 100 volts is generated at a range of frequencies, such as at about one MHz for a low energy proton beam to about fifteen MHz for a high energy proton beam. The RF-signal is optionally set at an integer multiple of a period of circulation of the proton about the synchrotron circulating path. Each of the microcircuit/loop/coil combinations are optionally independently controlled in terms of acceleration voltage and frequency. - Integration of the RF-amplifier microcircuit and accelerating coil, in each microcircuit/loop/coil combination, results in three considerable advantages. First, for synchrotrons, the prior art does not use microcircuits integrated with the accelerating coils but rather uses a set of long cables to provide power to a corresponding set of coils. The long cables have an impedance/resistance, which is problematic for high frequency RF control. As a result, the prior art system is not operable at high frequencies, such as above about ten MHz. The integrated RF-amplifier microcircuit/accelerating coil system is operable at above about ten MHz and even fifteen MHz where the impedance and/or resistance of the long cables in the prior art systems results in poor control or failure in proton acceleration. Second, the long cable system, operating at lower frequencies, costs about $50,000 and the integrated microcircuit system costs about $1000, which is fifty times less expensive. Third, the microcircuit/loop/coil combinations in conjunction with the RF-amplifier system results in a compact low power consumption design allowing production and use of a proton cancer therapy system in a small space, as described supra, and in a cost effective manner.
- Referring again to
FIG. 16 , an example of a windingcoil 1630 that covers two turningmagnets coil 1640 covers twomagnets magnets first correction coil 1640 is illustrated that is used to correct the magnetic field for thefirst turning magnet 1010. Asecond correction coil 1620 is illustrated that is used to correct the magnetic field for a windingcoil 1630 about two turning magnets. Individual correction coils for each turning magnet are preferred and individual correction coils yield the most precise and/or accurate magnetic field in each turning section. Particularly, an individual correction coil is preferably used to compensate for imperfections in the individual magnet of a given turning section. Hence, with a series of magnetic field sensors, corresponding magnetic fields are individually adjustable in a series of feedback loops, via a magnetic field monitoring system, as an independent coil is used for each turning section. Alternatively, a multiple magnet correction coil is used to correct the magnetic field for a plurality of turning section magnets. - Referring now to
FIG. 18A , an exemplary protonbeam extraction process 1800 from thesynchrotron 130 is illustrated. For clarity,FIG. 18 removes elements represented inFIG. 2 , such as the turning magnets, which allows for greater clarity of presentation of the proton beam path as a function of time. Generally, protons are extracted from thesynchrotron 130 by slowing the protons. As described, supra, the protons were initially accelerated in a circulatingpath 264, which is maintained with a plurality ofmain bending magnets 250. The circulating path is referred to herein as an originalcentral beamline 264. The protons repeatedly cycle around a central point in thesynchrotron 280. The proton path traverses through a radio frequency (RF)cavity system 1910. To initiate extraction, an RF field is applied across afirst blade 1912 and asecond blade 1914, in theRF cavity system 1910. Thefirst blade 1912 andsecond blade 1914 are referred to herein as a first pair of blades. - In the proton extraction process, an RF voltage is applied across the first pair of blades, where the
first blade 1912 of the first pair of blades is on one side of the circulatingproton beam path 264 and thesecond blade 1914 of the first pair of blades is on an opposite side of the circulatingproton beam path 264. The applied RF field applies energy to the circulating charged-particle beam. The applied RF field alters the orbiting or circulating beam path slightly of the protons from the originalcentral beamline 264 to an altered circulatingbeam path 265. Upon a second pass of the protons through the RF cavity system, the RF field further moves the protons off of theoriginal proton beamline 264. For example, if the original beamline is considered as a circular path, then the altered beamline is slightly elliptical. The applied RF field is timed to apply outward or inward movement to a given band of protons circulating in the synchrotron accelerator. Each orbit of the protons is slightly more off axis compared to the original circulatingbeam path 264. Successive passes of the protons through the RF cavity system are forced further and further from the originalcentral beamline 264 by altering the direction and/or intensity of the RF field with each successive pass of the proton beam through the RF field. - The RF voltage is frequency modulated at a frequency about equal to the period of one proton cycling around the synchrotron for one revolution or at a frequency than is an integral multiplier of the period of one proton cycling about the synchrotron. The applied RF frequency modulated voltage excites a betatron oscillation. For example, the oscillation is a sine wave motion of the protons. The process of timing the RF field to a given proton beam within the RF cavity system is repeated thousands of times with each successive pass of the protons being moved approximately one micrometer further off of the original
central beamline 264. For clarity, the approximately 1000 changing beam paths with each successive path of a given band of protons through the RF field are illustrated as the alteredbeam path 265. - With a sufficient sine wave betatron amplitude, the altered circulating
beam path 265 touches and/or traverses amaterial 1930, such as a foil or a sheet of foil. The foil is preferably a lightweight material, such as beryllium, a lithium hydride, a carbon sheet, or a material having low nuclear charge components. Herein, a material of low nuclear charge is a material composed of atoms consisting essentially of atoms having six or fewer protons. The foil is preferably about 10 to 150 microns thick, is more preferably about 30 to 100 microns thick, and is still more preferably about 40 to 60 microns thick. In one example, the foil is beryllium with a thickness of about 50 microns. When the protons traverse through the foil, energy of the protons is lost and the speed of the protons is reduced. Typically, a current is also generated, described infra. Protons moving at a slower speed travel in the synchrotron with a reduced radius ofcurvature 266 compared to either the originalcentral beamline 264 or the altered circulatingpath 265. The reduced radius ofcurvature 266 path is also referred to herein as a path having a smaller diameter of trajectory or a path having protons with reduced energy. The reduced radius ofcurvature 266 is typically about two millimeters less than a radius of curvature of the last pass of the protons along the alteredproton beam path 265. - The thickness of the
material 1930 is optionally adjusted to created a change in the radius of curvature, such as about ½, 1, 2, 3, or 4 mm less than the last pass of theprotons 265 or original radius ofcurvature 264. Protons moving with the smaller radius of curvature travel between a second pair of blades. In one case, the second pair of blades is physically distinct and/or is separated from the first pair of blades. In a second case, one of the first pair of blades is also a member of the second pair of blades. For example, the second pair of blades is thesecond blade 1914 and athird blade 1916 in theRF cavity system 1910. A high voltage DC signal, such as about 1 to 5 kV, is then applied across the second pair of blades, which directs the protons out of the synchrotron through anextraction magnet 292, such as a Lambertson extraction magnet, into atransport path 268. - Still referring to
FIG. 18A , in one example, thematerial 1930 is a set of foils with different foils having different thicknesses. For example, afirst foil 1932 has a thickness less than a thickness of asecond foil 1934 and thesecond foil 1934 has a thickness less than a thickness of athird foil 1936. Each of thefoils material 1930, described supra. The energy of the charged particles in the altered circulatingbeam path 265 is preferably in the range of about 70 to 250 MeV. Optionally, a thinner extraction foil is used in the extraction system with lower energy charged particles and a thicker foil is used in theextraction system 1800 with higher energy charged particles. For example, thefirst foil 1932 having a thickness of about 30 to 70 micrometers and preferably about 50 micrometers is used in the extraction of charged particles having energy of about 70 to 150 MeV, thesecond foil 1934 having a thickness of about 60 to 140 micrometers and preferably about 100 micrometers is used in the extraction of charged particles having energy of about 150 to 200 MeV, and the third foil having a thickness of about 150 to 250 micrometers and preferably about 200 micrometers is used in the extraction of charged particles having energy of about 70 to 150 MeV. Any number of foils are optionally used. Similarly, various members of the set of foils have varying densities. For example, a second foil has a density about 110, 120, 130, 150, 200, or 300 percent of a density of a first foil. For a given thickness, the denser foil is used in extraction of higher energy charged particles. Similarly, the foils vary in both density and thickness. - Still referring to
FIG. 18A , each of thefoils particle beam path 264 prior to and/or in the process of charged particle extraction, such as with one or more actuators. Preferably, the foil actuated toward the circulatingbeam path 264 is selected to have a larger thickness as a function of higher energy of the charged particles in the beam path, as described infra. - Referring now to
FIG. 18B andFIG. 18C , in use a thinner foil, such as thefirst foil 1932, is used for lower energy levels, such as depicted by E1 to traverse a short distance through apatient 2130 or a short distance through tissue to atumor 2120. Similarly, in use a medium thickness foil, such as thesecond foil 1934, is used for medium levels of energy of the charged particles, such as depicted by E2 to traverse a medium distance through apatient 2130 or a medium distance through tissue to thetumor 2120. Further, in use a thicker foil, such as thethird foil 1936, is used for higher energy levels charged particles, such as depicted by E3 to traverse a larger distance through apatient 2130 or a larger distance through tissue to thetumor 2120. - Control of acceleration of the charged particle beam path in the synchrotron with the accelerator and/or applied fields of the turning magnets in combination with the above described extraction system allows for control of the intensity of the extracted proton beam, where intensity is a proton flux per unit time or the number of protons extracted as a function of time. For example, when a current is measured beyond a threshold, the RF field modulation in the RF cavity system is terminated or reinitiated to establish a subsequent cycle of proton beam extraction. This process is repeated to yield many cycles of proton beam extraction from the synchrotron accelerator.
- In another embodiment, instead of moving the charged particles to the
material 1930, thematerial 1930 is mechanically moved to the circulating charged particles. Particularly, thematerial 1930 is mechanically or electromechanically translated into the path of the circulating charged particles to induce the extraction process, described supra. - In either case, because the extraction system does not depend on any change in magnetic field properties, it allows the synchrotron to continue to operate in acceleration or deceleration mode during the extraction process. Stated differently, the extraction process does not interfere with synchrotron acceleration. In stark contrast, traditional extraction systems introduce a new magnetic field, such as via a hexapole, during the extraction process. More particularly, traditional synchrotrons have a magnet, such as a hexapole magnet, that is off during an acceleration stage. During the extraction phase, the hexapole magnetic field is introduced to the circulating path of the synchrotron. The introduction of the magnetic field necessitates two distinct modes, an acceleration mode and an extraction mode, which are mutually exclusive in time. The herein described system allows for acceleration and/or deceleration of the proton during the extraction step without the use of a newly introduced magnetic field, such as by a hexapole magnet.
- Control of applied field, such as a radio-frequency (RF) field, frequency and magnitude in the
RF cavity system 1910 allows for intensity control of the extracted proton beam, where intensity is extracted proton flux per unit time or the number of protons extracted as a function of time. - Referring now to
FIG. 19 , anintensity control system 1900 is illustrated. In this example, an intensity control feedback loop is added to the extraction system, described supra. When protons in the proton beam hit thematerial 1930 electrons are given off resulting in a current. The resulting current is converted to a voltage and is used as part of a ion beam intensity monitoring system or as part of an ion beam feedback loop for controlling beam intensity. The voltage is optionally measured and sent to themain controller 110 or to anintensity controller subsystem 1940, which is preferably in communication or under the direction of themain controller 110. More particularly, when protons in the charged particle beam path pass through thematerial 1930, some of the protons lose a small fraction of their energy, such as about one-tenth of a percent, which results in a secondary electron. That is, protons in the charged particle beam push some electrons when passing throughmaterial 1930 giving the electrons enough energy to cause secondary emission. The resulting electron flow results in a current or signal that is proportional to the number of protons going through thetarget material 1930. The resulting current is preferably converted to voltage and amplified. The resulting signal is referred to as a measured intensity signal. - The amplified signal or measured intensity signal resulting from the protons passing through the
material 1930 is optionally used in monitoring the intensity of the extracted protons and is preferably used in controlling the intensity of the extracted protons. For example, the measured intensity signal is compared to a goal signal, which is predetermined in an irradiation of the tumor plan. The difference between the measured intensity signal and the planned for goal signal is calculated. The difference is used as a control to the RF generator. Hence, the measured flow of current resulting from the protons passing through thematerial 1930 is used as a control in the RF generator to increase or decrease the number of protons undergoing betatron oscillation and striking thematerial 1930. Hence, the voltage determined off of thematerial 1930 is used as a measure of the orbital path and is used as a feedback control to control the RF cavity system. - In one example, the
intensity controller subsystem 1940 preferably additionally receives input from: (1) adetector 1950, which provides a reading of the actual intensity of the proton beam and (2) anirradiation plan 1960. The irradiation plan provides the desired intensity of the proton beam for each x, y, energy, and/or rotational position of the patient/tumor as a function of time. Thus, theintensity controller 1940 receives the desired intensity from theirradiation plan 1950, the actual intensity from thedetector 1950 and/or a measure of intensity from thematerial 1930, and adjusts the radio-frequency field in theRF cavity system 1910 to yield an intensity of the proton beam that matches the desired intensity from theirradiation plan 1960. - As described, supra, the photons striking the
material 1930 is a step in the extraction of the protons from thesynchrotron 130. Hence, the measured intensity signal is used to change the number of protons per unit time being extracted, which is referred to as intensity of the proton beam. The intensity of the proton beam is thus under algorithm control. Further, the intensity of the proton beam is controlled separately from the velocity of the protons in thesynchrotron 130. Hence, intensity of the protons extracted and the energy of the protons extracted are independently variable. - For example, protons initially move at an equilibrium trajectory in the
synchrotron 130. An RF field is used to excite the protons into a betatron oscillation. In one case, the frequency of the protons orbit is about 10 MHz. In one example, in about one millisecond or after about 10,000 orbits, the first protons hit an outer edge of thetarget material 130. The specific frequency is dependent upon the period of the orbit. Upon hitting thematerial 130, the protons push electrons through the foil to produce a current. The current is converted to voltage and amplified to yield a measured intensity signal. The measured intensity signal is used as a feedback input to control the applied RF magnitude, RF frequency, or RF field. Preferably, the measured intensity signal is compared to a target signal and a measure of the difference between the measured intensity signal and target signal is used to adjust the applied RF field in theRF cavity system 1910 in the extraction system to control the intensity of the protons in the extraction step. Stated again, the signal resulting from the protons striking and/or passing through thematerial 130 is used as an input in RF field modulation. An increase in the magnitude of the RF modulation results in protons hitting the foil ormaterial 130 sooner. By increasing the RF, more protons are pushed into the foil, which results in an increased intensity, or more protons per unit time, of protons extracted from thesynchrotron 130. - In another example, a
detector 1950 external to thesynchrotron 130 is used to determine the flux of protons extracted from the synchrotron and a signal from the external detector is used to alter the RF field or RF modulation in theRF cavity system 1910. Here the external detector generates an external signal, which is used in a manner similar to the measured intensity signal, described in the preceding paragraphs. Preferably, an algorithm orirradiation plan 1960 is used as an input to theintensity controller 1940, which controls the RF field modulation by directing the RF signal in the betatron oscillation generation in theRF cavity system 1910. Theirradiation plan 1960 preferably includes the desired intensity of the charged particle beam as a function of time, energy of the charged particle beam as a function of time, for each patient rotation position, and/or for each x-, y-position of the charged particle beam. - In yet another example, when a current from
material 130 resulting from protons passing through or hitting material is measured beyond a threshold, the RF field modulation in the RF cavity system is terminated or reinitiated to establish a subsequent cycle of proton beam extraction. This process is repeated to yield many cycles of proton beam extraction from the synchrotron accelerator. - In still yet another embodiment, intensity modulation of the extracted proton beam is controlled by the
main controller 110. Themain controller 110 optionally and/or additionally controls timing of extraction of the charged particle beam and energy of the extracted proton beam. - The benefits of the system include a multi-dimensional scanning system. Particularly, the system allows independence in: (1) energy of the protons extracted and (2) intensity of the protons extracted. That is, energy of the protons extracted is controlled by an energy control system and an intensity control system controls the intensity of the extracted protons. The energy control system and intensity control system are optionally independently controlled. Preferably, the
main controller 110 controls the energy control system and themain controller 110 simultaneously controls the intensity control system to yield an extracted proton beam with controlled energy and controlled intensity where the controlled energy and controlled intensity are independently variable. Thus the irradiation spot hitting the tumor is under independent control of: -
- time;
- energy;
- intensity;
- x-axis position, where the x-axis represents horizontal movement of the proton beam relative to the patient, and
- y-axis position, where the y-axis represents vertical movement of the proton beam relative to the patient.
- In addition, the patient is optionally independently translated and/or rotated relative to a translational axis of the proton beam at the same time.
- Referring now to
FIGS. 20 A and B, a proton beamposition verification system 2000 is described. Anozzle 2010 provides an outlet for the second reduced pressure vacuum system initiating at thefoil 395 of thetandem accelerator 390 and running through thesynchrotron 130 to anozzle foil 2020 covering the end of thenozzle 2010. The nozzle expands in x-, y-cross-sectional area along the z-axis of theproton beam path 268 to allow theproton beam 268 to be scanned along the x- and y-axes by thevertical control element 142 andhorizontal control element 144, respectively. Thenozzle foil 2020 is preferably mechanically supported by the outer edges of an exit port of thenozzle 2010. An example of anozzle foil 2020 is a sheet of about 0.1 inch thick aluminum foil. Generally, the nozzle foil separates atmosphere pressures on the patient side of thenozzle foil 2020 from the low pressure region, such as about 10−5 to 10−7 torr region, on thesynchrotron 130 side of thenozzle foil 2020. The low pressure region is maintained to reduce scattering of theproton beam - Still referring to
FIG. 20 , the protonbeam verification system 2000 is a system that allows for monitoring of the actualproton beam position beam verification system 2000 preferably includes a proton beamposition verification layer 2030, which is also referred to herein as a coating, luminescent, fluorescent, phosphorescent, radiance, or viewing layer. The verification layer orcoating layer 2030 is preferably a coating or thin layer substantially in contact with an inside surface of thenozzle foil 2020, where the inside surface is on the synchrotron side of thenozzle foil 2020. Less preferably, the verification layer orcoating layer 2030 is substantially in contact with an outer surface of thenozzle foil 2020, where the outer surface is on the patient treatment side of thenozzle foil 2020. Preferably, thenozzle foil 2020 provides a substrate surface for coating by the coating layer. Optionally, a binding layer is located between thecoating layer 2030 and thenozzle foil 2020. Optionally a separate coating layer support element, on which thecoating 2030 is mounted, is placed anywhere in theproton beam path 268. - Referring now to
FIG. 20B , thecoating 2030 yields a measurable spectroscopic response, spatially viewable by aposition dosage detector 2040 or dosage detector camera, as a result of transmission by theproton beam 268. Thecoating 2030 is preferably a phosphor, but is optionally any material that is viewable or imaged by a detector where the material changes spectroscopically as a result of theproton beam path 268 hitting or transmitting through thecoating 2030. A detector or camera views thecoating layer 2030 and determines the current position of the chargedparticle beam 269 by the spectroscopic differences resulting from protons passing through the coating layer. For example, theposition dosage detector 2040 views thecoating surface 2030 as theproton beam 268 is being scanned by the horizontal 144 and vertical 142 beam position control elements during treatment of thetumor 2120. Thus, theposition dosage detector 2040 is optionally used to determine radiation dosage as a function of tumor position, such as the x-, y-position. Theposition dosage detector 2040 views the current position of the chargedparticle beam 269 as measured by spectroscopic response. Thecoating layer 2030 is preferably a phosphor or luminescent material that glows or emits photons for a short period of time, such as less than 5 seconds for a 50% intensity, as a result of excitation by theproton beam 268. Optionally, a plurality of cameras or detector are used, where each detector views all or a portion of thecoating layer 2030. For example, two detectors are used where a first detector views a first half of the coating layer and the second detector views a second half of the coating layer. Preferably, at least a portion of theposition dosage detector 2040 is mounted into thenozzle 2010 to view the proton beam position after passing through the first axis andsecond axis controllers coating layer 2030 is positioned in theproton beam path 268 in a position prior to the protons striking thepatient 2130. - Still referring to
FIG. 20B , ascintillation plate 2050 is optionally positioned in the charged particle beam path, such as within thevacuum chamber 320. Preferably, thescintillation plate 2050 is thin to allow transmission of the charged particles, such as less than about 1, 2, 3, 5, 10, 20, 50, or 100 micrometers. Preferably, the scintillation plate is about 2.5 micrometers thick. Ascintillation intensity detector 2054 views photons generated by the charged particles striking thescintillation plate 2050 and generates a corresponding scintillation intensity. The scintillation intensity is proportional or related to the charged particle beam intensity. One ormore scintillation optics 2052 optionally optically couple thescintillation plate 2050 to thescintillation detector 2054. Preferably, thescintillation plate 2050/scintillation detector 2054, which measures charged particle beam intensity, is used in combination with thecoating layer 2030/position dosage detector 2040, which measures positional dosage of the charge particle beam. Preferably output from one or both of theposition dosage detector 2040 and thescintillation detector 2054 is provided to themain controller 110, such as for feedback control of the charged particle beam generation, energy, intensity, and/or position. - Still referring to
FIG. 20B , themain controller 130, connected to the camera orposition dosage detector 2040 output, compares the actual chargedparticle beam position 269 with the planned proton beam position and/or a calibration reference to determine if the actual chargedparticle beam position 269 is within tolerance. The protonbeam verification system 2000 preferably is used in at least two phases, a calibration phase and a proton beam treatment phase. The calibration phase is used to correlate, as a function of x-, y-position of the glowing response the actual x-, y-position of the proton beam at the patient interface. During the proton beam treatment phase, the proton beam position is monitored and compared to the calibration and/or treatment plan to verify accurate proton delivery to thetumor 2120 and/or as a proton beam shutoff safety indicator. - Referring now to
FIG. 21 , the patient is preferably positioned on or within apatient positioning system 2110 that translates, rotates, and/or positions thepatient 2130. Thepatient positioning system 2110 is used to translate the patient and/or rotate the patient into a zone where the proton beam or charged particle beam may scan the tumor using ascanning system 140 or proton targeting system, described infra. Essentially, thepatient positioning system 2110 performs large movements of the patient to place the tumor near the center of aproton beam path 268 and the proton scanning or targetingsystem 140 performs fine movements of themomentary beam position 269 in targeting thetumor 2120. To illustrate,FIG. 21A shows the momentaryproton beam position 269 and a range ofscannable positions 2140 using the proton scanning or targetingsystem 140, where thescannable positions 2140 are about thetumor 2120 of thepatient 2130. In this example, the scannable positions are scanned along the x- and y-axes; however, scanning is optionally simultaneously performed along the z-axis as described infra. This illustratively shows that the y-axis movement of the patient occurs on a scale of the body, such as adjustment of about 1, 2, 3, or 4 feet, while the scannable region of theproton beam 268 covers a portion of the body, such as a region of about 1, 2, 4, 6, 8, 10, or 12 inches. The patient positioning system and its rotation and/or translation of the patient combines with the proton targeting system to yield precise and/or accurate delivery of the protons to the tumor. - Referring still to
FIG. 21 , thepatient positioning system 2110 optionally includes abottom unit 2112 and atop unit 2114, such as discs or a platform. Referring now toFIG. 21A , thepatient positioning system 2110 is preferably y-axis adjustable 2116 to allow vertical shifting of the patient relative to theproton therapy beam 268. Preferably, the vertical motion of thepatient positioning system 2110 is about 10, 20, 30, or 50 centimeters per minute. Referring now toFIG. 21B , thepatient positioning system 2110 is also preferably rotatable 2117 about a rotation axis, such as about the y-axis running through the center of thebottom unit 2112 or about a y-axis running through thetumor 2120, to allow rotational control and positioning of the patient relative to theproton beam path 268. Preferably the rotational motion of thepatient positioning system 2110 is about 360 degrees per minute. Optionally, thepatient positioning system 2110 rotates about 45, 90, or 180 degrees. Optionally, thepatient positioning system 2110 rotates at a rate of about 45, 90, 180, 360, 720, or 1080 degrees per minute. The rotation of thepositioning unit 2117 is illustrated about the rotation axis at two distinct times, t1 and t2. Protons are optionally delivered to thetumor 2120 at n times where each of the n times represent a different relative direction of theincident proton beam 269 hitting thepatient 2130 due to rotation of thepatient 2117 about the rotation axis. - Any of the semi-vertical, sitting, or laying patient positioning embodiments described, infra, are optionally vertically translatable along the y-axis or rotatable about the rotation or y-axis.
- Preferably, the top and
bottom units bottom units bottom units bottom units proton beam path 269, such as below thebottom unit 2112 and/or above thetop unit 2114. This is preferable as thepatient positioning system 2110 is preferably rotatable about 360 degrees and the motors, power supplies, and mechanical assemblies interfere with the protons if positioned in theproton beam path 269 - Referring now to
FIG. 22 , a commonX-ray distribution profile 2210, a protonion distribution profile 2220, and a carbon ion distribution profile 2310 is presented. As shown, X-rays deposit their highest dose near the surface of the targeted tissue and then deposited doses exponentially decrease as a function of tissue depth. The deposition of X-ray energy near the surface is non-ideal for tumors located deep within the body, which is usually the case, as excessive damage is done to the soft tissue layers surrounding thetumor 2120. The advantage of protons is that they deposit most of their energy near the end of the flight trajectory as the energy loss per unit path of the absorber traversed by a proton increases with decreasing particle velocity, giving rise to a sharp maximum in ionization near the end of the range, referred to herein as the Bragg peak. Furthermore, since the flight trajectory of the protons is variable by increasing or decreasing the initial kinetic energy or initial velocity of the proton, then the peak corresponding to maximum energy is movable within the tissue. Thus z-axis control of the proton depth of penetration is allowed by the acceleration/extraction process, described supra. As a result of proton dose-distribution characteristics, using the algorithm described, infra, a radiation oncologist can optimize dosage to thetumor 2120 while minimizing dosage to surrounding normal tissues. The use of heavier ions, such as carbon ions and/or C6 +, yields: (1) a smaller dose delivery percentage in lead-in healthy tissue, (2) a sharper in tumor dose delivery profile, and/or (3) a more rapid fall off in dose delivery at the Bragg limit due to atomic cross-sectional area. - Herein, the term ingress refers to a place charged particles enter into the
patient 2130 or a place of charged particles entering thetumor 2120. The ingress region of the Bragg energy profile refers to the relatively flat dose delivery portion at shallow depths of the Bragg energy profile. Similarly, herein the terms proximal or the clause proximal region refer to the shallow depth region of the tissue that receives the relatively flat radiation dose delivery portion of the delivered Bragg profile energy. Herein, the term distal refers to the back portion of the tumor located furthest away from the point of origin where the charged particles enter the tumor. In terms of the Bragg energy profile, the Bragg peak is at the distal point of the profile. Herein, the term ventral refers to the front of the patient and the term dorsal refers to the back of the patient. As an example of use, when delivering protons to a tumor in the body, the protons ingress through the healthy tissue and if delivered to the far side of the tumor, the Bragg peak occurs at the distal side of the tumor. For a case where the proton energy is not sufficient to reach the far side of the tumor, the distal point of the Bragg energy profile is the region of furthest penetration into the tumor. - The Bragg peak energy profile shows that protons deliver their energy across the entire length of the body penetrated by the proton up to a maximum penetration depth. As a result, energy is being delivered, in the proximal portion of the Bragg peak energy profile, to healthy tissue, bone, and other body constituents before the proton beam hits the tumor. It follows that the shorter the pathlength in the body prior to the tumor, the higher the efficiency of proton delivery efficiency, where proton delivery efficiency is a measure of how much energy is delivered to the tumor relative to healthy portions of the patient. Examples of proton delivery efficiency include: (1) a ratio of proton energy delivered to the tumor over proton energy delivered to non-tumor tissue; (2) pathlength of protons in the tumor versus pathlength in the non-tumor tissue; and/or (3) damage to a tumor compared to damage to healthy body parts. Any of these measures are optionally weighted by damage to sensitive tissue, such as a nervous system element, heart, brain, or other organ. To illustrate, for a patient in a laying position where the patient is rotated about the y-axis during treatment, a tumor near the heart would at times be treated with protons running through the head-to-heart path, leg-to-heart path, or hip-to-heart path, which are all inefficient compared to a patient in a sitting or semi-vertical position where the protons are all delivered through a shorter chest-to-heart; side-of-body-to-heart, or back-to-heart path. Particularly, compared to a laying position, using a sitting or semi-vertical position of the patient, a shorter pathlength through the body to a tumor is provided to a tumor located in the torso or head, which results in a higher or better proton delivery efficiency.
- Herein proton delivery efficiency is separately described from time efficiency or synchrotron use efficiency, which is a fraction of time that the charged particle beam apparatus is in a tumor treating operation mode.
- Referring now to
FIGS. 23 A-E, x-axis scanning of the proton beam is illustrated while z-axis energy of the proton beam undergoes controlledvariation 2300 to allow irradiation of slices of thetumor 2120. For clarity of presentation, the simultaneous y-axis scanning that is performed is not illustrated. InFIG. 23A , irradiation is commencing with the momentaryproton beam position 269 at the start of a first slice. Referring now toFIG. 23B , the momentary proton beam position is at the end of the first slice. Importantly, during a given slice of irradiation, the proton beam energy is preferably continuously controlled and changed according to the tissue mass and density in front of thetumor 2120. The variation of the proton beam energy to account for tissue density thus allows the beam stopping point, or Bragg peak, to remain inside the tissue slice. The variation of the proton beam energy during scanning or during x-, y-axes scanning is possible due to the acceleration/extraction techniques, described supra, which allow for acceleration of the proton beam during extraction.FIGS. 23C, 23D, and 23E show the momentary proton beam position in the middle of the second slice, two-thirds of the way through a third slice, and after finalizing irradiation from a given direction, respectively. Using this approach, controlled, accurate, and precise delivery of proton irradiation energy to thetumor 2120, to a designated tumor subsection, or to a tumor layer is achieved. Efficiency of deposition of proton energy to tumor, as defined as the ratio of the proton irradiation energy delivered to the tumor relative to the proton irradiation energy delivered to the healthy tissue is further described infra. - It is desirable to maximize efficiency of deposition of protons to the
tumor 2120, as defined by maximizing the ratio of the proton irradiation energy delivered to thetumor 2120 relative to the proton irradiation energy delivered to the healthy tissue. Irradiation from one, two, or three directions into the body, such as by rotating the body about 90 degrees between irradiation sub-sessions results in proton irradiation from the proximal portion of the Bragg peak concentrating into one, two, or three healthy tissue volumes, respectively. It is desirable to further distribute the proximal portion of the Bragg peak energy evenly through the healthy volume tissue surrounding thetumor 2120. - Multi-field irradiation is proton beam irradiation from a plurality of entry points into the body. For example, the
patient 2130 is rotated and the radiation source point is held constant. For example, thepatient 2130 is rotated through 360 degrees and proton therapy is applied from a multitude of angles resulting in the ingress or proximal radiation being circumferentially spread about the tumor yielding enhanced proton irradiation efficiency. In one case, the body is rotated into greater than 3, 5, 10, 15, 20, 25, 30, or 35 positions and proton irradiation occurs with each rotation position. Rotation of the patient is preferably performed using thepatient positioning system 2110 and/or thebottom unit 2112 or disc, described supra. Rotation of thepatient 2130 while keeping thedelivery proton beam 268 in a relatively fixed orientation allows irradiation of thetumor 2120 from multiple directions without use of a new collimator for each direction. Further, as no new setup is required for each rotation position of thepatient 2130, the system allows thetumor 2120 to be treated from multiple directions without reseating or positioning the patient, thereby minimizingtumor 2120 regeneration time, increasing the synchrotrons efficiency, and increasing patient throughput. - The patient is optionally centered on the
bottom unit 2112 or thetumor 2120 is optionally centered on thebottom unit 2112. If the patient is centered on thebottom unit 2112, then the firstaxis control element 142 and secondaxis control element 144 are programmed to compensate for the off central axis of rotation position variation of thetumor 2120. - Referring now to
FIGS. 24 A-E, an example ofmulti-field irradiation 2400 is presented. In this example, five patient rotation positions are illustrated; however, the five rotation positions are discrete rotation positions of about thirty-six rotation positions, where the body is rotated about ten degrees with each position. Referring now toFIG. 24A , a range of irradiation beam positions 269 is illustrated from a first body rotation position, illustrated as thepatient 2130 facing the proton irradiation beam where the tumor receives the bulk of the Bragg profile energy while a firsthealthy volume 2411 is irradiated by the less intense ingress portion of the Bragg profile energy. Referring now toFIG. 24B , thepatient 2130 is rotated about forty degrees and the irradiation is repeated. In the second position, thetumor 2120 again receives the bulk of the irradiation energy and a secondhealthy tissue volume 2412 receives the smaller ingress portion of the Bragg profile energy. Referring now toFIGS. 24 C-E, thepatient 2130 is rotated a total of about 90, 130, and 180 degrees, respectively. For each of the third, fourth, and fifth rotation positions, thetumor 2120 receives the bulk of the irradiation energy and the third, fourth, and fifthhealthy tissue volumes tumor 2120, such as to regions one to five 2411-2415, while along a given axis, at least about 75, 80, 85, 90, or 95 percent of the energy is delivered to thetumor 2120. - For a given rotation position, all or part of the tumor is irradiated. For example, in one embodiment only a distal section or distal slice of the
tumor 2120 is irradiated with each rotation position, where the distal section is a section furthest from the entry point of the proton beam into thepatient 2130. For example, the distal section is the dorsal side of the tumor when thepatient 2130 is facing the proton beam and the distal section is the ventral side of the tumor when thepatient 2130 is facing away from the proton beam. - Referring now to
FIG. 25 , a second example ofmulti-field irradiation 2500 is presented where the proton source is stationary and thepatient 2130 is rotated. For ease of presentation, the stationary but scanningproton beam path 269 is illustrated as entering the patient 2130 from varying sides at times t1, t2, t3, . . . , tn, tn+1 as the patient is rotated. At a first time, t1, the ingress side or proximal region of the Bragg peak profile hits a first area, A1. Again, the proximal end of the Bragg peak profile refers to the relatively shallow depths of tissue where Bragg energy profile energy delivery is relatively flat. The patient is rotated and the proton beam path is illustrated at a second time, t2, where the ingress energy of the Bragg energy profile hits a second area, A2. Thus, the low radiation dosage of the ingress region of the Bragg profile energy is delivered to the second area. At a third time, the ingress end of the Bragg energy profile hits a third area, A3. This rotation and irradiation process is repeated n times, where n is a positive number greater than five and preferably greater than about 10, 20, 30, 100, or 300. As illustrated, at an nth time, tn, if thepatient 2130 is rotated further, thescanning proton beam 269 would hit asensitive body constituent 2150, such as the spinal cord or eyes. Irradiation is preferably suspended until the sensitive body constituent is rotated out of thescanning proton beam 269 path. Irradiation is resumed at a time, tn+1, after thesensitive body constituent 2150 is rotated out of the proton beam path. In this manner: -
- the distal Bragg peak energy is always within the tumor;
- the radiation dose delivery of the distal region of the Bragg energy profile is spread over the tumor;
- the ingress or proximal region of the Bragg energy profile is distributed in healthy tissue about the
tumor 2120; and -
sensitive body constituents 2150 receive minimal or no proton beam irradiation.
- Herein, charged particle or proton delivery efficiency is radiation dose delivered to the tumor compared to radiation dose delivered to the healthy regions of the patient.
- A proton delivery enhancement method is described where proton delivery efficiency is enhanced, optimized, or maximized. In general, multi-field irradiation is used to deliver protons to the tumor from a multitude of rotational directions. From each direction, the energy of the protons is adjusted to target the distal portion of the tumor, where the distal portion of the tumor is the volume of the tumor furthest from the entry point of the proton beam into the body.
- For clarity, the process is described using an example where the outer edges of the tumor are initially irradiated using distally applied radiation through a multitude of rotational positions, such as through 360 degrees. This results in a symbolic or calculated remaining smaller tumor for irradiation. The process is then repeated as many times as necessary on the smaller tumor. However, the presentation is for clarity. In actuality, irradiation from a given rotational angle is performed once with z-axis proton beam energy and intensity being adjusted for the calculated smaller inner tumors during x- and y-axis scanning.
- Referring now to
FIG. 26 , the proton delivery enhancement method is further described. Referring now toFIG. 26A , at a first point in time protons are delivered to thetumor 2120 of the patient 2130 from a first direction. From the first rotational direction, the proton beam is scanned 269 across the tumor. As the proton beam is scanned across the tumor the energy of the proton beam is adjusted to allow the Bragg peak energy to target the distal portion of the tumor. Again, distal refers to the back portion of the tumor located furthest away from where the charged particles enter the tumor. As illustrated, the proton beam is scanned along an x-axis across the patient. This process allows the Bragg peak energy to fall within the tumor, for the middle area of the Bragg peak profile to fall in the middle and proximal portion of the tumor, and for the small intensity ingress portion of the Bragg peak to hit healthy tissue. In this manner, the maximum radiation dose is delivered to the tumor or the proton dose efficiency is maximized for the first rotational direction. - After irradiation from the first rotational position, the patient is rotated to a new rotational position. Referring now to
FIG. 26B , the scanning of the proton beam is repeated. Again, the distal portion of the tumor is targeted with adjustment of the proton beam energy to target the Bragg peak energy to the distal portion of the tumor. Naturally, the distal portion of the tumor for the second rotational position is different from the distal portion of the tumor for the first rotational position. Referring now toFIG. 26C , the process of rotating the patient and then irradiating the new distal portion of the tumor is further illustrated at an nth rotational position. Preferably, the process of rotating the patient and scanning along the x- and y-axes with the Z-axes energy targeting the new distal portion of the tumor is repeated, such as with more than 5, 10, 20, or 30 rotational positions or with about 36 rotational positions. - For clarity,
FIGS. 26A-C andFIG. 26 E show the proton beam as having moved, but in actuality, the proton beam is stationary and the patient is rotated, such as via use of rotating thebottom unit 2112 of thepatient positioning system 2110. Also,FIGS. 26A-C andFIG. 26E show the proton beam being scanned across the tumor along the x-axis. Though not illustrated for clarity, the proton beam is additionally scanned up and down the tumor along the y-axis of the patient. Combined, the distal portion or volume of the tumor is irradiated along the x- and y-axes with adjustment of the z-axis energy level of the proton beam. In one case, the tumor is scanned along the x-axis and the scanning is repeated along the x-axis for multiple y-axis positions. In another case, the tumor is scanned along the y-axis and the scanning is repeated along the y-axis for multiple x-axis positions. In yet another case, the tumor is scanned by simultaneously adjusting the x- and y-axes so that the distal portion of the tumor is targeted. In all of these cases, the z-axis or energy of the proton beam is adjusted along the contour of the distal portion of the tumor to target the Bragg peak energy to the distal portion of the tumor. - Referring now to
FIG. 26D , after targeting the distal portion of the tumor from multiple directions, such as through 360 degrees, theouter tumor perimeter 2122 tumor has been strongly irradiated with peak Bragg profile energy, the middle of the Bragg peak energy profile energy has been delivered along an inner edge of the heavily irradiatedtumor perimeter 2122, and smaller dosages from the ingress portion of the Bragg energy profile are distributed throughout the tumor and into some healthy tissue. The delivered dosages or accumulated radiation flux levels are illustrated in a cross-sectional area of thetumor 2120 using an iso-line plot. After a first full rotation of the patient, symbolically, the darkest regions of the tumor are nearly fully irradiated and the regions of the tissue having received less radiation are illustrated with a gray scale with the whitest portions having the lowest radiation dose. - Referring now to
FIG. 26E , after completing the distal targeting multi-field irradiation, a smaller inner tumor is defined, where the inner tumor is already partially irradiated. The smaller inner tumor is indicated by the dashedline 2630. The above process of irradiating the tumor is repeated for the newly defined smaller tumor. The proton dosages to the outer or distal portions of the smaller tumor are adjusted to account for the dosages delivered from other rotational positions. After the second tumor is irradiated, a yet smaller third tumor is defined. The process is repeated until the entire tumor is irradiated at the prescribed or defined dosage. - As described at the onset of this example, the patient is preferably only rotated to each rotational position once. In the above described example, after irradiation of the
outer tumor perimeter 2122, the patient is rotationally positioned, such as through 360 degrees, and the distal portion of the newest smaller tumor is targeted as described, supra. However, the irradiation dosage to be delivered to the second smaller tumor and each subsequently smaller tumor is known a-priori. Hence, when at a given angle of rotation, the smaller tumor or multiple progressively smaller tumors, are optionally targeted so that the patient is only rotated to the multiple rotational irradiation positions once. - The goal is to deliver a treatment dosage to each position of the tumor, to preferably not exceed the treatment dosage to any position of the tumor, to minimize ingress radiation dosage to healthy tissue, to circumferentially distribute ingress radiation hitting the healthy tissue, and to further minimize ingress radiation dosage to sensitive areas. Since the Bragg energy profile is known, it is possible to calculated the optimal intensity and energy of the proton beam for each rotational position and for each x- and y-axis scanning position. These calculation result in slightly less than threshold radiation dosage to be delivered to the distal portion of the tumor for each rotational position as the ingress dose energy from other positions bring the total dose energy for the targeted position up to the threshold delivery dose.
- Referring again to
FIG. 26A andFIG. 26C , the intensity of the proton beam is preferably adjusted to account for the cross-sectional distance or density of the healthy tissue. An example is used for clarity. Referring now toFIG. 26A , when irradiating from the first position where the healthy tissue has asmall area 2610, the intensity of the proton beam is preferably increased as relatively less energy is delivered by the ingress portion of the Bragg profile to the healthy tissue. Referring now toFIG. 26C , in contrast when irradiating from the nth rotational position where the healthy tissue has a largecross-sectional area 2620, the intensity of the proton beam is preferably decreased as a greater fraction the proton dose is delivered to the healthy tissue from this orientation. - In one example, for each rotational position and/or for each z-axis distance into the tumor, the efficiency of proton dose delivery to the tumor is calculated. The intensity of the proton beam is made proportional to the calculated efficiency. Essentially, when the scanning direction has really good efficiency, the intensity is increased and vise-versa. For example, if the tumor is elongated, generally the efficiency of irradiating the distal portion by going through the length of the tumor is higher than irradiating a distal region of the tumor by going across the tumor with the Bragg energy distribution. Generally, in the optimization algorithm:
-
- distal portions of the tumor are targeted for each rotational position;
- the intensity of the proton beam is largest with the largest cross-sectional area of the tumor;
- intensity is larger when the intervening healthy tissue volume is smallest; and
- intensity is minimized or cut to zero when the intervening healthy tissue volume includes sensitive tissue, such as the spinal cord or eyes.
- Using an algorithm so defined, the efficiency of radiation dose delivery to the tumor is maximized. More particularly, the ratio of radiation dose delivered to the tumor versus the radiation dose delivered to surrounding healthy tissue approaches a maximum. Further, integrated radiation dose delivery to each x, y, and z-axis volume of the tumor as a result of irradiation from multiple rotation directions is at or near the preferred dose level. Still further, ingress radiation dose delivery to healthy tissue is circumferentially distributed about the tumor via use of multi-field irradiation where radiation is delivered from a plurality of directions into the body, such as more than 5, 10, 20, or 30 directions.
- In one multi-field irradiation example, the particle therapy system with a synchrotron ring diameter of less than six meters includes ability to:
-
- rotate the patient through about 360 degrees;
- extract radiation in about 0.1 to 10 seconds;
- scan vertically about 100 millimeters;
- scan horizontally about 700 millimeters;
- vary beam energy from about 30 to 330 MeV/second during irradiation;
- vary the proton beam intensity independently of varying the proton beam energy;
- focus the proton beam with a cross-sectional distance from about 2 to 20 millimeters at the tumor; and/or
- complete multi-field irradiation of a tumor in less than about 1, 2, 4, or 6 minutes as measured from the time of initiating proton delivery to the
patient 2130.
- Two multi-field irradiation methods are described. In the first method, the
main controller 110 rotationally positions thepatient 2130 and subsequently irradiates thetumor 2120. The process is repeated until a multi-field irradiation plan is complete. In the second method, themain controller 110 simultaneously rotates and irradiates thetumor 2120 within thepatient 2130 until the multi-field irradiation plan is complete. More particularly, the proton beam irradiation occurs while thepatient 2130 is being rotated. - The 3-dimensional scanning system of the proton spot focal point, described herein, is preferably combined with a rotation/raster method. The method includes layer wise tumor irradiation from many directions. During a given irradiation slice, the proton beam energy is continuously changed according to the tissue's density in front of the tumor to result in the beam stopping point, defined by the Bragg peak, always being inside the tumor and inside the irradiated slice. The novel method allows for irradiation from many directions, referred to herein as multi-field irradiation, to achieve the maximal effective dose at the tumor level while simultaneously significantly reducing possible side-effects on the surrounding healthy tissues in comparison to existing methods. Essentially, the multi-field irradiation system distributes dose-distribution at tissue depths not yet reaching the tumor.
- Referring now to
FIG. 27A , a beam delivery and tissue volume scanning system is illustrated. Presently, the worldwide radiotherapy community uses a method of dose field forming using a pencil beam scanning system. In stark contrast,FIG. 27 illustrates a spot scanning system or tissue volume scanning system. In the tissue volume scanning system, the proton beam is controlled, in terms of transportation and distribution, using an inexpensive and precise scanning system. The scanning system is an active system, where the beam is focused into a spot focal point of about one-half, one, two, or three millimeters in diameter. The focal point is translated along two axes while simultaneously altering the applied energy of the proton beam, which effectively changes the third dimension of the focal point. The system is applicable in combination with the above described rotation of the body, which preferably occurs in-between individual moments or cycles of proton delivery to the tumor. Optionally, the rotation of the body by the above described system occurs continuously and simultaneously with proton delivery to the tumor. - For example, in the illustrated system in
FIG. 27A , the spot is translated horizontally, is moved down a vertical y-axis, and is then back along the horizontal axis. In this example, current is used to control a vertical scanning system having at least one magnet. The applied current alters the magnetic field of the vertical scanning system to control the vertical deflection of the proton beam. Similarly, a horizontal scanning magnet system controls the horizontal deflection of the proton beam. The degree of transport along each axes is controlled to conform to the tumor cross-section at the given depth. The depth is controlled by changing the energy of the proton beam. For example, the proton beam energy is decreased, so as to define a new penetration depth, and the scanning process is repeated along the horizontal and vertical axes covering a new cross-sectional area of the tumor. Combined, the three axes of control allow scanning or movement of the proton beam focal point over the entire volume of the cancerous tumor. The time at each spot and the direction into the body for each spot is controlled to yield the desired radiation does at each sub-volume of the cancerous volume while distributing energy hitting outside of the tumor. - The focused beam spot volume dimension is preferably tightly controlled to a diameter of about 0.5, 1, or 2 millimeters, but is alternatively several centimeters in diameter. Preferred design controls allow scanning in two directions with: (1) a vertical amplitude of about 100 mm amplitude and frequency up to about 200 Hz; and (2) a horizontal amplitude of about 700 mm amplitude and frequency up to about 1 Hz.
- In
FIG. 27A , the proton beam is illustrated along a z-axis controlled by the beam energy, the horizontal movement is along an x-axis, and the vertical direction is along a y-axis. The distance the protons move along the z-axis into the tissue, in this example, is controlled by the kinetic energy of the proton. This coordinate system is arbitrary and exemplary. Referring now toFIG. 27B , preferably control of the proton beam is controlled in 3-dimensional space using two scanning magnet systems and by simultaneously varying and controlling the kinetic energy of the proton beam. The use of the extraction system, described supra, allows for different scanning patterns. Particularly, the system allows simultaneous adjustment of the x-, y-, and z-axes in the irradiation of the solid tumor. Stated again, instead of scanning along an x,y-plane and then adjusting energy of the protons, such as with a range modulation wheel, the system allows for moving along the z-axes while simultaneously adjusting the x- and or y-axes. Hence, rather than irradiating slices of the tumor, the tumor is optionally irradiated in three simultaneous dimensions. For example, the tumor is irradiated around an outer edge of the tumor in three dimensions. Then the tumor is irradiated around an outer edge of an internal section of the tumor. This process is repeated until the entire tumor is irradiated. The outer edge irradiation is preferably coupled with simultaneous rotation of the subject, such as about a vertical y-axis. This system allows for maximum efficiency of deposition of protons to the tumor, as defined as the ratio of the proton irradiation energy delivered to the tumor relative to the proton irradiation energy delivered to the healthy tissue. - Combined, the system allows for multi-axes control of the charged particle beam system in a small space with a low or small power supply. For example, the system uses multiple magnets where each magnet has at least one edge focusing effect in each turning section of the synchrotron and/or multiple magnets having concentrating magnetic field geometry, as described supra. The multiple edge focusing effects in the circulating beam path of the synchrotron combined with the concentration geometry of the magnets and described extraction system yields a synchrotron having:
-
- a small circumference system, such as less than about 50 meters;
- a vertical proton beam size gap of about 2 cm;
- corresponding reduced power supply requirements associated with the reduced gap size;
- an extraction system not requiring a newly introduced magnetic field;
- acceleration or deceleration of the protons during extraction; and
- control of z-axis energy during extraction.
- The result is a 3-dimensional scanning system, x-, y-, and z-axes control, where the z-axes control resides in the synchrotron and where the z-axes energy is variably controlled during the extraction process inside the synchrotron.
- Referring now to
FIG. 28 , an intensity modulated 3-dimensional scanning system 2800 is described. Referring now toFIG. 28A , a proton beam is being scanned across and x- and/or y-axis as a function of time. With each time, the z-axis energy is optionally adjusted. In this case, from the first time, t1, to the third time, t3, the energy is increased, and from the third time, t3, to the fifth time, t5, the energy is decreased. Thus, the system is scanning in 3-dimensions along the x-, y-, and/or z-axes. Notably, the radiation energy delivery efficiency is increasing from t9 to t3 and decreasing from t3 to t5, where efficiency refers to the percentage of radiation delivered to the tumor. For example, at the third time, t3, the Bragg peak energy is located at the distal, or back, portion of the tumor located furthest away from the point of origin where the charged particles enter thetumor 2120. Delivered Bragg peak energy increases exponentially up to the maximum distance of proton energy penetration into the body. Hence, as illustrated the percentage of the delivered Bragg peak energy in the tumor is greatest at the third time period t3, which has the largest tumor cross-section pathlength, less at the second and fourth time periods, t2 and t4, and still less at the first and fifth time periods, t9 and t5, which have the smallest tumor cross-section pathlength Referring now toFIG. 28B , the intensity of the proton beam is also changing with time in a manner correlated with the radiation energy delivery efficiency. In this case, the intensity of the proton beam is greatest at the third time period t3, less at the second and fourth time periods, t2 and t4, and still less at the first and fifth time periods, t9 and t5. The intensity of the proton beam is adjusted to be more intense when radiation delivery efficiency increases using the protonbeam extraction process 1800 andintensity control system 1900, described supra. Intensity is generally positively correlated with tumor cross-sectional pathlength, proton beam energy, and/or radiation delivery efficiency. Preferably, the distal portion of the tumor is targeted with each rotational position of thepatient 2130 using themulti-field irradiation 2500, described supra, allowing repeated use of increased intensity at changing distal portions of thetumor 2120 as thepatient 2130 is rotated in themulti-field irradiation system 2500. - As an example, the
intensity controller subsystem 1940 adjusts the radio-frequency field in theRF cavity system 1910 to yield an intensity to correlate with radiation delivery efficiency and/or with theirradiation plan 1960. Preferably, the intensity controller subsystem adjusts the intensity of the radiation beam using a reading of the actual intensity of theproton beam 1950 or from the feedback current from theextraction material 1930, which is proportional to the extracted beam intensity, as described supra. Thus, independent of the x- and y-axes targeting system and independent of the z-axis energy of the proton beam, the intensity of the proton beam is controlled, preferably in coordination with themulti-field irradiation system 2500, to yield peak intensities with greatest radiation delivery efficiency. The independent control of beam parameters allows use of a raster beam scanning system. Often, the greatest radiation delivery efficiency occurs, for a given rotational position of the patient, when the energy of the proton beam is largest. Hence, the intensity of the proton beam optionally correlates with the energy of the proton beam. The system is optionally timed with the patient's respiration cycle, as described infra. The system optionally operates in a raster beam scanning mode, as described infra. - An example of a proton scanning or targeting
system 140 used to direct the protons to the tumor with 4-dimensional scanning control is provided, where the 4-dimensional scanning control is along the x-, y-, and z-axes along with intensity control, as described supra. A fifth controllable axis is time. A sixth controllable axis is patient rotation. Typically, charged particles traveling along thetransport path 268 are directed through a firstaxis control element 142, such as a vertical control, and a secondaxis control element 144, such as a horizontal control and into atumor 2120. As described, supra, the extraction system also allows for simultaneous variation in the z-axis. Further, as described, supra, the intensity or dose of the extracted beam is optionally simultaneously and independently controlled and varied. Thus instead of irradiating a slice of the tumor, as inFIG. 27A , all four dimensions defining the targeting spot of the proton delivery in the tumor are simultaneously variable. The simultaneous variation of the proton delivery spot is illustrated inFIG. 27B by thespot delivery path 269 and inFIG. 28 , where the intensity is controlled as a function of efficiency of radiation delivery. - In one example, the protons are initially directed around an outer edge of the tumor and are then directed around an inner radius of the tumor. Combined with rotation of the subject about a vertical axis, a multi-field irradiation process is used where a not yet irradiated portion of the tumor is preferably irradiated at the further distance of the tumor from the proton entry point into the body. This yields the greatest percentage of the proton delivery, as defined by the Bragg peak, into the tumor and minimizes damage to peripheral healthy tissue.
- Raster beam scanning is optionally used. In traditional spot targeting systems, a spot of the tumor is targeted, then the radiation beam is turned off, a new spot is targeted, and the radiation beam is turned on. The cycle is repeated with changes in the x- and/or y-axis position. In stark contrast, in the raster beam scanning system, the proton beam is scanned from position to position in the tumor without turning off the radiation beam. In the raster scanning system, the irradiation is not necessarily turned off between spots, rather the irradiation of the tumor is optionally continuous as the beam scans between 3-dimensional locations in the tumor. The velocity of the scanning raster beam is optionally independently controlled. Velocity is change in the x, y, z position of the spot of the scanning beam with time. Hence, in a velocity control system, the rate of movement of the proton beam from coordinate to coordinate optionally varies with time or has a mathematical change in velocity with time. Stated again, the movement of the spot of the scanning beam with time is optionally not constant as a function of time. Further, the raster beam scanning system optionally uses the simultaneous and/or independent control of the x- and/or y-axes position, energy of the proton beam, intensity of the proton beam, and rotational position of the patient using the acceleration, extraction systems, and rotation systems, described supra.
- In one example, a charged particle beam system for irradiation of a tumor of a patient, includes: a synchrotron configured with an extraction foil, where a timing controller times the charged particle beam striking the extraction foil in an acceleration period in the synchrotron resulting in extraction of the charged particle beam at a selected energy and a raster beam scanning system configured to scan the charged particle beam across delivery positions while both (1) constantly delivering the charged particle beam at and between the delivery positions and (2) simultaneously varying the selected energy level of the charged particle beam across the delivery positions. Preferably, an intensity controller is used that is configured to measure a current resulting from the charged particle beam striking the extraction foil, the current used as a feedback control to a radio-frequency cavity system, wherein an applied radio frequency, using the feedback control, in the radio-frequency cavity system controls the number of particles in the charged particle beam striking the extraction foil resulting in intensity control of the charged particle beam. Preferably, a velocity controller is configured to change a rate of movement of the charged particle beam between the delivery position along x- and/or y-axes in the tumor as a function of time.
- Herein, an X-ray system is used to illustrate an imaging system.
- An X-ray is preferably collected either (1) just before or (2) concurrently with treating a subject with proton therapy for a couple of reasons. First, movement of the body, described supra, changes the local position of the tumor in the body relative to other body constituents. If the patient or subject 2130 has an X-ray taken and is then bodily moved to a proton treatment room, accurate alignment of the proton beam to the tumor is problematic. Alignment of the proton beam to the
tumor 2120 using one or more X-rays is best performed at the time of proton delivery or in the seconds or minutes immediately prior to proton delivery and after the patient is placed into a therapeutic body position, which is typically a fixed position or partially immobilized position. Second, the X-ray taken after positioning the patient is used for verification of proton beam alignment to a targeted position, such as a tumor and/or internal organ position. - An X-ray is preferably taken just before treating the subject to aid in patient positioning. For positioning purposes, an X-ray of a large body area is not needed. In one embodiment, an X-ray of only a local area is collected. When collecting an X-ray, the X-ray has an X-ray path. The proton beam has a proton beam path. Overlaying the X-ray path with the proton beam path is one method of aligning the proton beam to the tumor. However, this method involves putting the X-ray equipment into the proton beam path, taking the X-ray, and then moving the X-ray equipment out of the beam path. This process takes time. The elapsed time while the X-ray equipment moves has a couple of detrimental effects. First, during the time required to move the X-ray equipment, the body moves. The resulting movement decreases precision and/or accuracy of subsequent proton beam alignment to the tumor. Second, the time required to move the X-ray equipment is time that the proton beam therapy system is not in use, which decreases the total efficiency of the proton beam therapy system.
- Preferably, components in the particle beam therapy system require minimal or no maintenance over the lifetime of the particle beam therapy system. For example, it is desirable to equip the proton beam therapy system with an X-ray system having a long lifetime source, such as a lifetime of about 20 years.
- In one system, described infra, electrons are used to create X-rays. The electrons are generated at a cathode where the lifetime of the cathode is temperature dependent. Analogous to a light bulb, where the filament is kept in equilibrium, the cathode temperature is held in equilibrium at temperatures at about 200, 500, or 1000 degrees Celsius. Reduction of the cathode temperature results in increased lifetime of the cathode. Hence, the cathode used in generating the electrons is preferably held at as low of a temperature as possible. However, if the temperature of the cathode is reduced, then electron emissions also decrease. To overcome the need for more electrons at lower temperatures, a large cathode is used and the generated electrons are concentrated. The process is analogous to compressing electrons in an electron gun; however, here the compression techniques are adapted to apply to enhancing an X-ray tube lifetime.
- Referring now to
FIG. 29 , an example of anX-ray generation device 2900 having an enhanced lifetime is provided.Electrons 2920 are generated at acathode 2910, focused with acontrol electrode 2912, and accelerated with a series of acceleratingelectrodes 2940. The acceleratedelectrons 2950 impact anX-ray generation source 2948 resulting in generated X-rays that are then directed along anX-ray path 3070 to the subject 2130. The concentrating of the electrons from afirst diameter 2915 to a second diameter 2916 allows the cathode to operate at a reduced temperature and still yield the necessary amplified level of electrons at theX-ray generation source 2948. In one example, theX-ray generation source 2948 is the anode coupled with thecathode 2910 and/or the X-ray generation source is substantially composed of tungsten. - Still referring to
FIG. 29 , a more detailed description of an exemplaryX-ray generation device 2900 is described. Ananode 2914/cathode 2910 pair is used to generated electrons. Theelectrons 2920 are generated at thecathode 2910 having afirst diameter 2915, which is denoted d1. Thecontrol electrodes 2912 attract the generatedelectrons 2920. For example, if the cathode is held at about −150 kV and the control electrode is held at about −149 kV, then the generatedelectrons 2920 are attracted toward thecontrol electrodes 2912 and focused. A series of acceleratingelectrodes 2940 are then used to accelerate the electrons into a substantiallyparallel path 2950 with a smaller diameter 2916, which is denoted d2. For example, with the cathode held at −150 kV, a first, second, third, and fourth acceleratingelectrodes cathode 2910 is held at a smaller level, such as about −90 kV and the control electrode, first, second, third, and fourth electrode are each adjusted to lower levels. Generally, the voltage difference from the cathode to fourth electrode is less for a smaller negative voltage at the cathode and vise-versa. The acceleratedelectrons 2950 are optionally passed through amagnetic lens 2960 for adjustment of beam size, such as a cylindrical magnetic lens. The electrons are also optionally focused usingquadrupole magnets 2970, which focus in one direction and defocus in another direction. The acceleratedelectrons 2950, which are now adjusted in beam size and focused strike theX-ray generation source 2948, such as tungsten, resulting in generated X-rays that pass through anoptional blocker 3062 and proceed along anX-ray path 3070 to the subject. TheX-ray generation source 2948 is optionally cooled with acooling element 2949, such as water touching or thermally connected to a backside of theX-ray generation source 2948. The concentrating of the electrons from afirst diameter 2915 to a second diameter 2916 allows the cathode to operate at a reduced temperature and still yield the necessary amplified level of electrons at theX-ray generation source 2948. - More generally, the
X-ray generation device 2900 produces electrons having initial vectors. One or more of thecontrol electrode 2912, acceleratingelectrodes 2940,magnetic lens 2960, andquadrupole magnets 2970 combine to alter the initial electron vectors into parallel vectors with a decreased cross-sectional area having a substantially parallel path, referred to as the acceleratedelectrons 2950. The process allows theX-ray generation device 2900 to operate at a lower temperature. Particularly, instead of using a cathode that is the size of the electron beam needed, a larger electrode is used and the resultingelectrons 2920 are focused and/or concentrated into the required electron beam needed. As lifetime is roughly an inverse of current density, the concentration of the current density results in a larger lifetime of the X-ray generation device. A specific example is provided for clarity. If the cathode has a fifteen mm radius or d1 is about 30 mm, then the area (π r2) is about 225 mm2 times pi. If the concentration of the electrons achieves a radius of five mm or d2 is about 10 mm, then the area (π r2) is about 25 mm2 times pi. The ratio of the two areas is about nine (225π/25π). Thus, there is about nine times less density of current at the larger cathode compared to the traditional cathode having an area of the desired electron beam. Hence, the lifetime of the larger cathode approximates nine times the lifetime of the traditional cathode, though the actual current through the larger cathode and traditional cathode is about the same. Preferably, the area of thecathode 2910 is about 2, 4, 6, 8, 10, 15, 20, or 25 times that of the cross-sectional area of the substantiallyparallel electron beam 2950. - In another embodiment of the invention, the
quadrupole magnets 2970 result in an oblong cross-sectional shape of theelectron beam 2950. A projection of the oblong cross-sectional shape of theelectron beam 2950 onto theX-ray generation source 2948 results in anX-ray beam 3070 that has a small spot in cross-sectional view, which is preferably substantially circular in cross-sectional shape, that is then passed through the patient 2930. The small spot is used to yield an X-ray having enhanced resolution at the patient. - Referring now to
FIG. 30 , in one embodiment, an X-ray is generated close to, but not in, the proton beam path. A proton beam therapy system and anX-ray system combination 3000 is illustrated inFIG. 30 . The proton beam therapy system has aproton beam 268 in a transport system after theLambertson extraction magnet 292 of thesynchrotron 130. The proton beam is directed by the scanning/targeting/delivery system 140 to atumor 2120 of apatient 2130. TheX-ray system 3005 includes anelectron beam source 2905 generating anelectron beam 2950. The electron beam is directed to anX-ray generation source 2948, such as a piece of tungsten. Preferably, the tungsten X-ray source is located about 1, 2, 3, 5, 10, 15, or 20 millimeters from theproton beam path 268. When theelectron beam 2950 hits the tungsten, X-rays are generated in all directions. X-rays are blocked with aport 3062 and are selected for anX-ray beam path 3070. TheX-ray beam path 3070 andproton beam path 268 run substantially in parallel as they progress to thetumor 2120. The distance between theX-ray beam path 3070 andproton beam path 269 preferably diminishes to near zero and/or theX-ray beam path 3070 andproton beam path 269 overlap by the time they reach thetumor 2120. Simple geometry shows this to be the case given the long distance, of at least a meter, between the tungsten and thetumor 2120. The distance is illustrated as agap 3080 inFIG. 30 . The X-rays are detected at anX-ray detector 3090, which is used to form an image of thetumor 2120 and/or position of thepatient 2130. - As a whole, the system generates an X-ray beam that lies in substantially the same path as the proton therapy beam. The X-ray beam is generated by striking a tungsten or equivalent material with an electron beam. The X-ray generation source is located proximate to the proton beam path. Geometry of the incident electrons, geometry of the X-ray generation material, and/or geometry of the
X-ray beam blocker 262 yield an X-ray beam that runs either substantially in parallel with the proton beam or results in an X-ray beam path that starts proximate the proton beam path an expands to cover and transmit through a tumor cross-sectional area to strike an X-ray detector array or film allowing imaging of the tumor from a direction and alignment of the proton therapy beam. The X-ray image is then used to control the charged particle beam path to accurately and precisely target the tumor, and/or is used in system verification and validation. - Referring now to
FIG. 31 , additional geometry of theelectron beam path 2950 andX-ray beam path 3070 is illustrated. Particularly, theelectron beam 2950 is shown as an expandedelectron beam path X-ray beam path 3070 is shown as an expandedX-ray beam path - Still referring to
FIG. 31 , an optional system for retracting and repositioning of theX-ray generation source 2948 is illustrated where aflexible bellows 3120 connected to theX-ray generation source 2948 is used to move theX-ray generation source 2948 in an alternating fashion toward the charged particle beam and away from the charged particle beam. Theflexible bellows 3120 optionally have a metallic surface and/or have an about cylindrical longitudinal shape. Any mechanical means are used to move expand and/or contract the bellows. Optionally, theflexible bellows 3120 is connected to anelectron vacuum tube 3110 which maintains a vacuum between the cathode and anode of theX-ray generation device 3000. - Referring now to
FIG. 32 , a 3-dimensional (3-D)X-ray tomography system 3200 is presented. In a typical X-ray tomography system, the X-ray source and detector rotationally translate about a stationary subject. In the X-ray tomography system described herein, the X-ray source and detector are stationary and thepatient 2130 rotates. The stationary X-ray source allows a system where theX-ray source 2948 is proximate the protontherapy beam path 268, as described supra. In addition, the rotation of thepatient 2130 allows the proton dosage to be distributed around the body, rather than being concentrated on one static entrance side of the body. Further, the 3-D X-ray tomography system allows for simultaneous updates of the tumor position relative to body constituents in real-time during proton therapy treatment of thetumor 2120 in thepatient 2130. The X-ray tomography system is further described, infra. - Patient Imaging with Rotation
- In a first step of the
X-ray tomography system 3200, thepatient 2130 is positioned relative to theX-ray beam path 3070 andproton beam path 268 using a patient semi-immobilization/placement system, described infra. Afterpatient 2130 positioning, a series of reference 2-D X-ray images are collected, on adetector array 3090 or film, of thepatient 2130 andtumor 2120 as the subject is rotated about a y-axis 2117. For example, a series of about 50, 100, 200, or 400 X-ray images of the patient are collected as the patient is rotated. In a second example, an X-ray image is collected with each n degrees of rotation of thepatient 2130, where n is about ½, 1, 2, 3, 5, 10, or 20 degrees of rotation. Preferably, about 200 images are collected during one full rotation of the patient through 360 degrees. Subsequently, using the reference 2-D X-ray images, an algorithm produces a reference 3-D picture of thetumor 2120 relative to the patient's constituent body parts. Atumor 2120 irradiation plan is made using the 3-D picture of thetumor 2120 and the patient's constituent body parts. Creation of the proton irradiation plan is optionally performed after the patient has moved from the X-ray imaging area. - In a second step, the
patient 2130 is repositioned relative to theX-ray beam path 3070 andproton beam path 268 using the patient semi-immobilization/placement system. Just prior to implementation of the proton irradiation plan, a few comparative X-ray images of thepatient 2130 andtumor 2120 are collected at a limited number of positions using theX-ray tomography system 2600 setup. For example, a single X-ray image is collected with the patient positioned straight on, at angles of plus/minus forty-five degrees, and/or at angles of plus/minus ninety degrees relative to theproton beam path 268. The actual orientation of thepatient 2130 relative to theproton beam path 268 is optionally any orientation. The actual number of comparative X-ray images is also optionally any number of images, though the preferable number of comparative X-ray images is about 2 to 5 comparative images. The comparative X-ray images are compared to the reference X-ray images and differences are detected. A medical expert or an algorithm determines if the difference between the reference images and the comparative images is significant. Based upon the differences, the medical expert or algorithm determines if: proton treatment should commence, be halted, or adapted in real-time. For example, if significant differences in the X-ray images are observed, then the treatment is preferably halted and the process of collecting a reference 3-D picture of the patient's tumor is reinitiated. In a second example, if the differences in the X-ray images are observed to be small, then the proton irradiation plan commences. In a third example, the algorithm or medical expert can adapt the proton irradiation plan in real-time to adjust for differences in tumor location resulting from changes in position of thetumor 2120 in thepatient 2130 or from differences in thepatient 2130 placement. In the third example, the adaptive proton therapy increases patient throughput and enhances precision and accuracy of proton irradiation of thetumor 2120 relative to the healthy tissue of thepatient 2130. - Accurate and precise delivery of a proton beam to a tumor of a patient requires: (1) positioning control of the proton beam and (2) positioning control of the patient. As described, supra, the proton beam is controlled using algorithms and magnetic fields to a diameter of about 0.5, 1, or 2 millimeters. This section addresses partial immobilization, restraint, and/or alignment of the patient to insure the tightly controlled proton beam efficiently hits a target tumor and not surrounding healthy tissue as a result of patient movement.
- Herein, an x-, y-, and z-axes coordinate system and rotation axis is used to describe the orientation of the patient relative to the proton beam. The z-axis represent travel of the proton beam, such as the depth of the proton beam into the patient. When looking at the patient down the z-axis of travel of the proton beam, the x-axis refers to moving left or right across the patient and the y-axis refers to movement up or down the patient. A first rotation axis is rotation of the patient about the y-axis and is referred to herein as a rotation axis,
bottom unit 2112 rotation axis, or y-axis ofrotation 2117. In addition, tilt is rotation about an axis, such as the x-, y-, and/or z-axes. In one example, tile is rotation about the x-axis, yaw is rotation about the y-axis, and roll is rotation about the z-axis. In this coordinate system, theproton beam path 269 optionally runs in any direction. As an illustrative matter, the proton beam path running through a treatment room is described as running horizontally through the treatment room. - In this section, three examples of positioning systems are provided: (1) a semi-vertical
partial immobilization system 3300; (2) a sittingpartial immobilization system 3400; and (3) a layingpositioning system 3500. Elements described for one immobilization system apply to other immobilization systems with small changes. For example, a headrest, a head support, or head restraint will adjust along one axis for a reclined position, along a second axis for a seated position, and along a third axis for a laying position. However, the headrest itself is similar for each immobilization position. - Referring now to
FIG. 33 , the semi-verticalpatient positioning system 3300 is preferably used in conjunction with proton therapy of tumors in the torso. The patient positioning and/or immobilization system controls and/or restricts movement of the patient during proton beam therapy. In a first partial immobilization embodiment, the patient is positioned in a semi-vertical position in a proton beam therapy system. As illustrated, the patient is reclining at an angle alpha, α, about 45 degrees off of the y-axis as defined by an axis running from head to foot of the patient. More generally, the patient is optionally completely standing in a vertical position of zero degrees off the of y-axis or is in a semi-vertical position alpha that is reclined about 5, 10, 15, 20, 25, 30, 35, 40, 45, 50, 55, 60, or 65 degrees off of the y-axis toward the z-axis. -
Patient positioning constraints 3315 that are used to maintain the patient in a treatment position, include one or more of: aseat support 3320, aback support 3330, ahead support 3340, anarm support 3350, aknee support 3360, and afoot support 3370. The constraints are optionally and independently rigid or semi-rigid. Examples of a semi-rigid material include a high or low density foam or a visco-elastic foam. For example the foot support is preferably rigid and the back support is preferably semi-rigid, such as a high density foam material. One or more of thepositioning constraints 3315 are movable and/or under computer control for rapid positioning and/or immobilization of the patient. For example, theseat support 3320 is adjustable along aseat adjustment axis 3322, which is preferably the y-axis; theback support 3330 is adjustable along aback support axis 3332, which is preferably dominated by z-axis movement with a y-axis element; thehead support 3340 is adjustable along ahead support axis 3342, which is preferably dominated by z-axis movement with a y-axis element; thearm support 3350 is adjustable along anarm support axis 3352, which is preferably dominated by z-axis movement with a y-axis element; theknee support 3360 is adjustable along aknee support axis 3362, which is preferably dominated by z-axis movement with a y-axis element; and thefoot support 3370 is adjustable along afoot support axis 3372, which is preferably dominated by y-axis movement with a z-axis element. - If the patient is not facing the incoming proton beam, then the description of movements of support elements along the axes change, but the immobilization elements are the same.
- An
optional camera 3380 is used with the patient immobilization system. The camera views the patient/subject 2130 creating a video image. The image is provided to one or more operators of the charged particle beam system and allows the operators a safety mechanism for determining if the subject has moved or desires to terminate the proton therapy treatment procedure. Based on the video image, the operators optionally suspend or terminate the proton therapy procedure. For example, if the operator observes via the video image that the subject is moving, then the operator has the option to terminate or suspend the proton therapy procedure. - An optional video display or
display monitor 3390 is provided to the patient. The video display optionally presents to the patient any of: operator instructions, system instructions, status of treatment, or entertainment. - Motors for positioning the
patient positioning constraints 3315, thecamera 3380, and/orvideo display 3390 are preferably mounted above or below theproton transport path 268 or momentaryproton scanning path 269. - Respiration control is optionally performed by using the video display. As the patient breathes, internal and external structures of the body move in both absolute terms and in relative terms. For example, the outside of the chest cavity and internal organs both have absolute moves with a breath. In addition, the relative position of an internal organ relative to another body component, such as an outer region of the body, a bone, support structure, or another organ, moves with each breath. Hence, for more accurate and precise tumor targeting, the proton beam is preferably delivered at a point in time where the position of the internal structure or tumor is well defined, such as at the bottom or top of each breath. The video display is used to help coordinate the proton beam delivery with the patient's respiration cycle. For example, the video display optionally displays to the patient a command, such as a hold breath statement, a breathe statement, a countdown indicating when a breath will next need to be held, or a countdown until breathing may resume.
- In a second partial immobilization embodiment, the patient is partially restrained in a seated
position 3400. The sitting restraint system uses support structures similar to the support structures in the semi-vertical positioning system, described supra, with an exception that the seat support is replaced by a chair and the knee support is not required. The seated restraint system generally retains the adjustable support, rotation about the y-axis, camera, video, and breath control parameters described in the semi-vertical embodiment, described supra. - Referring now to
FIG. 34 , a particular example of a sittingpatient semi-immobilization system 3400 is provided. The sitting system is preferably used for treatment of head and/or neck tumors. As illustrated, the patient is positioned in a seated position on achair 3410 for particle therapy. The patient is further immobilized using any of the: thehead support 3340, theback support 3330, thehand support 3350, theknee support 3360, and thefoot support 3370. Thesupports adjustment chair 3410 is either readily removed to allow for use of a different patient constraint system or adapts under computer control to a new patient position, such as the semi-vertical system. - In a third partial immobilization embodiment, the patient is partially restrained in a laying position. Referring now to
FIG. 34 , the layingpositioning system 3500 or laying restraint system has support structures that are similar to the support structures used in the sittingpositioning system 3400 andsemi-vertical positioning system 3300, described supra. In the laying position, optional restraint, support, or partial immobilization elements include one or more of: thehead support 3340 and the back support, hip, andshoulder 3330 support. The supports preferably have respective axes of adjustment that are rotated as appropriate for a laying position of the patient. The laying position restraint system generally retains the adjustable supports, rotation about the y-axis, camera, video, and breath control parameters described in the semi-vertical embodiment, described supra. - If the patient is very sick, such as the patient has trouble standing for a period of about one to three minutes required for treatment, then being in a partially supported system can result in some movement of the patient due to muscle strain. In this and similar situations, treatment of a patient in a laying position on a support table 3520 is preferentially used. The support table has a horizontal platform to support the bulk of the weight of the patient. Preferably, the horizontal platform is detachable from a treatment platform. In a laying
positioning system 3500, the patient is positioned on aplatform 3510, which has a substantially horizontal portion for supporting the weight of the body in a horizontal position. Optional hand grips are used, described infra. In one embodiment, theplatform 3510 affixes relative to the table 3520 using a mechanical stop orlock element 3530 and matchingkey element 3535 and/or thepatient 2130 is aligned or positioned relative to aplacement element 3560. - Additionally,
upper leg support 3544,lower leg support 3540, and/orarm support 3550 elements are optionally added to raise, respectively, an arm or leg out of theproton beam path 269 for treatment of a tumor in the torso or to move an arm or leg into theproton beam path 269 for treatment of a tumor in the arm or leg. This increases proton delivery efficiency, as described supra. The leg supports 3540, 3544 andarm support 3550 are each optionally adjustable along support axes or arcs 3542, 3546, 3552. One or more leg support elements are optionally adjustable along an arc to position the leg into theproton beam path 269 or to remove the leg from theproton beam path 269, as described infra. An arm support element is preferably adjustable along at least one arm adjustment axis or along an arc to position the arm into theproton beam path 269 or to remove the arm from theproton beam path 269, as described infra. - Preferably, the patient is positioned on the
platform 3510 in an area or room outside of theproton beam path 268 and is wheeled or slid into the treatment room or proton beam path area. For example, the patient is wheeled into the treatment room on a gurney where the top of the gurney, which is the platform, detaches and is positioned onto a table. The platform is preferably lifted onto the table or slid onto the table so that the gurney or bed need not be lifted onto the table. - The semi-vertical
patient positioning system 3300 and sittingpatient positioning system 3400 are preferentially used to treatment of tumors in the head or torso due to efficiency. The semi-verticalpatient positioning system 3300, sittingpatient positioning system 3400, and layingpatient positioning system 3500 are all usable for treatment of tumors in the patient's limbs. -
Positioning constraints 3315 include all elements used to position the patient, such as those described in thesemi-vertical positioning system 3300, sittingpositioning system 3400, and layingpositioning system 3500. Preferably, positioning constraints or support system elements are aligned in positions that do not impede or overlap theproton beam path 269. However, in some instances the positioning constraints are in theproton beam path 269 during at least part of the time of treatment of the patient. For instance, a positioning constraint element may reside in theproton beam path 269 during part of a time period where the patient is rotated about the y-axis during treatment. In cases or time periods that the positioning constraints or support system elements are in the proton beam path, then an upward adjustment of proton beam energy is preferably applied that increases the proton beam energy to offset the positioning constraint element impedance of the proton beam. This time period and energy is a function of rotational orientation of the patient. In one case, the proton beam energy is increased by a separate measure of the positioning constraint element impedance determined during a reference scan of the positioning constraint system element or set of reference scans of the positioning constraint element as a function of rotation about the y-axis. - For clarity, the
positioning constraints 3315 or support system elements are herein described relative to thesemi-vertical positioning system 3300; however, the positioning elements and descriptive x-, y-, and z-axes are adjustable to fit any coordinate system, to the sittingpositioning system 3400, or the layingpositioning system 3500. - An example of a head support system is described to support, align, and/or restrict movement of a human head. The head support system preferably has several head support elements including any of: a back of head support, a right of head alignment element, and a left of head alignment element. The back of head support element is preferably curved to fit the head and is optionally adjustable along a head support axis, such as along the z-axis. Further, the head supports, like the other patient positioning constraints, is preferably made of a semi-rigid material, such as a low or high density foam, and has an optional covering, such as a plastic or leather. The right of head alignment element and left of head alignment elements or head alignment elements, are primarily used to semi-constrain movement of the head or to fully immobilize the head. The head alignment elements are preferably padded and flat, but optionally have a radius of curvature to fit the side of the head. The right and left head alignment elements are preferably respectively movable along translation axes to make contact with the sides of the head. Restricted movement of the head during proton therapy is important when targeting and treating tumors in the head or neck. The head alignment elements and the back of head support element combine to restrict tilt, rotation or yaw, roll and/or position of the head in the x-, y-, z-axes coordinate system.
- Referring now to
FIG. 36 another example of ahead support system 3600 is described for positioning and/or restricting movement of ahuman head 2102 during proton therapy of a solid tumor in the head or neck. In this system, the head is restrained using 1, 2, 3, 4, or more straps or belts, which are preferably connected or replaceably connected to a back ofhead support element 3610. In the example illustrated, afirst strap 3620 pulls or positions the forehead to thehead support element 3610, such as by running predominantly along the z-axis. Preferably asecond strap 3630 works in conjunction with thefirst strap 3620 to prevent the head from undergoing tilt, yaw, roll or moving in terms of translational movement on the x-, y-, and z-axes coordinate system. Thesecond strap 3630 is preferably attached or replaceable attached to thefirst strap 3620 at or about: (1) aforehead position 3632; (2) at a position on one or both sides of thehead 3634; and/or (3) at or about a position on thesupport element 3636. Athird strap 3640 preferably orientates the chin of the subject relative to thesupport element 3610 by running dominantly along the z-axis. Afourth strap 3650 preferably runs along a predominantly y- and z-axes to hold the chin relative to thehead support element 3610 and/or proton beam path. The third 3640 strap preferably is attached to or is replaceably attached to thefourth strap 3650 during use at or about the patient'schin position 3642. Thesecond strap 3630 optionally connects 3636 to thefourth strap 3650 at or about thesupport element 3610. The fourstraps straps head support element 3610. The straps are optionally attached to thehead support element 3610 using hook and loop technology, a buckle, or fastener. Generally, the straps combine to control position, front-to-back movement of the head, side-to-side movement of the head, tilt, yaw, roll, and/or translational position of the head. - The straps are preferably of known impedance to proton transmission allowing a calculation of peak energy release along the z-axis to be calculated. For example, adjustment to the Bragg peak energy is made based on the slowing tendency of the straps to proton transport.
- Referring now to
FIG. 37 , still another example of ahead support system 3340 is described. Thehead support 3340 is preferably curved to fit a standard or child sized head. Thehead support 3340 is optionally adjustable along ahead support axis 3342. Further, the head supports, like the other patient positioning constraints, is preferably made of a semi-rigid material, such as a low or high density foam, and has an optional covering, such as a plastic or leather. - Elements of the above described head support, head positioning, and head immobilization systems are optionally used separately or in combination.
- Still referring to
FIG. 37 , an example of thearm support 3350 is further described. The arm support preferably has aleft hand grip 3710 and aright hand grip 3720 used for aligning the upper body of thepatient 2130 through the action of thepatient 2130 gripping the left and right hand grips 3710, 3720 with the patient'shands 2134. The left and right hand grips 3710, 3720 are preferably connected to thearm support 3350 that supports the mass of the patient's arms. The left and right hand grips 3710, 3720 are preferably constructed using a semi-rigid material. The left and right hand grips 3710, 3720 are optionally molded to the patient's hands to aid in alignment. The left and right hand grips optionally have electrodes, as described supra. - In yet another embodiment, a rapid
patient positioning system 3800 is provided, which facilitates positioning of the patient. In the above section, systems for the partial immobilization, restraint, and/or alignment of the patient were described to ensure the tightly controlled proton beam efficiently hits a target tumor and not surrounding healthy tissue as a result of patient movement. For example, the positioning system placing the patient into a laying position was described. In the current art, the patient lays in any position on a flat table. The resulting variation in patient placement on the table is necessarily compensated for using methods that require fifteen to twenty minutes. Further, many patients have physical and/or health constraints that make it difficult for the patient to climb onto the table. Herein, an alternative rapidpatient positioning system 3800 is provided. - Generally, the rapid
patient positioning system 3800 contains several steps including: -
- positioning the
patient 2130 relative to a table 3510 in a substantially vertical orientation; - optionally constraining motion of the
patient 2130; - transitioning the table 3510 through a semi-vertical orientation, such as with a robot arm; and
- orientating the
patient 2130 and table 3510 in a substantially horizontal orientation, such as in a position fortumor 2120 therapy.
- positioning the
- Optionally, the robot arm is an arm in common with an arm used to move the
patient 2130 in traditional proton therapy. Optionally, the robot arm is used to re-orientate thepatient 2130 into a substantially vertical orientation at the conclusion of a charged particle therapy session. - Referring now to
FIG. 38 , an example of the rapidpatient positioning system 3800 is provided. In this example, thepatient 2130 is positioned relative to a table 3510 in a substantially vertical orientation at a first point in time, t1. For example, thepatient 2130 leans against the table 3510 held in a substantially vertical orientation, such as at an angle α that is vertical or about 5, 10, 15, 20, 25, or 30 degrees off of vertical. Any of the above describedpositioning constraints 3315, such as theseat support 3320, theback support 3330, thehead support 3340, thearm support 3350, theknee support 3360, and/or thefoot support 3370 are optionally used to position thepatient 2130 relative to the substantially vertical table 3510. Alternative embodiments of thefoot support 3370, theback support 3330, and thehead support 3340 are illustrated inFIG. 38 . Additionally,FIG. 38 illustrates a knee backsupport 3364, which is an example of apositioning constraint 3315. The knee backsupport 3364 supports the back of the knee of thepatient 2130 off of the table 3510. At the first point in time, t1, one or more of thepositioning constraints 3315 substantially align the patient relative to the table 3510 in an orientation that the patient can readily access. Preferably, the foot of the table 3510 is resting on the floor or is within 10, 20, or 30 centimeters of the floor to facilitate the patient stepping onto thefoot support 3370 attached to the table 3510. Subsequently, at a second point in time, t2, the table 3510 is re-orientated through a semi-vertical orientation by one ormore robot arms 3850, such as a first robot arm positioned near the head of a table 3510 or a second robot arm positioned at a foot of the table 3510. At a third point in time, t3, the preferablysingle robot arm 3850 finalizes orientation of the table 3510 into a substantially horizontal position. In this manner, thepatient 2130 is rapidly positioned onto the table 3510 in a fixed position in a time period of less than 1, 2, or 3 minutes. As described, infra, the positions of one or more elements of one or more of thepositioning constraints 3315 are recorded digitally and are later used in a step of computer controlled repositioning of the patient in the minutes or seconds prior to implementation of the irradiation element of the tumor treatment plan. - In yet another embodiment, a
patient support system 3900 is used to facilitate positioning of thepatient 2130. Referring now toFIG. 39 , apatient 2130 is illustrated relative to asupport 3301, such as the table 3510 or an element attached to the table 3510. In this example, twopositioning constraints 3315 are illustrated, an embodiment of thehead constraint 3340 and an embodiment of theback constraint 3330. In this example, theback constraint 3330 has at least degrees of freedom along the x- and/or z-axes for an arbitrary axis system with the z-axis running through the patient 2130 from front to back and the z-axis running from the patient's left shoulder to right shoulder. Preferably, one or both of the x- and z-axes degrees of freedom are under computer and motor control, as described infra for thepositioning constraints 3315. - Still referring now to
FIG. 39 , to illustrate the degrees of freedom of theback constraint 3330, the patient is illustrated at three points of time, t1, t2, t3, with theback constraint 3330 in varying configurations. Referring now toFIG. 39A , at the first time, t1, the shoulders of thepatient 2130 are observed to not fit into theback constraint 3330. Referring now toFIG. 39B , at the second point in time, t2, a left and a right side of the back constraints have been adjusted along the x-axis in opposite directions a first distance, d1, to a point where the shoulders fit comfortably but are constrained between the left side and the right side of theback constraint 3330. Referring now toFIG. 39A andFIG. 39B , at the first and second time, t9 and t2, the back of thepatient 2130 is observed to not be relaxed relative to the head of thepatient 2130. Referring now toFIG. 39C , at the third time, t3, theback constraint 3330 has been adjusted along the z-axis a second distance, d2, to allow the back of the shoulders to relax to a natural position along the z-axis relative to the head of thepatient 2130. In practice, each of theback constraint 3330 degrees of freedom along the x- and z-axes are independently adjustable. Similarly, thehead constraint 3340 is optionally adjustable along the z-axis relative to theback constraint 3330, which have a common fixed element of thesupport 3301 or table 3510, to achieve relaxation and constraint of the head relative to the shoulders of thepatient 2130. - The
back constraint 3330 andhead constraint 3340 of thepatient support system 3900 allows for a comfortable, computer recorded, and computer adjustable patient support configuration. Thepatient support system 3900 is preferably integrated with the rapidpatient positioning system 3800, described supra, to facilitate rapid, accurate, and/or precise alignment of thepatient 2130 relative to the table 3510 in the charged particle therapy system described herein. - Preferably, the patient's respiration pattern is monitored. When a subject or
patient 2130 is breathing many portions of the body move with each breath. For example, when a subject breathes the lungs move as do relative positions of organs within the body, such as the stomach, kidneys, liver, chest muscles, skin, heart, and lungs. Generally, most or all parts of the torso move with each breath. Indeed, the inventors have recognized that in addition to motion of the torso with each breath, various motion also exists in the head and limbs with each breath. Motion is to be considered in delivery of a proton dose to the body as the protons are preferentially delivered to the tumor and not to surrounding tissue. Motion thus results in an ambiguity in where the tumor resides relative to the beam path. To partially overcome this concern, protons are preferentially delivered at the same point in each of a series of respiration cycles. - Initially a rhythmic pattern of breathing of a subject is determined. The cycle is observed or measured. For example, an X-ray beam operator or proton beam operator can observe when a subject is breathing or is between breaths and can time the delivery of the protons to a given period of each breath. Alternatively, the subject is told to inhale, exhale, and/or hold their breath and the protons are delivered during the commanded time period.
- Preferably, one or more sensors are used to determine the respiration cycle of the individual. Two examples of a
respiration monitoring system 4010 are provided: (1) a thermal monitoring system and (2) a force monitoring system. - Referring again to
FIG. 35 , a first example of the thermal respiration monitoring system is provided. In the thermal respiration monitoring system, a sensor is placed by the nose and/or mouth of the patient. As the jaw of the patient is optionally constrained, as described supra, the thermal respiration monitoring system is preferably placed by the patient's nose exhalation path. To avoid steric interference of the thermal sensor system components with proton therapy, the thermal respiration monitoring system is preferably used when treating a tumor not located in the head or neck, such as a when treating a tumor in the torso or limbs. In the thermal monitoring system, a firstthermal resistor 3670 is used to monitor the patient's respiration cycle and/or location in the patient's respiration cycle. Preferably, the firstthermal resistor 3670 is placed by the patient's nose, such that the patient exhaling through their nose onto the firstthermal resistor 3670 warms the firstthermal resistor 3670 indicating an exhale. Preferably, a secondthermal resistor 3660 operates as an environmental temperature sensor. The secondthermal resistor 3660 is preferably placed out of the exhalation path of the patient but in the same local room environment as the firstthermal resistor 3670. Generated signal, such as current from thethermal resistors main controller 110 or a sub-controller of the main controller. Preferably, the secondthermal resistor 3660 is used to adjust for the environmental temperature fluctuation that is part of a signal of the firstthermal resistor 3670, such as by calculating a difference between the values of thethermal resistors - Referring again to
FIG. 34 , a second example of a monitoring system is provided. In an example of a force respiration monitoring system, a sensor is placed by the torso. To avoid steric interference of the force sensor system components with proton therapy, the force respiration monitoring system is preferably used when treating a tumor located in the head, neck, or limbs. In the force monitoring system, a belt orstrap 3450 is placed around an area of the patient's torso that expands and contracts with each respiration cycle of the patient. Thebelt 3450 is preferably tight about the patient's chest and is flexible. Aforce meter 3452 is attached to the belt and senses the patients respiration pattern. The forces applied to theforce meter 3452 correlate with periods of the respiration cycle. The signals from theforce meter 3452 are preferably communicated with themain controller 110 or a sub-controller of the main controller. - In this section, charged particle beam control systems, described supra, are coordinated for cancer therapy.
- Referring now to
FIG. 40 , a method of cancer therapy is provided. In this method, the patient is first positioned 4010, then the tumor is imaged 4020, subsequently a charged particle irradiation plan is developed 4030, and then the charged particle irradiation plan is implemented 4040. Further examples of the steps provided inFIG. 40 are described, infra, along with additional optional steps. For example, the positioning, imaging, and irradiation steps are optionally integrated with patient translation control, patient rotation control, and/or patient respiration control. Additionally, any of the steps described herein are optionally coordinated with charged particle beam generation, acceleration, extraction, and/or delivery. Additionally, any of the steps are optionally coordinated with x-, y-axis beam trajectory control, delivered energy control, delivered intensity control, timing of charged particle delivery, and/or distribution of radiation striking healthy tissue. - Referring now to
FIG. 41 , a method of tumor imaging is provided. In a first step, the patient is positioned 4010, such as with the patient immobilization and/or positioning systems described supra. Subsequently, the tumor is imaged 4020, such as with the imaging/X-ray system described supra. Preferably, each image is a 2-dimensional image. If the image is not complete 4010, then the patient is rotated 4020, such as with the multi-field irradiation rotatable platform described supra. For instance, the image is collected with rotation of the patient about the y-axis 2117. After rotation of n degrees of rotation of thepatient 2130, where n is about ½, 1, 2, 3, 5, 10, or 20 degrees, another image is collected 4020. Theimaging 4020 androtation 4120 processes are repeated until thetumor 2120 is suitably imaged. A 3-dimensional image is created 4130 using the two-dimensional images collected as a function of patient rotation. - Referring now to
FIG. 42 , a patient is positioned 4010 and once the rhythmic pattern of the subject's breathing or respiration cycle is determined 4210, a signal is optionally delivered to the patient, such as via thedisplay monitor 3390, to more precisely control thebreathing frequency 4220. For example, thedisplay screen 3390 is placed in front of the patient and a message or signal is transmitted to thedisplay screen 3390 directing the subject when to hold their breath and when to breathe. Typically, a respiration control module uses input from one or more of the respiration sensors. For example, the input is used to determine when the next breath exhale is to complete. At the bottom of the breath, the control module displays a hold breath signal to the subject, such as on a monitor, via an oral signal, digitized and automatically generated voice command, or via a visual control signal. Preferably, adisplay monitor 3390 is positioned in front of the subject and the display monitor displays breathing commands to the subject. Typically, the subject is directed to hold their breath for a short period of time, such as about ½, 1, 2, 3, 5, or 10 seconds. The period of time the breath is held is preferably synchronized to the delivery time of the proton beam to the tumor, which is about ½, 1, 2, or 3 seconds. While delivery of the protons at the bottom of the breath is preferred, protons are optionally delivered at any point in the respiration cycle, such as upon full inhalation. Delivery at the top of the breath or when the patient is directed to inhale deeply and hold their breath by the respiration control module is optionally performed as at the top of the breath the chest cavity is largest and for some tumors the distance between the tumor and surrounding tissue is maximized or the surrounding tissue is rarefied as a result of the increased volume. Hence, protons hitting surrounding tissue is minimized. Optionally, the display screen tells the subject when they are about to be asked to hold their breath, such as with a 3, 2, 1, second countdown so that the subject is aware of the task they are about to be asked to perform. - X-Ray Synchronization with Patient Respiration
- In one embodiment, X-ray images are collected in synchronization with patient respiration. The synchronization enhances X-ray image clarity by removing position ambiguity due to the relative movement of body constituents during a patient respiration cycle.
- In a second embodiment, an X-ray system is orientated to provide X-ray images of a patient in the same orientation as viewed by a proton therapy beam, is synchronized with patient respiration, is operable on a patient positioned for proton therapy, and does not interfere with a proton beam treatment path. Preferably, the synchronized system is used in conjunction with a negative ion beam source, synchrotron, and/or targeting method and apparatus to provide an X-ray timed with patient respiration. Preferably, X-ray images are collected immediately prior to and/or concurrently with particle beam therapy irradiation to ensure targeted and controlled delivery of energy relative to a patient position resulting in efficient, precise, and/or accurate in-vivo treatment of a solid cancerous tumor with minimization of damage to surrounding healthy tissue.
- An X-ray delivery control algorithm is used to synchronize delivery of the X-rays to the
patient 2130 within a given period of each breath, such as at the top or bottom of a breath, and/or when the subject is holding their breath. For clarity of combined X-ray images, the patient is preferably both accurately positioned and precisely aligned relative to theX-ray beam path 3070. The X-ray delivery control algorithm is preferably integrated with the respiration control module. Thus, the X-ray delivery control algorithm knows when the subject is breathing, where in the respiration cycle the subject is, and/or when the subject is holding their breath. In this manner, the X-ray delivery control algorithm delivers X-rays at a selected period of the respiration cycle. Accuracy and precision of patient alignment allow for (1) more accurate and precise location of thetumor 2120 relative to other body constituents and (2) more accurate and precise combination of X-rays in generation of a 3-dimensional X-ray image of thepatient 2130 andtumor 2120. - Referring again to
FIG. 42 , an example of generating an X-ray image of thepatient 2130 andtumor 2120 using theX-ray generation device 3000 or 3-dimensionalX-ray generation device 3000 as a known function of time of the patient's respiration cycle is provided. In one embodiment, as a first step themain controller 110 instructs, monitors, and/or is informed ofpatient positioning 4010. In a first example ofpatient positioning 4010, the automated patient positioning system, described supra, undermain controller 110 control, is used to align thepatient 2130 relative to theX-ray beam path 3070. In a second example of patient positioning, themain controller 110 is told via sensors or human input that thepatient 2130 is aligned. In a second step, patient respiration is then monitored 4210, as described infra. As a first example of respiration monitoring, an X-ray is collected 4230 at a known point in the patient respiration cycle. In a second example of respiration monitoring, the patient's respiration cycle is first controlled in a third step of controllingpatient respiration 4220 and then as a fourth step an X-ray is collected 4230 at a controlled point in the patient respiration cycle. Preferably, the cycle ofpatient positioning 4010,patient respiration monitoring 4210,patient respiration control 4220, and collecting anX-ray 4230 is repeated with different patient positions. For example, thepatient 2130 is rotated about anaxis 2117 and X-rays are collected as a function of the rotation. In a fifth step, a 3-dimensional X-ray image 4240 is generated of thepatient 2130,tumor 2120, and body constituents about the tumor using the collected X-ray images, such as with the 3-dimensionalX-ray generation device 3000, described supra. The patient respiration monitoring and control steps are further described, infra. - An X-ray timed with patient respiration where the X-ray is preferably collected immediately prior to and/or concurrently with particle beam therapy irradiation to ensure targeted and controlled delivery of energy relative to a patient position resulting in efficient, precise, and/or accurate treatment of a solid cancerous tumor with minimization of damage to surrounding healthy tissue in a patient using the proton beam position verification system.
- Proton Beam Therapy Synchronization with Respiration
- In one embodiment, charged particle therapy and preferably multi-field proton therapy is coordinated and synchronized with patient respiration via use of the respiration feedback sensors, described supra, used to monitor and/or control patient respiration. Preferably, the charged particle therapy is performed on a patient in a partially immobilized and repositionable position and the proton delivery to the
tumor 2120 is timed to patient respiration via control of charged particle beam injection, acceleration, extraction, and/or targeting methods and apparatus. The synchronization enhances proton delivery accuracy by removing position ambiguity due to the relative movement of body constituents during a patient respiration cycle. Synchrotron control to deliver protons at a desired point in the respiration cycle is described infra. - In a second embodiment, the X-ray system, described supra, is used to provide X-ray images of a patient in the same orientation as viewed by a proton therapy beam and both the X-ray system and the proton therapy beam are synchronized with patient respiration. Again, synchrotron control to deliver protons at a desired point in the respiration cycle is described infra.
- A proton delivery control algorithm is used to synchronize delivery of the protons to the tumor within a given period of each breath, such as at the top of a breath, at the bottom of a breath, and/or when the subject is holding their breath. The proton delivery control algorithm is preferably integrated with the respiration control module. Thus, the proton delivery control algorithm knows when the subject is breathing, where in the respiration cycle the subject is, and/or when the subject is holding their breath. The proton delivery control algorithm controls when protons are injected and/or inflected into the synchrotron, when an RF signal is applied to induce an oscillation, as described supra, and when a DC voltage is applied to extract protons from the synchrotron, as described supra. Typically, the proton delivery control algorithm initiates proton inflection and subsequent RF induced oscillation before the subject is directed to hold their breath or before the identified period of the respiration cycle selected for a proton delivery time. In this manner, the proton delivery control algorithm delivers protons at a selected period of the respiration cycle by simultaneously or nearly simultaneously delivering the high DC voltage to the second pair of plates, described supra, which results in extraction of the protons from the synchrotron and subsequent delivery to the subject at the selected time point. Since the period of acceleration of protons in the synchrotron is constant or known for a desired energy level of the proton beam, the proton delivery control algorithm is used to set an AC RF signal that matches the respiration cycle or directed respiration cycle of the subject.
- The above described charged particle therapy elements are combined in combinations and/or permutations in developing and implementing a tumor treatment plan, described infra.
- Referring now to
FIG. 43 , an example of implementation of theirradiation plan 4040 is provided. The multi-axis and/or multi-field charged particle cancer therapy system elements described herein are preferably coordinated with chargedparticle delivery 4300. Afterpatient positioning 4010 and reading theirradiation plan instructions 4310, hydrogen is injected 4315 into thenegative ion source 310, plasma is generated 4320, a negative ion is extracted 4325, and the negative ion is accelerated 4330, converted into apositive ion 4340, and injected into thesynchrotron 4345. Subsequently, the positive ion is accelerated 4350, extraction is initiated 4355, intensity of the irradiation beam is controlled 4360, extraction of the charged particle beam is performed 4365, and the tumor is irradiated 4370. Preferably, one or more elements of the chargedparticle delivery 4300 system are timed with patient respiration. Aftertumor irradiation 4370, the patient is preferably rotated 4120 and the irradiation sequence is repeated yielding multi-field irradiation of thetumor 2120. The entire sequence is optionally performed using the intensity modulated 3-dimensional scanning system 2800, described supra. - Referring now to
FIG. 44 , another example of implementation of theirradiation plan 4040 is provided. In this example, a multi-axis charged particle beam therapy system is provided, where multi-axis refers to independent control of: x-axis beam control, y-axis beam control, delivered beam energy, and/or delivered beam intensity. The multi-axis control is preferably implemented with multi-field charge particle irradiation, such as via use of independent control of rotation and/or translation of the patient. In this example, themain controller 110 independently adjusts x-axis targeting of theproton beam 4410, y-axis targeting of theproton beam 4420, rotational position of thepatient 4430, delivered energy of theproton beam 4440, and/or delivered intensity of the proton beam in the step of irradiating thetumor 4040. The process is optionally repeated or iterated using a continuously irradiating and scanning charged particle irradiation system as described using the 3-dimensional scanning system 2800. - A series of steps are performed to design and execute a radiation treatment plan for treating a
tumor 2120 in apatient 2130. The steps include one or more of: -
- positioning and immobilizing the patient;
- recording the patient position;
- monitoring patient respiration;
- controlling patient respiration;
- collecting multi-field images of the patient to determine tumor location relative to body constituents;
- developing a radiation treatment plan;
- repositioning the patient;
- verifying tumor location; and
- irradiating the tumor.
- In this section, an overview of developing the irradiation plan and subsequent implementation of the irradiation plan is initially presented, the individual steps are further described, and a more detailed example of the process is then described.
- Referring now to
FIG. 45 , an overview of a system for development of an irradiation plan and subsequent implementation of theirradiation plan 4500 is provided. Preferably, all elements of the positioning, respiration monitoring, imaging, andtumor irradiation system 4500 are undermain controller 110 control. - Initially, the tumor containing volume of the
patient 2130 is positioned and immobilized 4010 in a controlled and reproducible position. The process of positioning and immobilizing 4010 the patient 2310 is preferably iterated 4512 until the position is accepted. The position is preferably digitally recorded 4515 and is later used in a step of computer controlled repositioning of thepatient 4517 in the minutes or seconds prior to implementation of theirradiation element 4040 of the tumor treatment plan. The process of positioning the patient in a reproducible fashion and reproducibly aligning the patient 2310 to the controlled position is further described, infra. - Subsequent to
patient positioning 4010, the steps ofmonitoring 4210 and preferably controlling 4220 the respiration cycle of thepatient 2130 are preferably performed to yield more precise positioning of thetumor 2120 relative to other body constituents, as described supra. Multi-field images of the tumor are then collected 4540 in the controlled, immobilized, and reproducible position. For example, multi-field X-ray images of thetumor 2120 are collected using the X-ray source proximate the proton beam path, as described supra. The multi-field images are optionally from three or more positions and/or are collected while the patient is rotated, as described supra. - At this point the
patient 2130 is either maintained in the treatment position or is allowed to move from the controlled treatment position while an oncologist processes themulti-field images 4545 and generates atumor treatment plan 4550 using the multi-field images. Optionally, the tumor irradiation plan is implemented 4040 at this point in time. - Typically, in a subsequent treatment center visit, the
patient 2130 is repositioned 4517. Preferably, the patient's respiration cycle is again monitored 4212 and/or controlled 4022, such as via use of the thermal monitoring respiration sensors, force monitoring respiration sensor, and/or via commands sent to thedisplay monitor 3390, described supra. Once repositioned, verification images are collected 4560, such as X-ray location verification images from 1, 2, or 3 directions. For example, verification images are collected with the patient facing the proton beam and at rotation angles of 90, 180, and 270 degrees from this position. At this point, comparing the verification images to the original multi-field images used in generating the treatment plan, the algorithm or preferably the oncologist determines if thetumor 2120 is sufficiently repositioned 4565 relative to other body parts to allow for initiation of tumor irradiation using the charged particle beam. Essentially, the step of accepting the final position of thepatient 4565 is a safety feature used to verify that that thetumor 2120 in thepatient 2130 has not shifted or grown beyond set specifications. At this point the charged particle beam therapy commences 4040. Preferably the patient's respiration is monitored 4214 and/or controlled 4224, as described supra, prior to commencement of the chargedparticle beam treatment 4040. - Optionally,
simultaneous X-ray imaging 4590 of thetumor 2120 is performed during the multi-field proton beam irradiation procedure and themain controller 110 uses the X-ray images to adapt the radiation treatment plan in real-time to account for small variations in movement of thetumor 2120 within thepatient 2130. - Herein the steps of
monitoring multi-filed imaging 4540,position verification 4560, and/ortumor irradiation 4040 steps. Thepatient positioning 4010 and patient repositioning 4517 steps are further described, infra. - In yet another embodiment, the charged particle accelerator is synchronized to the patient's respiration cycle. More particularly, synchrotron acceleration cycle usage efficiency is enhanced by adjusting the synchrotron's acceleration cycle to correlate with a patient's respiration rate. Herein, efficiency refers to the duty cycle, the percentage of acceleration cycles used to deliver charged particles to the tumor, and/or the fraction of time that charged particles are delivered to the tumor from the synchrotron. The system senses patient respiration and controls timing of negative ion beam formation, injection of charged particles into a synchrotron, acceleration of the charged particles, and/or extraction to yield delivery of the particles to the tumor at a predetermine period of the patient's respiration cycle. Preferably, one or more magnetic fields in the
synchrotron 130 are stabilized through use of a feedback loop, which allows rapid changing of energy levels and/or timing of extraction from pulse to pulse. Further, the feedback loop allows control of the acceleration/extraction to correlate with a changing patient respiration rate. Independent control of charged particle energy and intensity is maintained during the timed irradiation therapy. Multi-field irradiation ensures efficient delivery of Bragg peak energy to the tumor while spreading ingress energy about the tumor. - In one example, a sensor, such as the first
thermal sensor 3670 or the secondthermal sensor 3660, is used to monitor a patient's respiration. A controller, such as themain controller 110, then controls charged particle formation and delivery to yield a charged particle beam delivered at a determined point or duration period of the respiration cycle, which ensures precise and accurate delivery of radiation to a tumor that moves during the respiration process. Optional charged particle therapy elements controlled by the controller include theinjector 120,accelerator 132, and/orextraction 134 system. Elements optionally controlled in theinjector system 120 include: injection of hydrogen gas into anegative ion source 310, generation of a high energy plasma within the negative ion source, filtering of the high energy plasma with a magnetic field, extracting a negative ion from the negative ion source, focusing thenegative ion beam 319, and/or injecting a resultingpositive ion beam 262 into thesynchrotron 130. Elements optionally controlled in theaccelerator 132 include: accelerator coils, applied magnetic fields in turning magnets, and/or applied current to correction coils in the synchrotron. Elements optionally controlled in theextraction system 134 include: radio-frequency fields in an extraction element and/or applied fields in an extraction process. By using the respiration sensor to control delivery of the charged particle beam to the tumor during a set period of the respiration cycle, the period of delivery of the charged particle to the tumor is adjustable to a varying respiration rate. Thus, if the patient breathes faster, the charged particle beam is delivered to the tumor more frequently and if the patient breathes slower, then the charged particle beam is delivered to the tumor less frequently. Optionally, the charged particle beam is delivered to the tumor with each breath of the patient regardless of the patient's changing respiration rate. This lies in stark contrast with a system where the charged particle beam delivers energy at a fixed time interval and the patient must adjust their respiration rate to match the period of the accelerator delivering energy and if the patient's respiration rate does not match the fixed period of the accelerator, then that accelerator cycle is not delivered to the tumor and the acceleration usage efficiency is reduced. - Typically, in an accelerator the current is stabilized. A problem with current stabilized accelerators is that the magnets used have memories in terms of both magnitude and amplitude of a sine wave. Hence, in a traditional system, in order to change the circulation frequency of the charged particle beam in a synchrotron, slow changes in current must be used. However, in a second example, the magnetic field controlling the circulation of the charged particles about the synchrotron is stabilized. The magnetic field is stabilized through use of: (1)
magnetic field sensors 1650 sensing the magnetic field about the circulating charged particles and (2) a feedback loop through a controller ormain controller 110 controlling the magnetic field about the circulating charged particles. The feedback loop is optionally used as a feedback control to the first windingcoil 1250 and the second windingcoil 1260. However, preferably the feedback loop is used to control the correction coils 1510, 1520, described supra. With the use of the feedback loop described herein using the magnetic field sensors, the frequency and energy level of the synchrotron are rapidly adjustable and the problem is overcome. Further, the use of thesmaller correction coils coils synchrotron 130. - In this section, the first example yielded delivery of the charged particle beam during a particular period of the patient's respiration cycle even if the patient's respiration period is varying. In this section, the second example used a
magnetic field sensor 1650 and a feedback loop to the correction coils 1510, 1520 to rapidly adjust the energy of the accelerator from pulse to pulse. In a third example, the respiration sensor of the first example is combined with the magnetic field sensor of the second example to control both the timing of the delivery of the charged particle beam from the accelerator and the energy of the charged particle beam from the accelerator. More particularly, the timing of the charged particle delivery is controlled using the respiration sensor, as described supra, and the energy of the charged particle beam is controlled using the magnetic field sensors and feedback loop, as described supra. Still more particularly, a magnetic field controller, such as themain controller 110, takes the input from the respiration sensor and uses the input as: (1) a feedback control to the magnetic fields controlling the circulating charged particles energy and (2) as a feedback control to time the pulse of the charged particle accelerator to the respiration cycle of the patient. This combination allows delivery of the charged particle beam to the tumor with each breath of the patient even if the breathing rate of the patient varies. In this manner, the accelerator efficiency is increased as the cancer therapy system does not need to lose cycles when the patient's breathing is not in phase with the synchrotron charged particle generation rate. - Referring now to
FIG. 46 , the combined use of the respiration sensor andmagnetic field sensor 4600 to deliver charged particles at varying energy and at varying time intervals is further described. Themain controller 110 controls theinjection system 120, chargedparticle acceleration system 132,extraction system 134, and targeting/delivery system 140. In this embodiment, the previously describedrespiration monitoring system 4610 of thepatient interface module 150 is used as an input to amagnetic field controller 4620. A second input to themagnetic field controller 4620 is amagnetic field sensor 1650. In one case, the respiration rates from therespiration monitoring system 4610 are fed to themain controller 130, which controls theinjection system 120 and/or components of theacceleration system 132 to yield a charged particle beam at a chosen period of the respiration cycle, as described supra. In a second case, the respiration data from the respiration monitoring system is used as an input to themagnetic field controller 4620. The magnetic field controller also receives feedback input from themagnetic field sensor 1650. The magnetic field controller thus times charged particle energy delivery to correlate with sensed respiration rates and delivers energy levels of the charged particle beam that are rapidly adjustable with each pulse of the accelerator using the feedback loop through themagnetic field sensor 1650. - Referring still to
FIG. 46 and now additionally referring toFIG. 47 , a further example is used to clarify the magnetic field control using afeedback loop 4600 to change delivery times and/or periods of proton pulse delivery. In one case, arespiratory sensor 4610 senses the respiration cycle of the patient. The respiratory sensor sends the patient's respiration pattern or information to an algorithm in themagnetic field controller 4620, typically via thepatient interface module 150 and/or via themain controller 110 or a subcomponent thereof. The algorithm predicts and/or measures when the patient is at a particular point in the respiration cycle, such as at the top or bottom of a breath. One or moremagnetic field sensors 1650 are used as inputs to themagnetic field controller 4620, which controls a magnet power supply for a given magnetic, such as within afirst turning magnet 1010 of asynchrotron 130. The control feedback loop is thus used to dial the synchrotron to a selected energy level and to deliver protons with the desired energy at a selected point in time, such as at a particular point in the respiration cycle. The selected point in the respiration cycle is optionally anywhere in the respiration cycle and/or for any duration during the respiration cycle. As illustrated inFIG. 47 , the selected time period is at the top of a breath for a period of about 0.1, 0.5, 1 seconds. More particularly, themain controller 110 controls injection of hydrogen into the injection system, formation of thenegative ion 310, controls extraction of negative ions fromnegative ion source 310, controlsinjection 120 of protons into thesynchrotron 130, and/or controls acceleration of the protons in a manner that combined withextraction 134 delivers theprotons 140 to the tumor at a selected point in the respiration cycle. Intensity of the proton beam is also selectable and controllable by themain controller 130 at this stage, as described supra. The feedback control from themagnetic field controller 4620 is optionally to a power or power supplies for one or both of themain bending magnet 250, described supra, or to the correction coils 1520 within themain bending magnet 250. Having smaller applied currents, the correction coils 1510, 1520 are rapidly adjustable to a newly selected acceleration frequency or corresponding charged particle energy level. Particularly, themagnetic field controller 4620 alters the applied fields to the main bending magnets or correction coils that are tied to the patient's respiration cycle. This system is in stark contrast to a system where the current is stabilized and the synchrotron delivers pulses with a fixed period. Preferably, the feedback of the magnetic field design coupled with the correction coils allows for the extraction cycle to match the varying respiratory rate of the patient, such as where afirst respiration period 4710, P1, does not equal asecond respiration period 4720, P2. - Referring now to
FIG. 48 , an example of a charged particlecancer therapy system 100 is provided. A main controller receives input from one, two, three, or four of a respiration monitoring and/or controllingcontroller 4810, abeam controller 4815, arotation controller 4850, and/or a timing to a time period in arespiration cycle controller 4860. Thebeam controller 4815 preferably includes one or more or abeam energy controller 4820, thebeam intensity controller 1940, abeam velocity controller 4830, and/or a horizontal/verticalbeam positioning controller 4840. Themain controller 110 controls any element of theinjection system 120; thesynchrotron 130; the scanning/targeting/delivery system 140; thepatient interface module 150; thedisplay system 160; and/or theimaging system 170. For example, the respiration monitoring/controllingcontroller 4810 controls any element or method associated with the respiration of the patient; thebeam controller 4815 controls any of the elements controlling acceleration and/or extraction of the charged particle beam; therotation controller 4850 controls any element associated with rotation of thepatient 2130 or an element moved by a gantry; and the timing to a period inrespiration cycle controller 4860 controls any aspects affecting delivery time of the charged particle beam to the patient. As a further example, thebeam controller 4815 optionally controls any magnetic and/or electric field about any magnet in the charged particlecancer therapy system 100. - One or more of the patient positioning unit components and/or one of more of the patient positioning constraints are preferably under computer control. For example, the computer records or controls the position of the
patient positioning elements 3315, such as via recording a series of motor positions connected to drives that move thepatient positioning elements 3315. For example, the patient is initially positioned 4010 and constrained by thepatient positioning constraints 3315. The position of each of the patient positioning constraints is recorded and saved by themain controller 110, by a sub-controller of themain controller 110, or by a separate computer controller. Then, imaging systems are used to locate thetumor 2120 in thepatient 2130 while the patient is in the controlled position of final treatment. Preferably, when the patient is in the controlled position, multi-field imaging is performed, as described herein. Theimaging system 170 includes one or more of: MRI's, X-rays, CT's, proton beam tomography, and the like. Time optionally passes at this point while images from theimaging system 170 are analyzed and a proton therapy treatment plan is devised. The patient optionally exits the constraint system during this time period, which may be minutes, hours, or days. Upon, and preferably after, return of the patient and initial patient placement into the patient positioning unit, the computer returns the patient positioning constraints to the recorded positions. This system allows for rapid repositioning of the patient to the position used during imaging and development of the multi-field charged particle irradiation treatment plan, which minimizes setup time of patient positioning and maximizes time that the chargedparticle beam system 100 is used for cancer treatment. - In one embodiment, using a patient positioning and
immobilization system 4200, a region of thepatient 2130 about thetumor 2120 is reproducibly positioned and immobilized, such as with the motorized patient translation androtation positioning system 2110 and/or with thepatient positioning constraints 3315. For example, one of the above described positioning systems, such as (1) the semi-verticalpartial immobilization system 3300; (2) the sittingpartial immobilization system 3400; or (3) the layingpositioning system 3500 is used in combination with the patient translation androtation system 2110 to position thetumor 2120 of thepatient 2130 relative to theproton beam path 268. Preferably, the position and immobilization system controls position of thetumor 2120 relative to theproton beam path 268, immobilizes position of thetumor 2120, and facilitates repositioning thetumor 2120 relative to theproton beam path 268 after thepatient 2130 has moved away from theproton beam path 268, such as during development of theirradiation treatment plan 4545. - Preferably, the
tumor 2120 of thepatient 2130 is positioned in terms of 3-D location and in terms of orientation attitude. Herein, 3-D location is defined in terms of the x-, y-, and z-axes and orientation attitude is the state of pitch, yaw, and roll. Roll is rotation of a plane about the z-axis, pitch is rotation of a plane about the x-axis, and yaw is the rotation of a plane about the y-axis. Tilt is used to describe both roll and pitch. Preferably, the positioning and immobilization system controls thetumor 2120 location relative to theproton beam path 268 in terms of at least three of and preferably in terms of four, five, or six of: pitch, yaw, roll, x-axis location, y-axis location, and z-axis location. - The patient positioning and
immobilization system 4200 is further described using a chair positioning example. For clarity, a case of positioning and immobilizing a tumor in a shoulder is described using chair positioning. Using thesemi-vertical immobilization system 3300, the patient is generally positioned using theseat support 3320,knee support 3360, and/orfoot support 3370. To further position the shoulder, a motor in theback support 3330 pushes against the torso of the patient.Additional arm support 3350 motors align the arm, such as by pushing with a first force in one direction against the elbow of the patient and the wrist of the patient is positioned using a second force in a counter direction. This restricts movement of the arm, which helps to position the shoulder. Optionally, the head support is positioned to further restrict movement of the shoulder by applying tension to the neck. Combined, thepatient positioning constraints 3315 control position of thetumor 2120 of thepatient 2130 in at least three dimensions and preferably control position of thetumor 2120 in terms of all of yaw, roll, and pitch movement as well as in terms of x-, y-, and z-axis position. For instance, the patient positioning constraints position thetumor 2120 and restricts movement of the tumor, such as by preventing patient slumping. Optionally, sensors in one or more of thepatient positioning constraints 3315 record an applied force. In one case, the seat support senses weight and applies a force to support a fraction of the patient's weight, such as about 50, 60, 70, or 80 percent of the patient's weight. In a second case, a force applied to the neck, arm, and/or leg is recorded. - Generally, the patient positioning and
immobilization system 4200 removes movement degrees of freedom from thepatient 2130 to accurately and precisely position and control the position of thetumor 2120 relative to theX-ray beam path 3070,proton beam path 268, and/or an imaging beam path. Further, once the degrees of freedom are removed, the motor positions for each of the patient positioning constraints are recorded and communicated digitally to themain controller 110. Once the patient moves from theimmobilization system 4200, such as when the irradiation treatment plan is generated 4550, thepatient 2130 must be accurately repositioned in apatient repositioning system 4500 before the irradiation plan is implemented. To accomplish this, thepatient 2130 sits generally in the positioning device, such as the chair, and the main controller sends the motor position signals and optionally the applied forces back to motors controlling each of thepatient positioning constraints 3315 and each of thepatient positioning constraints 3315 are automatically moved back to their respective recorded positions. Hence, re-positioning and re-immobilizing thepatient 2130 is accomplished from a time of sitting to fully controlled position in less than about 10, 30, 60, 120, or 600 seconds. - Using the computer controlled and automated patient positioning system, the patient is re-positioned in the positioning and
immobilization system 4500 using the recalledpatient positioning constraint 3315 motor positions; thepatient 2130 is translated and rotated using the patient translation androtation system 2120 relative to theproton beam 268; and theproton beam 268 is scanned to itsmomentary beam position 269 by themain controller 110, which follows the generatedirradiation treatment plan 4550. - Cancer is typically treated using charged particles to directly ablate the whole tumor. Alternatively, as taught herein, cancer is indirectly treated by ablating the periphery of the tumor and/or the healthy tissue proximately contacting the tumor, which reduces/prevents nutrient delivery to the tumor. The second case of peripheral tumor treatment is further described, infra.
- Referring now to
FIG. 49 (A-D), atumor sealing system 4900 for treating atumor 2120 is illustrated using the chargedparticle beam system 100. - Referring now to
FIG. 49A , thetumor 2120 is illustrated at a first pint in time, t1, with anouter periphery 2122. For clarity of presentation, thetumor periphery 2122 is illustrated in two-dimensions as a perimeter of the tumor. However, the periphery includes all of the outer edge/outer surface area of thetumor 2120 and/or the healthy tissue proximately contacting the outer surface of thetumor 2120. As such, herein thetumor periphery 2122 of thetumor 2120 refers to the outer portions of the tumor proximate healthy tissue and/or portions of the healthy tissue proximately surrounding/contacting thetumor 2120. - Referring now to
FIGS. 49B and 49C , the tumor treatment is illustrated at a second point in time, t2, and third point in time, t3, where the chargedparticle beam system 100 has treated a portion of thetumor periphery 2122 to form asealing layer 2126. Treatment voxels are preferably: (1) adjacent and/or (2) overlapped, such as to yield an approximately uniform dose as a function of 3-dimensional position about an edge of thetumor 2120. Thesealing layer 2126 is a physical barrier to nutrient flow, such as caused by localized heating, scarring, and/or ablation. - Referring now to
FIG. 49D , the tumor treatment is illustrated at a fourth point in time, t4, after forming thesealing layer 2126. Thesealing layer 2126 functions to hinder and/or prevent delivery of nutrients to thetumor 2120 by the body. For example, tumor growth is hindered, retarded, stopped, and/or reversed through lack of nutrients, such as glucose, oxygen, proteins, fats, minerals, and/or vitamins. Similarly, thesealing layer 2126 functions to hinder removal of metabolic waste product(s) from the tumor, such as carbon dioxide and urea. - Still referring to
FIG. 49D , the lack of nutrient delivery to the tumor and/or the lack of metabolic waste removal from the tumor causes natural death/necrosis of the tumor and the natural decay and/or release of natural products back into the body that, if passed by thesealing layer 2126, are recognized and dealt with by the body, such as through the circulatory, lymphatic, digestive, kidney, and/or liver systems. Further, the total treated volume of thetumor 2120 treated directly by the chargedparticle beam system 100 is reduced relative to the total volume of the tumor as preferably only the surface of thetumor 2120 is treated and the internal sections of thetumor 2120 are relatively untreated. In practice, at least 50, 60, 70, 80, 90, 95, 98, 99 percent of the surface area of the tumor is treated with the charged particle beam of the chargedparticle therapy system 100. By not treating the entire tumor volume, the amount of negative side products resultant from tumor treatment with charged particles is reduced as is treatment time. Preferably, the tail of the Bragg peak is delivered into the tumor, as described supra, and illustrated inFIG. 49B andFIG. 49C . - Referring now to
FIG. 50 , a three-dimensional tumorperimeter treatment system 5000 is illustrated, which is an example of thetumor sealing system 4900. In this example, thetumor periphery 2122 of thetumor 2120 is illustrated in a partially completed three-dimensionaltumor sealing layer 2126. Optionally, the three-dimensional surface of thetumor 2120 is treated in any order. In this particular case, the treatment forms a series of perimeters along an offset-axis to form a series of concentric and/or eccentric treatment perimeters, such as formed through one or more revolutions of the patient support system relative to the beam delivery angle from the gantry, an element held or suspended by the gantry, or nozzle of the chargedparticle therapy system 100. - Referring now to
FIG. 51A andFIG. 51B , alayered treatment system 5100 of the tumor is illustrated using the chargedparticle treatment system 100. Referring now toFIG. 51A , treatment of thetumor periphery 2122 of thetumor 2120 is illustrated at a first time, t1, and at a second time, t2. As illustrated, in this example voxels of thetumor 2120 are treated: (1) along a first axis at a first time with movement of the current position of theproton beam 269 relative to thepatient 2130 and (2) optionally along a second axis at a second time to form a multiply treatedvoxel zone 2128 or volume. Preferably, the first and second axis are about perpendicular and/or form an acute angle relative to each other of greater than about 20, 40, 60, 70, 80, or 85 degrees. By changing treatment axes, channels and/or leaks resultant from one treatment pass are blocked or woven into channels from a subsequent treatment pass, thereby enhancing the imperviousness of thesealing layer 2126. Referring now toFIG. 51B , the multiply treatedvoxel zone 2128 is optionally reinforced with a reinforcement sealing layer, such as illustrated at the third time, t3. Preferably, the treatment at the third time treats an inner layer of thetumor 2120 proximate the multiply treatedvoxel zone 2128; however, the reinforcement layer is optionally overlapped with the multiply treatedvoxel zone 2128 and/or is on any side of the multiple treatedvoxel zone 2128, which again if leaks or channels are present, the channels are blocked by the roughly orthogonal treatment layers. - Referring still to
FIG. 51A andFIG. 51B , the periphery of thetumor 2120 is optionally treated by sweeping the current position of theproton beam 269, or carbon ion beam, across the tumor/healthy tissue boundary, as illustrated at the fifth point in time, t5, across the x- and y-axes and at the sixth point in time, t6, across the z-axis. - Generally, the tumor/healthy tissue boundary or tumor penumbra is sealed using the charged
particle beam system 100 by treating the periphery of thetumor 2120 of thepatient 2130 with one or more overlapped, inter-stitched, interwoven, and/or adjacent sets of tissue volume or tissue voxels to hinder nutrient delivery to thetumor 2120 and/or waste product removal from thetumor 2120. Preferably, inner volumes of thetumor 2120 are not treated with the chargedparticle therapy system 100 and/or are treated with a dosage less than 100 percent of full treatment dosage, such as less than 80, 60, 40, or 20 percent of full dosage. - At a subsequent point in time, the
tumor 2120 is optionally retreated, as needed, to treat tumor growths through thetumor sealing layer 2126 and/or new tumor growth. - Referring now to
FIGS. 52 (A-E), a rapid beam redirection system 5200 is described. Referring now toFIG. 52A , a fast magnet 5210 is illustrated as part of the chargedparticle beam system 110. Generally, the fast magnet 5210 is any magnet where a current, such as in a winding coil about the magnet, is rapidly changed. The rapid change in current results in a rapid change in a magnetic field, such as a magnetic field passing through a charged particle beam path anywhere in the chargedparticle beam system 110. The change in magnetic field redirects the charged particles, such as away from thepatient 2130 to a charged particle beam stop 5212. As illustrated, the fast magnet 5210 is a separate magnet about the beam path in the beam line (1) after the firstLambertson extraction magnet 292 between two turningmagnets Lambertson extraction magnets 292, 293 move the charged particle beam from a circulatingbeam plane 267 to an about parallel second plane along thebeam transport path 268. The inventor has determined that placing the fast magnet 5210 between the two planes is preferable to reduce divergence of the charged particle beam. However, the fast magnet 5210 is optionally positioned anywhere in the chargedparticle beam system 110, such as within thesynchrotron 130 or in one or more beam transport lines and/orbeamline arc 5340 line(s) from the synchrotron to thepatient 2130. Still further, the rapid change in current is applied to any coil or inductor described herein and/or is applied to an additional safety coil wrapped about any magnet core described herein as any part of the chargeparticle beam system 110. Preferably, for safety, the charged particle beam is redirected from thepatient 2130 very rapidly, such as in less than about 25, 50, 100, 200, 500, 750, 1,000, or 5,000 microseconds. Preferably, the charged particle beam is redirected, through use of themain controller 110, on a time scale between delivery of individual pulses of the charged particle beam, on a time scale between treatment of individual tumor voxels, and/or on a time scale of a flinch of thepatient 2130. Two exemplary methods for rapidly altering current in the coil are described, infra. Optionally, the second Lambertson extraction magnet redirects the charged particle beam in thebeam transport path 268 along ahorizontal plane 5320 at the base of abeamline arc 5340. - Referring now to
FIG. 52B andFIG. 52C , a first method of rapidly increasing current to a coil of the fast magnet 5210 is presented. Referring now toFIG. 52B , a low voltage system 5220 is illustrated. In the low voltage system 5220, it is observed that as voltage is increased, the current increases, as potential is related to current and resistance.FIG. 52B illustrates that a time to increase the current is substantial with low applied voltages 5222 and that reaching a threshold current sufficient to, through change in the magnetic field, redirect the charged particle beam away from thepatient 2130 may take considerable time, such as much more than 50 microseconds. Referring now toFIG. 52C , a high voltage power system 5230 is illustrated. In the high voltage power system 5230, a time to increase the current to the threshold current using the high applied voltage 5232 is considerably faster, such as within 50 microseconds. The inventor has discovered, to achieve the faster solution a separate power supply is required. By applying a pulse to the separate power supply, such as to greater than 100, 200, 300, or 400 volts, and preferably to 500 volts, the corresponding current rises rapidly to the threshold, such as within 50 microseconds. Thus, in the first method, a separate magnet about the beam path controlled with a separate current supplied by a separate high voltage power supply to a separate coil about the core of the separate magnet is preferred. - Referring now to
FIG. 52D andFIG. 52E , a second method of rapidly decreasing current to a coil of the fast magnet 5210 is presented. Referring now toFIG. 52D , a current control circuit 5240 is illustrated. The inductor 5242 or coil is electrically connected to a resistor 5244 and switch 5246, where the resistor 5244 and switch 5246 are wired electrically in parallel at a first point in time. Referring now toFIG. 52E , a decreasing current system 5248 is illustrated. In the decreasing voltage system 5248, at a first point in time a voltage and current, such as a steady state current and voltage, are applied to the inductor 5242. When the switch 5246 is opened, the current applied to the inductor is rapidly reduced as the current must now run through the resistor 5244, which is optionally a large resistor, such as greater than about 0.05, 0.1, 0.2, 0.4, or 0.6 Ohms. Optionally, more than one resistor is used, the power supply is of fixed polarity, and/or resistors are used with an applied negative voltage system. Preferably, the charged particle beam is redirected by changing the applied current to the magnet, which alters the magnetic field and hence charged particle beam path, through use of themain controller 110, as described supra. - Targeting the
tumor 2120 of thepatient 2130 optionally uses beam control of one or more of: x-, y-axes position, energy, and intensity control. Additionally, targeting thetumor 2120 of thepatient 2130 optionally controls timing of the beam relative to patient translation and/or rotation position and/or relative to physiological movement of the patient, such as flinching and/or respiration. Herein, a new combination of beam/patient control is presented to target thetumor 2120 in 2.5 or 3-dimensions. Examples presented herein use adual rotation system 5360 for positioning of thepatient 2130 and an optional rotatable targetingmagnet system 5300. For clarity of presentation, non-limiting examples are provided, infra, to illustrate the combined rotatable targetingmagnet system 5300 and thedual rotation system 5360 of the patient. - Referring now to
FIG. 53A ,FIG. 53C , andFIG. 53F , the rotatable targetingmagnet system 5300 is further described in a first example. The chargedparticle beam system 100 contains a beamline that transports the charged particles from the accelerator, such as thesynchrotron 130, to thetumor 2120 of thepatient 2130. Optionally the beamline contains abeamline arc 5340 that arcs above and/or above and to the side of ahorizontal plane 5320 at the base of abeamline arc 5340. Thebeamline arc 5340 generally contains turning or bending magnets used to direct the charged particle beam first up and/or away from thehorizontal plane 5320 and then down and/or toward thepatient 2130. Traditionally, thebeamline arc 5340 terminates along a downward z-axis axis with two magnets: an x-axis scanning magnet and a y-axis scanning magnet. Scanning both the x-axis scanning magnet and the y-axis scanning magnet allows scanning of the proton beam along an x/y plane. Herein, an optionalrotatable targeting magnet 5310 replaces one and preferably both of the x-axis scanning magnet and the y-axis scanning magnet at a termination of thebeamline arc 5340. Replacement of the x-axis scanning magnet and/or the y-axis scanning magnet has multiple benefits, including: -
- termination of the
beamline arc 5340 at least 10, 20, 22.5, 30, 40, or 45 degrees before arcing down to a vertical beam; - termination of the
beamline arc 5340 above thehorizontal plane 5320; - termination of the
beamline arc 5340 within less than 3, 2, 1, 0.75, 0.5, or 0.25 meters of the tumor; and/or - reduction of weight that need be supported by a beamline gantry.
- termination of the
- The inventor notes that these are significant benefits, as further described supra.
- A first benefit is weight reduction. Traditionally many tons of magnets in the
beamline arc 5340, such as 25, 50, 75, or 100 tons, need be supported by a beamline gantry. The extreme weight introduces binding errors in re-positioning/movement of thebeamline arc 5340, that is significantly reduced with reduction of beamline arc weight, such as by removal of the x-axis scanning magnet and/or the y-axis scanning magnet. - A second benefit is that termination of the
beamline arc 5340 before a terminal vertical orientation allows coupling with thedual rotation system 5360 of thepatient 2130 and allows tumor treatment from multiple incident angles through thepatient 2130 with simple rotation of thepatient 2130 using a firstpatient rotation platform 2113 rotating, translating, and/or moving around therotatable targeting magnet 5310 and/or use of a secondpatient rotation platform 2115 mounted on the firstpatient rotation platform 2113, as described supra, where the firstpatient rotation platform 2113 and secondpatient rotation platform 2115 are optionally sub-units of thepatient positioning system 2110. A third benefit is that therotatable targeting magnet 5310 design allows closer positioning of thepatient 2130 to the end of thebeamline arc 5340, which reduced beam spread, Ω. Referring now toFIG. 53B , a physics limitation of a charged particle beam is beam spread, Ω. The ability to place thetumor 2120 closer to the termination of thebeamline arc 5340, such as through co-rotation of: (1) thepatient 2130 on the firstpatient rotation platform 2113 and therotatable targeting magnet 5310 allows thetumor 2120 to be positioned very close to termination of thebeamline arc 5340 as the steric restraints of leaving room for the gantry to reposition the termination point of the beamline arc 534, that would otherwise force movement of thepatient 2130 relative to termination of thebeamline arc 5340, are removed. Stated again, the patient position is optionally maintained on the firstpatient rotation platform 2113 at a fixed distance from therotatable targeting magnet 5310 as thebeamline arc 5340 is repositioned. Accordingly, the patient/beamline arc termination distance,distance 1, using therotatable targeting magnet 5310 is less than prior art patient/beamline arc termination distance,distance 2, where the x- and y-axes scanning magnets must be moved with movement of thebeamline arc 5340 forcing repositioning thepatient 2130 with different beamline arc positions. The forced repositioning of the patient with beamline arc changes causesdistance 2 to be greater thandistance 1. Said again, thesmaller distance 1, which is optionally a constant and hence an accurate, precise, and reproducible distance, results in a smaller beam spread, Ω1 compared to the physics based necessarily larger beam spread, Ω2, using the traditional x- and y-scanning magnets. In addition, theconstant distance 1 removes re-positioning error inherent in movement of the patient relative to the termination of the beamline arc using a traditional patient “couch”. - A third benefit of termination of the
beamline arc 5340 at least 10, 20, 22.5, 30, 40, or 45 degrees before arcing down to a vertical beam is the reduction in the number of beamline turning magnets as thebeamline arc 5340 need not turn the beam ninety degrees, but need only turn the beam a smaller amount, such as 45 degrees relying on the rotatable targeting magnet for directing the beam the last 0 to 45 degrees. For example, a traditional arc may use nine turning magnets, while termination of the arc at less than 90 degrees or before vertical allows fewer turning magnets in the arc, such as seven turning magnets. - Referring now to
FIGS. 53 (A-E), an illustrative and non-limiting example of thedual rotation system 5360 is provided. In thedual rotation system 5360, thepatient 2130 is rotated on the firstpatient rotation platform 2113. As illustrated, the entire person rotates around a central region where therotatable targeting magnet 5310 rotates and/or moves. As illustrated, thepatient 2130 is orientated on the sittingpartial immobilization system 3400, but is optionally laying or in any position. In various cases, thepatient 2130 is rotated on a path around the rotatable targeting magnet, is rotated in place, or is rotated “in place” while translating along the circular path, which is a combination of the first and second case. The last case is analogous to a person turning around while rotating around the edge of a merry-go-round. Each of the cases are further described, infra. In all of the cases, the charged particle beam is optionally scanned along any vector, such as a single vector, horizontally, or preferably vertically, by varying the current in therotatable targeting magnet 5310 and the charged particle beam is rotated across the tumor by physical rotation of the rotatable targeting magnet, rotation of thepatient 2130 on the firstpatient rotation platform 2113, rotation of the patient on the secondpatient rotation platform 2115, or through rotation of the patient relative to the charged particle beam through rotation of two or all of therotatable targeting magnet 5310, the firstpatient rotation platform 2113, and the secondpatient rotation platform 2115. - In a first case, the patient rotates in a circular path on the first
patient rotation platform 2113. In the first case, if thepatient 2130 were facing the center of the first patient rotation platform at the 12 o'clock position, thepatient 2130 would also be facing the center of the firstpatient rotation platform 2113 as a function of rotations, such as at the 3, 6, and 9 o'clock positions. Thus, themomentary beam 269 would always enter the same side of thepatient 2130 in route to thetumor 2120. In the first case, thetumor 2120 is treated vertically through changing current to the rotatable targeting magnet and is treated horizontally through mechanical movement of one or both of therotatable targeting magnet 5310 and the firstpatient rotation platform 2113. - In a second case, the
patient 2130 rotates in place on the secondpatient rotation platform 2115 without movement of the firstpatient rotation platform 2113. In the second case, if thepatient 2130 were at the 12 o'clock position, therotatable targeting magnet 5310 mechanically moves axially across thetumor 2120 of thepatient 2130, such as in the x/y plane, by rotating a few degrees across the tumor while variations of current provided to the rotatable targeting magnet target the tumor in various z-axis positions. Meanwhile, the rotation of thepatient 2130 on the second patient rotation platform distributes trailing edges of the Bragg peak curve around the tumor, reducing effects of the charged particles on healthy tissue of thepatient 2130. - In a third case, the illustrated case in
FIG. 53B , thepatient 2130 rotates on a path, such as a circular path, on the firstpatient rotation platform 2113 around therotatable targeting magnet 5310 while also rotating on the secondpatient rotation platform 2115, simultaneously or not, “in-place” on a given position of the firstpatient rotation platform 2113. InFIG. 53B , the secondpatient rotation platform 2115, not illustrated, resides under thepatient 2130. In the third case, as illustrated, the ventral, Ve, sinister side, Si, dorsal side, Do, and dexter side, De, of the patient are sequentially in the charged particle beam path; as illustrated at the 6, 3, 12, and 9 o'clock positions respectively, which distributes the charged particle beam tail energy about the tumor. Referring again toFIG. 53C , thepatient 2130 is illustrated at two opposite clock positions at a first time, t1, and second time, t2, respectively. The illustrated case shows the dorsal, Do, side of thetumor 2120 toward the charged particle beam at the first time and the ventral, Ve, side of the patient toward the charged particle beam at the second time. At each time, a two-dimensional slice of the tumor is treated. By repeating the process through a full rotation of thepatient 2130, a three-dimensional tumor volume is treated.FIG. 53D illustrates the two-dimensional slice: (1) at a given rotation point along a rotation plane, defined by two x-axis rotation times/positions, (2) with delivery of the charged particle beam depth into thetumor 2120 along the z-axis through variation of beam energy, and (3) with vertical scanning of thetumor 2120, through variation of applied current to therotatable turning magnet 5310, moving the charged particle beam along the y-axis. - Referring now to
FIG. 53E , yet another representation of thetumor 2120 moving around therotatable targeting magnet 5310 on the firstpatient rotation platform 2113 while also rotating on the secondpatient rotation platform 2115 is provided. InFIG. 53E , the representation is from the point of view of thetumor 2120. Particularly, at a first point in time, t1, the ventral side of thetumor 2120 is treated, as represent by along a first x/y-plane (x1, y1), and with a first variation in charged particle beam energy, z1. In the third case, in the preceding paragraph, a vertical plane of thetumor 2120 would treated at the first time. In this representation, the x/y plane at the first time is used to represent, with the expanding ovals, that with the addition of a second scanning magnet, such as an x-axis scanning magnet and/or a y-axis scanning magnet, more than one plane is optionally scanned at a first rotation position. However, preferably, a first single treatment plane of thetumor 2120 is treated at the first rotation position, represented at the first time and a second single treatment plane of thetumor 2120 is treated at the second rotation position at a second time. As illustrated, the ventral, dexter, dorsal, and sinister side entry points of thepatient 2130 ortumor 2120 are treated at four times, t1, t2, t3, t4, with individual treatment planes, that optionally overlap, to form a three-dimensional treatment volume with n rotation points of thepatient 2130. Optionally, treatment of thetumor 2120 occurs at n times and/or at n rotational positions, where n is a positive integer equal to or greater than 2, 3, 5, 10, 25, 50, or 100, to treat a three-dimensional volume with the charged particles. - In all cases, the first
patient rotation platform 2113 need not be a complete disk, but instead need only hold thepatient 2130, such as on a platform translatable in an arc, perimeter, or geometric path about the rotatable targeting magnet. - In any of the cases, the
patient 2130 is optionally held on thepatient positioning system 2110. - The
rotatable targeting magnet 5310 is further described herein. Therotatable targeting magnet 5310 includes acore 5312 about a gap through which the charged particle beam passes. One ormore coils 5315 wrap around the core. Application of a current through thecoil 5315 induces and/or changes a magnetic field crossing the gap. Driving the current one way or another, such as positive or negative, alters strength and/or direction of the magnetic field, which redirects themomentary beam position 269. Preferably, the current switches to a positive current to move the beam more than 10, 20, 22.5, 30, 40, or 45 degrees in one direction and to a negative (reverse) current to move the beam more than 10, 20, 22.5, 30, 40, or 45 degrees in the opposite direction. Preferably, the charged particle beam is directed up and down for a given position of thepatient 2130 andtumor 2120 on the first and/or secondpatient rotation platforms - Referring again to
FIG. 53A , optionally and preferably therotatable targeting magnet 5310 rotates about an axis separate from a plane defined by thebeamline arc 5340 or movement of thebeamline arc 5340. For example, therotatable targeting magnet 5310 is optionally supported on an independent gantry from the beamline gantry and/or is supported from above, such as from a ceiling mount. Therotatable targeting magnet 5310 preferably: -
- rotates about an axis aligned with gravity;
- is proximate and/or is next to a turning magnet at the terminal end of the
beamline arc 5340; - is used with or without an x-axis control, such as the
first axis control 142, or a y-axis control, such as thesecond axis control 144; - is positioned above the
horizontal plane 5320, such as formed by the second Lambertson magnet 293; - has a maximum beam deflection from a nominal angle of orientation of the
rotatable targeting magnet 5310 aligned more than 20, 22.5, 30, 40, or 45 degrees off vertical to vertical and/or to past vertical, such as illustrated at a first point in time, t1; and/or - is positioned above and central to a path of movement of the patient on the first
patient rotation platform 2113.
- Preferably the rotatable targeting magnet is not attached to the end of the
beamline arc 5340. - Referring now to
FIG. 53C , patient positioning relative to therotatable targeting magnet 5310 is further described. As thepatient 2130 rotates on the firstpatient rotation platform 2113, thepatient 2130 is simultaneously additionally rotated on the secondpatient rotation platform 2115. The dual rotation allows different sides of the patient to face the charged particle beam directed by therotatable targeting magnet 5310 as a function of time. For example, the dorsal side, Do, of thepatient 2130 is illustrated toward the center of the firstpatient rotation platform 2113 at a first point in time, t1, and the dorsal side of the patient is illustrated toward the outer edge of the firstpatient rotation platform 2113 after rotation of the first patient rotation platform through 180 degrees at a second point in time, t2. Similarly, the ventral side, Ve, of thepatient 2130 is respectively illustrated away from and toward the center of the firstpatient rotation platform 2113 at the first and second times, t1, t2. Similarly, with initial reorientation of the patient 2130 a sinister side of the patient is toward the center of the firstpatient rotation platform 2113 at a first point in time, t1, and a dexter side of the patient is toward the center of thefirst rotation platform 2113 after 180 degrees of rotation of thefirst rotation platform 2113 at a second point in time, t2. - Referring now to
FIGS. 54A-D , in yet another embodiment, thepatient 2130 is tilted during and/or between treatment of one or more tissue voxels. For clarity of presentation, in this section tilt refers to rotation of thepatient 2130 about a longitudinal axis of the body of thepatient 2130, such as about a horizontal axis or an axis within 5, 10, 15, 20, or 25 degrees of horizontal. However, as the patient is optionally in any orientation, such as vertical, sitting, and/or semi-vertical, more generally tilt refers to rotation of the patient about any one or more axes. - Referring now to
FIG. 54A , a patient side/back support system 5400 is figuratively illustrated, which is an example of theback support 3330 and/or an example of the layingpositioning system 3500. In this example, a side/back support 5410 comprises abackside support 5410 and aside support 5412. As illustrated, thebackside support 5410 continues, directly and/or indirectly, from the back of thepatient 2130 around at least a portion of a side of thepatient 2130. Theside support 5412 constrains radial movement of thepatient 2130 and when the patient is tilted, constrains sliding of thepatient 2130 on thebackside support 5410, as illustrated inFIG. 54C . Referring again toFIG. 54A , thebackside support 5410 is optionally expanded or contracted along the y-axis or radial axis of thepatient 2130 to fit thepatient 2130, such as in a manner described for theback support 3330 supra. Referring now toFIG. 54B , thepatient 2130 is illustrated as laying on the layingpositioning system 3500. In one case, the layingpositioning system 3500 incorporates the patient side/back support system 5400. In another case, the layingpositioning system 3500 provides a support for the patient side/back support system 5400. In yet another case, the patient side/back support system 5400 is used in place of the layingpositioning system 3500. - In any case, the momentary charged
particle path 269 is used to treat one or more voxels of thetumor 2120 of thepatient 2130 at various points in time. For example, referring now toFIG. 54B , the patient 2139 is rotated about a vertical axis as a function of time. As illustrated, the momentary chargedparticle beam 269 at a first point in time, t1, comes down to the tumor, along an incident angle relative to the longitudinal axis of the patient, over a first portion of the patient, such as over the patient's head. Further, as illustrated at a second point in time, t2, thepatient 2130 is rotated, such as about the vertical axis through an angle, +β, and the incident angle comes down to thetumor 2120 over a second portion of the patient, such as the patient's right shoulder. Still further, as illustrated at a third point in time, t3, thepatient 2130 is rotated, such as about the vertical axis through an angle, −β, and the incident angle comes down to the tumor over a third portion of the patient, such as the patient's left shoulder. Generally, the momentary chargedparticle beam 269 comes at an angle down to the tumor of the patient and the charged particles enter the patient from a variety of angles through the tissue. Particularly, as described supra, the charged particles optionally enters thepatient 2130 toward and/or near the about ventral, about dexter, about dorsal, or about ventral side of the patient with a vector toward the tumor. As further described in relation toFIG. 54B , the charged particle beam optionally enter the patient from various angles relative to a horizontal axis and for any given fixed incident angle, the charged particles enter the patient through series of angles forming a cone with rotation of thepatient 2130 about a vertical axis. Combined, the momentary chargedparticle beam position 269 enters the patient from a variety of angles, such as forming an expanding cone as a function of rotation of the patient for a given scanning angle; the given scanning angle formed by therotatable targeting magnet 5310 or the first andsecond axis control - Referring now to
FIG. 54B andFIG. 54C , thepatient 2130 is optionally tilted, such as relative to a horizontal axis. As illustrated, the patient is tilted through an angle gamma, y, such as from 0 to ±15 degrees relative to the horizontal plane at less than 0.2, 0.4, 0.6, 0.8, 1, 2, or 3 degree step intervals. Theside support 5412, which is optionally formed to the individual user, is used to constrain radial movement of the patient. Particularly, a left side support is optionally formed to any portion of the patient's left side, left torso, and/or left leg and a right side support is optionally formed to any portion of the patient's right side, right torso, and/or right leg. Optionally, the left and right side supports are asymmetrical, such as where one of the supports is preformed to a side of a partial or total amputee. Optionally theside support 5412 is integrated with thebackside support 5410 and/or is connected to the backside support with a curved inner radius to fit the rounded joining of a backside and side of a patient or a particular shape of a patient. The side supports 5412 are optionally pro-molded to the patient and/or are formed out of generally incompressible material under standard gravitational forces of a tilted patient. - Still referring to
FIG. 54B andFIG. 54C , as illustrated the patient is horizontal at the first time, t1, described in the preceding paragraph and is tilted to the patient's left and right, +γ and −γ respectively, at the first rotation time, t1, before rotation of the patient through angle β. More generally, any angle (A) of (1) rotation, β, and (2) tilt, γ, are used with any (3) momentary chargedparticle beam 269 treatment angle directed by therotatable targeting magnet 5310, thefirst axis control 142, and/or thesecond axis control 144 in combination with (B) any orientation of thepatient 2130 on the firstpatient rotation platform 2113 to yield set of a 2.5 or 3-dimensional incident treatment angles of the charged particle beam into thepatient 2130 and/or into thetumor 2120, as illustrated inFIG. 54D at six treatment times of n treatment times where n is a positive number. - Herein, a gantry is used to support, hold, and/or move any element of the beamline between the accelerator, such as the synchrotron, and the
patient 2130. In one example, the gantry is used to support, hold momentarily in position, and reposition an end of thebeamline arc 5340, an output nozzle, or final element(s) of the beamline to aim and/or orient the momentary chargedparticle path 269 at a voxel of thetumor 2120 of thepatient 2130. The gantry optionally suspends at least a portion of thebeamline arc 5340 and/or supports a portion of thebeamline arc 5340. Optionally and preferably, the gantry re-orientates at least one magnet of thebeamline arc 5340, where the reorientation is used as a part of targeting the tumor of the patient. - Referring now to
FIG. 55A andFIG. 55B , anX-ray imaging system 5500, which is an example of theimaging system 170, that co-moves: (1) the imaging system imaging beam or beams, such as an X-ray beam, and (2) a positively charged particle beam, such as from the synchrotron and guided using a beamline, such as thebeamline arc 5340, or gantry, is provided. Generally, there exists a need for imaging with minimization of parallax or error due to an image of the imaging system, such as the X-ray system, not-being aligned with delivery of the positively chargedparticle beam 269 delivered from the synchrotron. The alignment is optionally performed using software aligning at least a portion of an image with at least a position of one or more reference images. In tandem or separately, a physical connection is used to connect at least a part of theimaging system 170 and part of the beamline from the accelerator to the patient and/orbeamline arc 5340. The physical connection, which preferably controls co-movement of: (1) the X-ray beam or imaging beam and (2) the positively charged particle beam, maintains alignment of the imaging beam and positively charged particle beam, such that the same voxel or volume of the tumor is imaged, provided to themain controller 110, and/or treated by the chargedparticle beam system 100. Two non-limiting examples are provided, infra, to further illustrate theimaging system 170. While a non-limiting X-ray system for imaging is illustrated in the examples, generally theimaging system 170 uses any form or forms of electromagnetic radiation and/or a positively or negatively charged particle. - Referring now to
FIG. 55A , a first example of theX-ray imaging system 5500 is provided. In the first example, anX-ray source 5510 is physically affixed using animaging system mount 5520 to at least one of the beamline, thebeamline arc 5340, a terminal magnet of the beamline, thenozzle 2010, the first orsecond axis control rotatable alignment magnet 5510. Theimaging system mount 5520 aligns one or more of: theimaging system 170, an element of the imaging system, theX-ray source 5510, and/or an element, magnet, and/or alignment element of the X-ray source with any one or more elements of: the beamline, thebeamline arc 5340, thenozzle 2010, thefirst axis control 142, thesecond axis control 144, and/or the gantry used to move any element of the beamline, thebeamline arc 5340, thenozzle 2010, thefirst axis control 142, and/or thesecond axis control 144. In the first example, anX-ray detector 5530, a digital X-ray detector, and/or an X-ray film in the form of a linear X-ray detector 5552 or preferably a two-dimensional array of X-ray detectors detects X-rays from theX-ray source 5510, such as after passing through thetumor 2120. Optionally, the X-ray detector is rotatable about theX-ray beam 5512, about an axis aligned with the momentaryproton beam position 269, and/or about a fixed point in space, which yields a set of x-vectors, x1, x2, . . . xn, or x/y-arrays, where n is a positive integer. Optionally, the charged particle beam or momentaryproton beam position 269 is scanned along an axis, such as a vertical axis or an axis perpendicular to the x-axis, yn. - Referring now to
FIG. 55B , a second example of elements of an optional version of theimaging system 170 is provided. In this second example, afinal guiding element 5342 of the beamline, where thefinal guiding element 5342 is proximate a final element of the beamline, such as an exit foil, vacuum barrier element, or axial beamline element, is used to form the finalmomentary beam position 269 of the positively charged particle beam, such as from thesynchrotron 130, and to direct the charged particle beam to a voxel of thetumor 2120. As illustrated, theX-ray source 5510 generates anX-ray beam 5512 and directs theX-ray beam 5512 through thetumor 5512, where theX-ray beam 5510 is detected by theX-ray detector 5530. In the second example, theX-ray beam 5342 is at least about parallel to themomentary beam position 269 and preferably is less than 3, 2, 1, or 0.5 millimeters from an axial center of themomentary beam position 269. More preferably, a radial cross-section of the X-ray beam overlaps at least a portion of themomentary beam position 269 of the charged particle beam along the final beam path from the beamline 2340 to thetumor 2120 and/or within an imaged voxel of thetumor 2120. Optionally and preferably, theX-ray beam 5512 passes through thefinal guiding element 5342 of the beamline, such as through a hole in the metal core of the final magnet, between windings about at least a portion of the final magnet, through an aperture or central aperture, such as thegap 1110 of the final magnet, and/or through a housing of the final magnet. As illustrated, theX-ray beam source 5510 is affixed and/or integrated into thefinal guiding element 5342. Optionally, the X-ray beam source is rigidly attached, directly or indirectly, to thefinal guiding element 5342. - Referring now to
FIG. 55C , a third example is provided of asource element 172 of theimaging system 170 that is fixed in position by theimaging system mount 5520 to one or more elements held, guided, and/or repositioned by the gantry, such as any element of thebeam line arc 5340. As illustrated, thesecond axis control 144 element directs themomentary beam position 269 of the positively charged particle beam. However, any beam guiding or scanning element is optionally used in place of thesecond axis control 144. Animaging detector 174, such as a digital imaging detector, an X-ray film, a tomography detector, a proton detector, a cation detector, and/or a C6+ detector is used to detect electromagnetic energy or particles from theimaging system 170. In the third example, the imaging source is held away from the element being positioned by the gantry, but the imaging source moves with the element as the element is repositioned and/or positioned using the gantry. - Optionally, the
X-ray detector 5530 is always on the opposite side of the patient 2130 from theX-ray source 5510. As thepatient 2130 or particle beam control element is rotated through 180 degrees, the resultant signal is optionally used to form a 3-dimensional image of a section of thepatient 2130 and/or thetumor 2120, as in a corner beam CT. - Any element of the above three examples are optionally used with any element of the remaining examples or any element described herein. Further, the physical connection and/or
imaging system mount 5520 semi-permanently used to maintain alignment, excepting initial alignment and/or dynamic control elements, of an imaging beam originating in the imaging source with the positively charged particles exiting the beamline is optionally: (1) integrated into any element held and moved by the gantry, (2) is semi-integrated into any element held and moved by the gantry, and/or (3) is rigidly aligned using the imaging system mount to any element held and moved by the gantry. The rigid/fixed alignment of the imaging and treatment beams preferably controls co-movement, co-translation, and/or co-rotation of: (1) the X-ray beam or imaging beam and the positively charged particle beam, such that the same voxel or volume of the tumor is imaged and/or treated by the chargedparticle beam system 100. - In one embodiment, the charged particle tomography apparatus is used to image a tumor in a patient.
- In another embodiment, the charged particle tomography apparatus is used in combination with a charged particle cancer therapy system using common elements. For example, tomographic imaging of a cancerous tumor is performed using charged particles generated with an injector, accelerator, and guided with a delivery system that are part of the cancer therapy system, described supra.
- In various embodiments, the tomography imaging system is optionally simultaneously operational with a charged particle cancer therapy system using common elements, allows tomographic imaging with rotation of the patient, is operational on a patient in an upright, semi-upright, and/or horizontal position, is simultaneously operational with X-ray imaging, and/or allows use of adaptive charged particle cancer therapy. Further, the common tomography and cancer therapy apparatus elements are optionally operational in a multi-axis and/or multi-field raster beam mode.
- In conventional medical X-ray tomography, a sectional image through a body is made by moving one or both of an X-ray source and the X-ray film in opposite directions during the exposure. By modifying the direction and extent of the movement, operators can select different focal planes, which contain the structures of interest. More modern variations of tomography involve gathering projection data from multiple directions by moving the X-ray source and feeding the data into a tomographic reconstruction software algorithm processed by a computer. Herein, in stark contrast to known methods, the radiation source is a charged particle, such as a proton ion beam or a carbon ion beam. A proton beam is used herein to describe the tomography system, but the description applies to a heavier ion beam, such as a carbon ion beam. Further, in stark contrast to known techniques, herein the radiation source is preferably stationary while the patient is rotated.
- Referring now to
FIG. 56 , an example of a tomography apparatus is described. In one example, thetomography system 5600 uses elements in common with the chargedparticle beam system 100, including elements of one or more of theinjection system 120, accelerator orsynchrotron 130, targeting/delivery system 140,patient interface module 150,display system 160, and/orimaging system 170, such as the X-ray imaging system. Preferably, ascintillation plate 5610, such as a scintillating plastic is positioned behind thepatient 2130 relative to the targeting/delivery system 140 elements. The chargedparticle beam system 100 as described has proven operation at up to and including 330 MeV, which is sufficient to send protons through the body and into contact with the scintillation material. The intensity or count of protons hitting the plate as a function of position is used to create an image. Thepatient 2130 is rotated 2117 about the y-axis and a new image is collected. Preferably, a new image is collected with about every one degree of rotation of the patient resulting in about 360 images that are combined into a tomogram using tomographic reconstruction software. The tomographic reconstruction software uses overlapping rotationally varied images in the reconstruction. Optionally, a new image is collected at about every 2, 3, 4, 5, 10, 15, 30, or 45 degrees of rotation of the patient. - In one embodiment, a tomogram or an individual tomogram section image is collected at about the same time as cancer therapy occurs using the charged particle beam system. For example, an tomogram is collected and cancer therapy is subsequently performed: without the patient moving from the positioning systems, such as the above described semi-vertical
partial immobilization system 3300, the sittingpartial immobilization system 3400, or the a layingpositioning system 3500. In a second example, an individual tomogram slice is collected using a first cycle of the accelerator orsynchrotron 130 and using a following cycle of the accelerator orsynchrotron 130, thetumor 2120 is irradiated, such as within about 1, 2, 5, 10, 15 or 30 seconds. In a third case, about 2, 3, 4, or 5 tomogram slices are collected using 1, 2, 3, 4, or more rotation positions of thepatient 2130 within about 5, 10, 15, 30, or 60 seconds of subsequent tumor irradiation therapy. - In another embodiment, the independent control of the tomographic imaging process and X-ray collection process allows simultaneous single and/or multi-field collection of X-ray images and tomographic images easing interpretation of multiple images. Indeed, the X-ray and tomographic images are optionally overlaid to from a hybrid X-ray/proton beam tomographic image as the patient is optionally in the same position for each image.
- In still another embodiment, the tomogram is collected with the
patient 2130 in the about the same position as when the patient's tumor is treated using subsequent irradiation therapy. For some tumors, the patient being positioned in the same upright or semi-upright position allows thetumor 2120 to be separated from surrounding organs or tissue of thepatient 2130 better than in a laying position. Positioning of thescintillation plate 5610 behind thepatient 2130 allows the tomographic imaging to occur while the patient is in the same upright or semi-upright position. - The use of common elements in the tomographic imaging and in the charged particle cancer therapy allows benefits of the cancer therapy, described supra, to optionally be used with the tomographic imaging, such as proton beam x-axis control, proton beam y-axis control, control of proton beam energy, control of proton beam intensity, timing control of beam delivery to the patient, rotation control of the patient, and control of patient translation all in a raster beam mode of proton energy delivery.
- In yet still another embodiment, initially a three-dimensional tomographic proton based reference image is collected, such as with hundreds of individual rotation images of the
tumor 2120 andpatient 2130. Subsequently, just prior to proton treatment of the cancer, just a few 2-dimensional control tomographic images of the patient are collected, such as with a stationary patient or at just a few rotation positions, such as an image straight on to the patient, with the patient rotated about 45 degrees each way, and/or the patient rotated about 90 degrees each way about the y-axis. The individual control images are compared with the 3-dimensional reference image. An adaptive proton therapy is subsequently performed where: (1) the proton cancer therapy is not used for a given position based on the differences between the 3-dimensional reference image and one or more of the 2-dimensional control images and/or (2) the proton cancer therapy is modified in real time based on the differences between the 3-dimensional reference image and one or more of the 2-dimensional control images - Still yet another embodiment includes any combination and/or permutation of any of the elements described herein.
- The particular implementations shown and described are illustrative of the invention and its best mode and are not intended to otherwise limit the scope of the present invention in any way. Indeed, for the sake of brevity, conventional manufacturing, connection, preparation, and other functional aspects of the system may not be described in detail. Furthermore, the connecting lines shown in the various figures are intended to represent exemplary functional relationships and/or physical couplings between the various elements. Many alternative or additional functional relationships or physical connections may be present in a practical system.
- In the foregoing description, the invention has been described with reference to specific exemplary embodiments; however, it will be appreciated that various modifications and changes may be made without departing from the scope of the present invention as set forth herein. The description and figures are to be regarded in an illustrative manner, rather than a restrictive one and all such modifications are intended to be included within the scope of the present invention. Accordingly, the scope of the invention should be determined by the generic embodiments described herein and their legal equivalents rather than by merely the specific examples described above. For example, the steps recited in any method or process embodiment may be executed in any order and are not limited to the explicit order presented in the specific examples. Additionally, the components and/or elements recited in any apparatus embodiment may be assembled or otherwise operationally configured in a variety of permutations to produce substantially the same result as the present invention and are accordingly not limited to the specific configuration recited in the specific examples.
- Benefits, other advantages and solutions to problems have been described above with regard to particular embodiments; however, any benefit, advantage, solution to problems or any element that may cause any particular benefit, advantage or solution to occur or to become more pronounced are not to be construed as critical, required or essential features or components.
- As used herein, the terms “comprises”, “comprising”, or any variation thereof, are intended to reference a non-exclusive inclusion, such that a process, method, article, composition or apparatus that comprises a list of elements does not include only those elements recited, but may also include other elements not expressly listed or inherent to such process, method, article, composition or apparatus. Other combinations and/or modifications of the above-described structures, arrangements, applications, proportions, elements, materials or components used in the practice of the present invention, in addition to those not specifically recited, may be varied or otherwise particularly adapted to specific environments, manufacturing specifications, design parameters or other operating requirements without departing from the general principles of the same.
- Although the invention has been described herein with reference to certain preferred embodiments, one skilled in the art will readily appreciate that other applications may be substituted for those set forth herein without departing from the spirit and scope of the present invention. Accordingly, the invention should only be limited by the Claims included below.
Claims (9)
1. A method for positioning a tumor of a patient for treatment with positively charged particles translating along a beam path, comprising the steps of:
rotating a rotatable magnet, of a beamline and a charged particle therapy system, about a first vertical axis, said beam path comprising both a vertical vector component and a horizontal vector component from said rotatable magnet to the patient;
rotating the patient on a first rotational patient positioning platform, of a patient positioning system, at least one hundred eighty degrees about the first vertical axis; and
rotating the patient on a second rotational patient positioning platform about a second vertical axis, said second rotational patient positioning platform mounted to said first rotational patient positioning platform, said second vertical axis moving around the first vertical axis with rotation of said first rotational patient positioning platform; and
co-rotating said rotatable magnet and said first rotational patient positioning platform, wherein rotation of said rotatable magnet rotates the horizontal vector component: (1) around said first vertical axis and (2) toward said second vertical axis.
2. The method of claim 1 , further comprising the step of:
rotating said first rotational patient positioning platform through at least one hundred eighty degrees about the first vertical axis, wherein the tumor does not cross the first vertical axis with rotation of said first rotational patient positioning platform through the at least one hundred eighty degrees.
3. The method of claim 2 , further comprising the steps of:
at a first point in time, delivering the positively charged particles through said rotatable magnet along a first downward line comprising a first horizontal vector; and
at a second point in time, delivering the positively charged particles through said rotatable magnet along a second downward line comprising a second horizontal vector, the first horizontal vector and the second horizontal vector pointing in opposite directions.
4. The method of claim 3 , further comprising the step of:
tilting said patient along a longitudinal axis from head to toe of the patient.
5. The method of claim 4 , said step of tilting further comprising the steps of:
at a first point in time orientating a first patient axis from said first vertical axis through a dexter side of the patient to a sinister side of the patient about perpendicular to a first axis of the positively charged particles from said beamline; and
at a second point in time orientating a second patient axis from the first vertical axis through a sinister side of the patient to a dexter side of the patient about perpendicular to a second axis of the positively charged particles from said beamline.
6. The method of claim 4 , wherein said step of tilting directs a dexter side of the patient toward the first vertical axis at a first rotational position of said first rotational patient positioning platform and directs a sinister side of the patient toward the first vertical axis at a second rotation position of said first rotational patient positioning system, the first vertical axis between said first rotational position and said second rotational position.
7. The method of claim 1 , further comprising the step of:
tilting said patient along a longitudinal axis from head to toe of the patient.
8. An apparatus for positioning a tumor of a patient for treatment with positively charged particles translating along a beam path, comprising:
a rotatable magnet, of a beamline and a charged particle therapy system, said rotatable magnet rotatable about a first vertical axis, said beam path comprising both a vertical vector component and a horizontal vector component from said rotatable magnet to the patient during use; and
a patient positioning system, comprising:
a first rotational patient positioning platform configured to rotate at least one hundred eighty degrees about the first vertical axis; and
a second rotational patient positioning platform mounted to said first rotational patient positioning platform, said second rotational patient positioning platform configured to: (1) rotate about a second vertical axis, said second vertical axis moving around the first vertical axis with rotation of said first rotational patient positioning platform,
wherein, during use, co-rotating said rotatable magnet and said first rotational patient positioning platform rotates the horizontal vector component: (1) around said first vertical axis and (2) toward said second vertical axis.
9. The apparatus of claim 8 , wherein said first vertical axis does not intersect said second rotational patient positioning platform.
Priority Applications (1)
Application Number | Priority Date | Filing Date | Title |
---|---|---|---|
US15/232,512 US20170087381A1 (en) | 2008-05-22 | 2016-08-09 | Charged particle cancer therapy patient constraint apparatus and method of use thereof |
Applications Claiming Priority (50)
Application Number | Priority Date | Filing Date | Title |
---|---|---|---|
US5539508P | 2008-05-22 | 2008-05-22 | |
US5540908P | 2008-05-22 | 2008-05-22 | |
US13470708P | 2008-07-14 | 2008-07-14 | |
US13471708P | 2008-07-14 | 2008-07-14 | |
US13471808P | 2008-07-14 | 2008-07-14 | |
US13757408P | 2008-08-01 | 2008-08-01 | |
US18840708P | 2008-08-11 | 2008-08-11 | |
US18840608P | 2008-08-11 | 2008-08-11 | |
US18901708P | 2008-08-15 | 2008-08-15 | |
US18981508P | 2008-08-25 | 2008-08-25 | |
US19061308P | 2008-09-02 | 2008-09-02 | |
US19054608P | 2008-09-02 | 2008-09-02 | |
US19104308P | 2008-09-08 | 2008-09-08 | |
US19223708P | 2008-09-17 | 2008-09-17 | |
US19224508P | 2008-09-17 | 2008-09-17 | |
US19797108P | 2008-11-03 | 2008-11-03 | |
US19824808P | 2008-11-05 | 2008-11-05 | |
US19850808P | 2008-11-07 | 2008-11-07 | |
US19850908P | 2008-11-07 | 2008-11-07 | |
US19940508P | 2008-11-17 | 2008-11-17 | |
US19940408P | 2008-11-17 | 2008-11-17 | |
US19940308P | 2008-11-17 | 2008-11-17 | |
US20173208P | 2008-12-15 | 2008-12-15 | |
US20173108P | 2008-12-15 | 2008-12-15 | |
US20172808P | 2008-12-15 | 2008-12-15 | |
US20330808P | 2008-12-22 | 2008-12-22 | |
US20536209P | 2009-01-21 | 2009-01-21 | |
US20818209P | 2009-02-23 | 2009-02-23 | |
US20897109P | 2009-03-03 | 2009-03-03 | |
US20952909P | 2009-03-09 | 2009-03-09 | |
US12/425,683 US7939809B2 (en) | 2008-05-22 | 2009-04-17 | Charged particle beam extraction method and apparatus used in conjunction with a charged particle cancer therapy system |
US27029809P | 2009-07-07 | 2009-07-07 | |
US12/687,387 US8642978B2 (en) | 2008-05-22 | 2010-01-14 | Charged particle cancer therapy dose distribution method and apparatus |
US30862110P | 2010-02-26 | 2010-02-26 | |
US30965110P | 2010-03-02 | 2010-03-02 | |
US32477610P | 2010-04-16 | 2010-04-16 | |
US12/985,039 US8598543B2 (en) | 2008-05-22 | 2011-01-05 | Multi-axis/multi-field charged particle cancer therapy method and apparatus |
US13/572,542 US9056199B2 (en) | 2008-05-22 | 2012-08-10 | Charged particle treatment, rapid patient positioning apparatus and method of use thereof |
US201461936100P | 2014-02-05 | 2014-02-05 | |
US201461937325P | 2014-02-07 | 2014-02-07 | |
US201461937312P | 2014-02-07 | 2014-02-07 | |
US201461941968P | 2014-02-19 | 2014-02-19 | |
US201461947072P | 2014-03-03 | 2014-03-03 | |
US201461948301P | 2014-03-05 | 2014-03-05 | |
US201461948335P | 2014-03-05 | 2014-03-05 | |
US201461954447P | 2014-03-17 | 2014-03-17 | |
US201461954425P | 2014-03-17 | 2014-03-17 | |
US14/216,788 US9682254B2 (en) | 2008-05-22 | 2014-03-17 | Cancer surface searing apparatus and method of use thereof |
US14/293,861 US9498649B2 (en) | 2008-05-22 | 2014-06-02 | Charged particle cancer therapy patient constraint apparatus and method of use thereof |
US15/232,512 US20170087381A1 (en) | 2008-05-22 | 2016-08-09 | Charged particle cancer therapy patient constraint apparatus and method of use thereof |
Related Parent Applications (1)
Application Number | Title | Priority Date | Filing Date |
---|---|---|---|
US14/293,861 Continuation US9498649B2 (en) | 2008-05-22 | 2014-06-02 | Charged particle cancer therapy patient constraint apparatus and method of use thereof |
Publications (1)
Publication Number | Publication Date |
---|---|
US20170087381A1 true US20170087381A1 (en) | 2017-03-30 |
Family
ID=54704173
Family Applications (2)
Application Number | Title | Priority Date | Filing Date |
---|---|---|---|
US14/293,861 Active - Reinstated 2029-04-28 US9498649B2 (en) | 2008-05-22 | 2014-06-02 | Charged particle cancer therapy patient constraint apparatus and method of use thereof |
US15/232,512 Abandoned US20170087381A1 (en) | 2008-05-22 | 2016-08-09 | Charged particle cancer therapy patient constraint apparatus and method of use thereof |
Family Applications Before (1)
Application Number | Title | Priority Date | Filing Date |
---|---|---|---|
US14/293,861 Active - Reinstated 2029-04-28 US9498649B2 (en) | 2008-05-22 | 2014-06-02 | Charged particle cancer therapy patient constraint apparatus and method of use thereof |
Country Status (1)
Country | Link |
---|---|
US (2) | US9498649B2 (en) |
Cited By (2)
Publication number | Priority date | Publication date | Assignee | Title |
---|---|---|---|---|
US20230269860A1 (en) * | 2022-02-21 | 2023-08-24 | Leidos Engineering, LLC | High electron trapping ratio betatron |
US11958183B2 (en) | 2019-09-19 | 2024-04-16 | The Research Foundation For The State University Of New York | Negotiation-based human-robot collaboration via augmented reality |
Families Citing this family (15)
Publication number | Priority date | Publication date | Assignee | Title |
---|---|---|---|---|
US10751554B2 (en) * | 2010-04-16 | 2020-08-25 | Scott Penfold | Multiple treatment beam type cancer therapy apparatus and method of use thereof |
CN105764567B (en) | 2013-09-27 | 2019-08-09 | 梅维昂医疗系统股份有限公司 | Particle beam scanning |
US10675487B2 (en) | 2013-12-20 | 2020-06-09 | Mevion Medical Systems, Inc. | Energy degrader enabling high-speed energy switching |
US9962560B2 (en) | 2013-12-20 | 2018-05-08 | Mevion Medical Systems, Inc. | Collimator and energy degrader |
US9661736B2 (en) | 2014-02-20 | 2017-05-23 | Mevion Medical Systems, Inc. | Scanning system for a particle therapy system |
KR101714733B1 (en) * | 2015-08-13 | 2017-03-09 | 한국기계연구원 | Detachable device for loading unit of robot, robot and controlling method of robot using the same |
US10786689B2 (en) | 2015-11-10 | 2020-09-29 | Mevion Medical Systems, Inc. | Adaptive aperture |
US11065476B2 (en) * | 2016-01-26 | 2021-07-20 | The Board Of Regents Of The University Of Texas System | Mid-plane range-probing techniques for particle therapy |
US10143856B2 (en) * | 2016-03-31 | 2018-12-04 | Varian Medical Systems International Ag | Method and apparatus pertaining to treating a patient using heavy particles |
CN109803723B (en) | 2016-07-08 | 2021-05-14 | 迈胜医疗设备有限公司 | Particle therapy system |
US11103730B2 (en) | 2017-02-23 | 2021-08-31 | Mevion Medical Systems, Inc. | Automated treatment in particle therapy |
WO2019006253A1 (en) | 2017-06-30 | 2019-01-03 | Mevion Medical Systems, Inc. | Configurable collimator controlled using linear motors |
JP7057643B2 (en) * | 2017-10-30 | 2022-04-20 | 株式会社日立製作所 | Particle therapy system |
WO2019096943A1 (en) * | 2017-11-16 | 2019-05-23 | Ebamed Sa | Heart arrhythmia non-invasive treatment device and method |
US11311746B2 (en) | 2019-03-08 | 2022-04-26 | Mevion Medical Systems, Inc. | Collimator and energy degrader for a particle therapy system |
Citations (12)
Publication number | Priority date | Publication date | Assignee | Title |
---|---|---|---|---|
US6034377A (en) * | 1997-11-12 | 2000-03-07 | Mitsubishi Denki Kabushiki Kaisha | Charged particle beam irradiation apparatus and method of irradiation with charged particle beam |
US6246066B1 (en) * | 1997-12-25 | 2001-06-12 | Mitsubishi Denki Kabushiki Kaisha | Magnetic field generator and charged particle beam irradiator |
US6826423B1 (en) * | 1999-01-04 | 2004-11-30 | Midco-Medical Instrumentation And Diagnostics Corporation | Whole body stereotactic localization and immobilization system |
US20060002511A1 (en) * | 2003-08-12 | 2006-01-05 | Miller Daniel W | Modular patient support system |
US20090129556A1 (en) * | 2007-11-19 | 2009-05-21 | Pyronia Medical Technologies, Incorporated | Patient positioning system and methods for diagnostic radiology and radiotherapy |
US20090209852A1 (en) * | 2005-03-02 | 2009-08-20 | Calypso Medical Technologies, Inc. | Systems and Methods for Treating a Patient Using Guided Radiation Therapy or Surgery |
US7860550B2 (en) * | 2004-04-06 | 2010-12-28 | Accuray, Inc. | Patient positioning assembly |
US8210899B2 (en) * | 2006-11-21 | 2012-07-03 | Loma Linda University Medical Center | Device and method for immobilizing patients for breast radiation therapy |
US20120264997A1 (en) * | 2008-04-25 | 2012-10-18 | Radiadyne, Llc | External immobilizer |
US20120294424A1 (en) * | 2010-01-18 | 2012-11-22 | The Board Of Trustees Of The Leland Stanford Junior University | Method And Apparatus for Radioablation of Regular Targets such as Sympathetic Nerves |
US20140100409A1 (en) * | 2012-10-09 | 2014-04-10 | Milford Burton Kime | Targeted Nuclear Fusion Tumor Therapy |
US20140257011A1 (en) * | 2009-04-17 | 2014-09-11 | Stephen L. Spotts | Treatment delivery control system and method of operation thereof |
Family Cites Families (303)
Publication number | Priority date | Publication date | Assignee | Title |
---|---|---|---|---|
GB539422A (en) | 1940-02-06 | 1941-09-10 | Standard Telephones Cables Ltd | Improvements in or relating to arrangments for producing concentrated beams of electrons, particularly for electron discharge apparatus of the velocity modulation type |
FR962963A (en) | 1947-03-19 | 1950-06-28 | ||
US2533688A (en) | 1950-01-31 | 1950-12-12 | Quam Nichols Company | Focusing device |
US2790902A (en) | 1954-03-03 | 1957-04-30 | Byron T Wright | Ion accelerator beam extractor |
US3082326A (en) | 1954-03-08 | 1963-03-19 | Schlumberger Well Surv Corp | Neutron generating apparatus |
US3360647A (en) | 1964-09-14 | 1967-12-26 | Varian Associates | Electron accelerator with specific deflecting magnet structure and x-ray target |
US3128405A (en) | 1962-07-31 | 1964-04-07 | Glen R Lambertson | Extractor for high energy charged particles |
US3412337A (en) | 1966-08-24 | 1968-11-19 | Atomic Energy Commission Usa | Beam spill control for a synchrotron |
US3585386A (en) | 1969-06-05 | 1971-06-15 | Jerry L Horton | Radiographic chair rotatable about two mutually perpendicular axes |
US3794927A (en) | 1970-01-20 | 1974-02-26 | Atomic Energy Commission | System for producing high energy positively charged particles |
US3655968A (en) | 1970-06-29 | 1972-04-11 | Kermath Mfg Corp | X-ray examination chair |
DE7223397U (en) | 1972-06-22 | 1972-11-30 | Max-Planck-Ges Zur Foerderung Der Wissenschaften E V | ELECTRON BEAM GENERATING SYSTEM FOR VERY HIGH ACCELERATION VOLTAGES AND BEAM POWER |
US3867705A (en) | 1974-03-29 | 1975-02-18 | Atomic Energy Commission | Cyclotron internal ion source with dc extraction |
US3911280A (en) | 1974-04-11 | 1975-10-07 | Us Energy | Method of measuring a profile of the density of charged particles in a particle beam |
US3882339A (en) | 1974-06-17 | 1975-05-06 | Gen Electric | Gridded X-ray tube gun |
US3986026A (en) | 1975-11-14 | 1976-10-12 | The United States Of America As Represented By The United States Energy Research And Development Administration | Apparatus for proton radiography |
US4002912A (en) | 1975-12-30 | 1977-01-11 | The United States Of America As Represented By The United States Energy Research And Development Administration | Electrostatic lens to focus an ion beam to uniform density |
JPS5568056A (en) | 1978-11-17 | 1980-05-22 | Hitachi Ltd | X-ray tube |
US4472822A (en) | 1980-05-19 | 1984-09-18 | American Science And Engineering, Inc. | X-Ray computed tomography using flying spot mechanical scanning mechanism |
US4622687A (en) | 1981-04-02 | 1986-11-11 | Arthur H. Iversen | Liquid cooled anode x-ray tubes |
JPS60254538A (en) | 1984-05-31 | 1985-12-16 | Toshiba Corp | X-ray tube device |
US4607380A (en) | 1984-06-25 | 1986-08-19 | General Electric Company | High intensity microfocus X-ray source for industrial computerized tomography and digital fluoroscopy |
DE3505281A1 (en) | 1985-02-15 | 1986-08-21 | Siemens AG, 1000 Berlin und 8000 München | MAGNETIC FIELD GENERATING DEVICE |
US4705955A (en) | 1985-04-02 | 1987-11-10 | Curt Mileikowsky | Radiation therapy for cancer patients |
US4726046A (en) | 1985-11-05 | 1988-02-16 | Varian Associates, Inc. | X-ray and electron radiotherapy clinical treatment machine |
JPH0722039B2 (en) | 1986-05-01 | 1995-03-08 | 三菱電機株式会社 | Vacuum Chimba for accelerator |
US4868843A (en) | 1986-09-10 | 1989-09-19 | Varian Associates, Inc. | Multileaf collimator and compensator for radiotherapy machines |
EP0277521B1 (en) | 1987-01-28 | 1991-11-06 | Siemens Aktiengesellschaft | Synchrotron radiation source with fixation of its curved coils |
US5177448A (en) | 1987-03-18 | 1993-01-05 | Hitachi, Ltd. | Synchrotron radiation source with beam stabilizers |
DE3828639C2 (en) | 1987-08-24 | 1994-08-18 | Mitsubishi Electric Corp | Radiotherapy device |
JP2667832B2 (en) | 1987-09-11 | 1997-10-27 | 株式会社日立製作所 | Deflection magnet |
US4870287A (en) | 1988-03-03 | 1989-09-26 | Loma Linda University Medical Center | Multi-station proton beam therapy system |
US4992746A (en) | 1988-04-26 | 1991-02-12 | Acctek Associates | Apparatus for acceleration and application of negative ions and electrons |
US5073913A (en) | 1988-04-26 | 1991-12-17 | Acctek Associates, Inc. | Apparatus for acceleration and application of negative ions and electrons |
US4989225A (en) | 1988-08-18 | 1991-01-29 | Bio-Imaging Research, Inc. | Cat scanner with simultaneous translation and rotation of objects |
GB2223350B (en) | 1988-08-26 | 1992-12-23 | Mitsubishi Electric Corp | Device for accelerating and storing charged particles |
GB8820628D0 (en) | 1988-09-01 | 1988-10-26 | Amersham Int Plc | Proton source |
JP2523826B2 (en) | 1988-10-07 | 1996-08-14 | 三菱電機株式会社 | Semiconductor laser |
US5216377A (en) | 1988-11-24 | 1993-06-01 | Mitsubishi Denki Kabushiki Kaisha | Apparatus for accumulating charged particles with high speed pulse electromagnet |
EP0389220A3 (en) | 1989-03-20 | 1991-08-07 | Hitachi, Ltd. | An acceleration device for charged particles |
US5017789A (en) | 1989-03-31 | 1991-05-21 | Loma Linda University Medical Center | Raster scan control system for a charged-particle beam |
US5098158A (en) | 1989-08-17 | 1992-03-24 | Palarski Timothy D | Articulated relaxation chair |
US5010562A (en) | 1989-08-31 | 1991-04-23 | Siemens Medical Laboratories, Inc. | Apparatus and method for inhibiting the generation of excessive radiation |
US5046078A (en) | 1989-08-31 | 1991-09-03 | Siemens Medical Laboratories, Inc. | Apparatus and method for inhibiting the generation of excessive radiation |
US5101169A (en) | 1989-09-29 | 1992-03-31 | Kabushiki Kaisha Toshiba | Synchrotron radiation apparatus |
US5600213A (en) | 1990-07-20 | 1997-02-04 | Hitachi, Ltd. | Circular accelerator, method of injection of charged particles thereof, and apparatus for injection of charged particles thereof |
US5168514A (en) | 1991-09-27 | 1992-12-01 | Board Of Regents, The University Of Texas System | Modular radiotherapy treatment chair and methods of treatment |
US5363008A (en) | 1991-10-08 | 1994-11-08 | Hitachi, Ltd. | Circular accelerator and method and apparatus for extracting charged-particle beam in circular accelerator |
JP3125805B2 (en) | 1991-10-16 | 2001-01-22 | 株式会社日立製作所 | Circular accelerator |
JPH05208004A (en) | 1992-01-31 | 1993-08-20 | Toshiba Corp | X-ray ct system |
US5260581A (en) | 1992-03-04 | 1993-11-09 | Loma Linda University Medical Center | Method of treatment room selection verification in a radiation beam therapy system |
JP2824363B2 (en) | 1992-07-15 | 1998-11-11 | 三菱電機株式会社 | Beam supply device |
JP2944317B2 (en) | 1992-07-28 | 1999-09-06 | 三菱電機株式会社 | Synchrotron radiation source device |
US5388580A (en) | 1992-08-19 | 1995-02-14 | The United States Of America As Represented By The Department Of Health And Human Services | Head holder for magnetic resonance imaging/spectroscopy system |
IL104453A (en) | 1993-01-20 | 1996-06-18 | Gavish Benjamin | Stress detecting device and method for monitoring breathing |
US5440133A (en) | 1993-07-02 | 1995-08-08 | Loma Linda University Medical Center | Charged particle beam scattering system |
US5576602A (en) | 1993-08-18 | 1996-11-19 | Hitachi, Ltd. | Method for extracting charged particle beam and small-sized accelerator for charged particle beam |
US5698954A (en) | 1993-09-20 | 1997-12-16 | Hitachi, Ltd. | Automatically operated accelerator using obtained operating patterns |
JP2908220B2 (en) | 1993-12-28 | 1999-06-21 | 住友重機械工業株式会社 | Normal conduction type bending electromagnet |
US5538494A (en) | 1994-03-17 | 1996-07-23 | Hitachi, Ltd. | Radioactive beam irradiation method and apparatus taking movement of the irradiation area into consideration |
JP3309193B2 (en) | 1994-03-17 | 2002-07-29 | 株式会社日立製作所 | Vacuum duct inner surface treatment method and vacuum duct inner surface treatment device |
DE4425683C2 (en) | 1994-07-20 | 1998-01-22 | Siemens Ag | Electron generating device of an X-ray tube with a cathode and with an electrode system for accelerating the electrons emanating from the cathode |
US5661366A (en) | 1994-11-04 | 1997-08-26 | Hitachi, Ltd. | Ion beam accelerating device having separately excited magnetic cores |
US5511549A (en) | 1995-02-13 | 1996-04-30 | Loma Linda Medical Center | Normalizing and calibrating therapeutic radiation delivery systems |
US5585642A (en) | 1995-02-15 | 1996-12-17 | Loma Linda University Medical Center | Beamline control and security system for a radiation treatment facility |
US5642302A (en) | 1995-02-21 | 1997-06-24 | Banque De Developpement Du Canada | Method and apparatus for positioning a human body |
ATE226842T1 (en) | 1995-04-18 | 2002-11-15 | Univ Loma Linda Med | SYSTEM FOR MULTIPLE PARTICLE THERAPY |
US5668371A (en) | 1995-06-06 | 1997-09-16 | Wisconsin Alumni Research Foundation | Method and apparatus for proton therapy |
US5659223A (en) | 1995-07-14 | 1997-08-19 | Science Research Laboratory, Inc. | System for extracting a high power beam comprising air dynamic and foil windows |
US5790997A (en) | 1995-08-04 | 1998-08-11 | Hill-Rom Inc. | Table/chair egress device |
BE1009669A3 (en) | 1995-10-06 | 1997-06-03 | Ion Beam Applic Sa | Method of extraction out of a charged particle isochronous cyclotron and device applying this method. |
US5595191A (en) | 1995-10-12 | 1997-01-21 | Wfr/Aquaplast Corporation | Adjustable patient immobilization system and method for patient immobilization |
JP2867933B2 (en) | 1995-12-14 | 1999-03-10 | 株式会社日立製作所 | High-frequency accelerator and annular accelerator |
JP3472657B2 (en) | 1996-01-18 | 2003-12-02 | 三菱電機株式会社 | Particle beam irradiation equipment |
US5633907A (en) | 1996-03-21 | 1997-05-27 | General Electric Company | X-ray tube electron beam formation and focusing |
US5760395A (en) | 1996-04-18 | 1998-06-02 | Universities Research Assoc., Inc. | Method and apparatus for laser-controlled proton beam radiology |
JPH1028742A (en) | 1996-07-18 | 1998-02-03 | Hitachi Medical Corp | Radioactive therapeutic apparatus |
DE69729151T2 (en) | 1996-08-30 | 2005-05-04 | Hitachi, Ltd. | Device for a charged particle beam |
GB9620160D0 (en) | 1996-09-27 | 1996-11-13 | Bede Scient Instr Ltd | X-ray generator |
US5825845A (en) | 1996-10-28 | 1998-10-20 | Loma Linda University Medical Center | Proton beam digital imaging system |
JP3246364B2 (en) | 1996-12-03 | 2002-01-15 | 株式会社日立製作所 | Synchrotron accelerator and medical device using the same |
JP3178381B2 (en) | 1997-02-07 | 2001-06-18 | 株式会社日立製作所 | Charged particle irradiation device |
JPH1119235A (en) | 1997-07-03 | 1999-01-26 | Hitachi Ltd | Charged particle beam irradiation device and method |
JP2978873B2 (en) | 1997-05-09 | 1999-11-15 | 株式会社日立製作所 | Electromagnet and accelerator, and accelerator system |
US5854531A (en) | 1997-05-30 | 1998-12-29 | Science Applications International Corporation | Storage ring system and method for high-yield nuclear production |
WO1998057335A1 (en) | 1997-06-10 | 1998-12-17 | Adelphi Technology, Inc. | Thin radiators in a recycled electron beam |
JP3519248B2 (en) | 1997-08-08 | 2004-04-12 | 住友重機械工業株式会社 | Rotation irradiation room for radiation therapy |
JP3203211B2 (en) | 1997-08-11 | 2001-08-27 | 住友重機械工業株式会社 | Water phantom type dose distribution measuring device and radiotherapy device |
US5825847A (en) | 1997-08-13 | 1998-10-20 | The Board Of Trustees Of The Leland Stanford Junior University | Compton backscattered collimated x-ray source |
US5907595A (en) | 1997-08-18 | 1999-05-25 | General Electric Company | Emitter-cup cathode for high-emission x-ray tube |
US6218675B1 (en) | 1997-08-28 | 2001-04-17 | Hitachi, Ltd. | Charged particle beam irradiation apparatus |
DE19758363C2 (en) | 1997-12-22 | 2002-04-18 | Deutsches Elektronen Synchr | Arrangement for digital subtraction angiography |
US6076005A (en) | 1998-02-25 | 2000-06-13 | St. Jude Children's Research Hospital | Respiration responsive gating means and apparatus and methods using the same |
JPH11253563A (en) | 1998-03-10 | 1999-09-21 | Hitachi Ltd | Method and device for charged particle beam radiation |
DE19810346C1 (en) | 1998-03-10 | 1999-10-07 | Siemens Ag | Rotary anode X=ray tube |
RU2149662C1 (en) | 1998-04-21 | 2000-05-27 | Астрахан Борис Владимирович | Method and device for fixing patient to be subjected to rotation radiation therapy with horizontal therapeutic proton beam |
DE19929278A1 (en) | 1998-06-26 | 2000-02-17 | Nissin Electric Co Ltd | Negative hydrogen ion beam injection method on substrate |
DE69841746D1 (en) | 1998-09-11 | 2010-08-12 | Gsi Helmholtzzentrum Schwerionenforschung Gmbh | Ion beam therapy system and method of operation of the system |
US6148058A (en) | 1998-10-23 | 2000-11-14 | Analogic Corporation | System and method for real time measurement of detector offset in rotating-patient CT scanner |
US6937696B1 (en) | 1998-10-23 | 2005-08-30 | Varian Medical Systems Technologies, Inc. | Method and system for predictive physiological gating |
US6444990B1 (en) | 1998-11-05 | 2002-09-03 | Advanced Molecular Imaging Systems, Inc. | Multiple target, multiple energy radioisotope production |
BE1012358A5 (en) | 1998-12-21 | 2000-10-03 | Ion Beam Applic Sa | Process of changes of energy of particle beam extracted of an accelerator and device for this purpose. |
BE1012371A5 (en) | 1998-12-24 | 2000-10-03 | Ion Beam Applic Sa | Treatment method for proton beam and device applying the method. |
DE19904675A1 (en) | 1999-02-04 | 2000-08-10 | Schwerionenforsch Gmbh | Gantry system and method for operating the system |
US6560354B1 (en) | 1999-02-16 | 2003-05-06 | University Of Rochester | Apparatus and method for registration of images to physical space using a weighted combination of points and surfaces |
DE19907097A1 (en) | 1999-02-19 | 2000-08-31 | Schwerionenforsch Gmbh | Method for operating an ion beam therapy system while monitoring the radiation dose distribution |
DE19907774A1 (en) | 1999-02-19 | 2000-08-31 | Schwerionenforsch Gmbh | Method for verifying the calculated radiation dose of an ion beam therapy system |
DE19907098A1 (en) | 1999-02-19 | 2000-08-24 | Schwerionenforsch Gmbh | Ion beam scanning system for radiation therapy e.g. for tumor treatment, uses energy absorption device displaced transverse to ion beam path via linear motor for altering penetration depth |
DE19907064A1 (en) | 1999-02-19 | 2000-08-31 | Schwerionenforsch Gmbh | Procedure for checking an emergency shutdown of an ion beam therapy system |
DE19907065A1 (en) | 1999-02-19 | 2000-08-31 | Schwerionenforsch Gmbh | Method for checking an isocenter and a patient positioning device of an ion beam therapy system |
DE19907205A1 (en) | 1999-02-19 | 2000-08-31 | Schwerionenforsch Gmbh | Method for operating an ion beam therapy system while monitoring the beam position |
DE19907771A1 (en) | 1999-02-19 | 2000-08-31 | Schwerionenforsch Gmbh | Method for checking the radiation control unit of an ion beam therapy system |
DE19907138A1 (en) | 1999-02-19 | 2000-08-31 | Schwerionenforsch Gmbh | Method for checking the beam generating means and the beam accelerating means of an ion beam therapy system |
DE19907207A1 (en) | 1999-02-19 | 2000-08-31 | Schwerionenforsch Gmbh | Ionization chamber for ion beams and method for monitoring the intensity of an ion beam |
DE19907121A1 (en) | 1999-02-19 | 2000-08-31 | Schwerionenforsch Gmbh | Procedure for checking the beam guidance of an ion beam therapy system |
EP1041579A1 (en) | 1999-04-01 | 2000-10-04 | GSI Gesellschaft für Schwerionenforschung mbH | Gantry with an ion-optical system |
US6433494B1 (en) | 1999-04-22 | 2002-08-13 | Victor V. Kulish | Inductional undulative EH-accelerator |
EP1069809A1 (en) | 1999-07-13 | 2001-01-17 | Ion Beam Applications S.A. | Isochronous cyclotron and method of extraction of charged particles from such cyclotron |
US6260999B1 (en) | 1999-07-26 | 2001-07-17 | Siemens Medical Systems, Inc. | Isocenter localization using electronic portal imaging |
JP3602985B2 (en) | 1999-07-29 | 2004-12-15 | 株式会社日立製作所 | Method and apparatus for controlling circular accelerator |
JP2001085200A (en) | 1999-09-14 | 2001-03-30 | Hitachi Ltd | Accelerator system |
US6903351B1 (en) | 1999-09-27 | 2005-06-07 | Hitachi, Ltd. | Charged particle beam irradiation equipment having scanning electromagnet power supplies |
EE200200225A (en) | 1999-10-29 | 2003-06-16 | Basf Aktiengesellschaft | L-pantolactone hydrolase and method for producing D-pantolactone |
US6545436B1 (en) | 1999-11-24 | 2003-04-08 | Adelphi Technology, Inc. | Magnetic containment system for the production of radiation from high energy electrons using solid targets |
US6725078B2 (en) | 2000-01-31 | 2004-04-20 | St. Louis University | System combining proton beam irradiation and magnetic resonance imaging |
US7109505B1 (en) | 2000-02-11 | 2006-09-19 | Carl Zeiss Ag | Shaped biocompatible radiation shield and method for making same |
US6421416B1 (en) | 2000-02-11 | 2002-07-16 | Photoelectron Corporation | Apparatus for local radiation therapy |
CA2400406C (en) | 2000-02-18 | 2012-05-08 | William Beaumont Hospital | Cone-beam computerized tomography with a flat-panel imager |
DE10010523C2 (en) | 2000-03-07 | 2002-08-14 | Schwerionenforsch Gmbh | Ion beam system for the irradiation of tumor tissue |
CA2305938C (en) | 2000-04-10 | 2007-07-03 | Vladimir I. Gorokhovsky | Filtered cathodic arc deposition method and apparatus |
AU2001274814B2 (en) | 2000-04-27 | 2004-04-01 | Loma Linda University | Nanodosimeter based on single ion detection |
DE10025913A1 (en) | 2000-05-26 | 2001-12-06 | Schwerionenforsch Gmbh | Tumor patient positioning device for heavy-ion therapy chamber has mechanism holding tumor of sitting patient in isocentre of heavy-ion beam |
DE10031074A1 (en) | 2000-06-30 | 2002-01-31 | Schwerionenforsch Gmbh | Device for irradiating a tumor tissue |
JP3705091B2 (en) | 2000-07-27 | 2005-10-12 | 株式会社日立製作所 | Medical accelerator system and operating method thereof |
US6906338B2 (en) | 2000-08-09 | 2005-06-14 | The Regents Of The University Of California | Laser driven ion accelerator |
JP2002051997A (en) | 2000-08-09 | 2002-02-19 | Nippon Colin Co Ltd | Heart sound analyzer |
DE10057824A1 (en) | 2000-11-21 | 2002-06-06 | Schwerionenforsch Gmbh | Device and method for adjusting an ion beam spot size in tumor radiation |
US6470068B2 (en) | 2001-01-19 | 2002-10-22 | Cheng Chin-An | X-ray computer tomography scanning system |
JP2002210028A (en) | 2001-01-23 | 2002-07-30 | Mitsubishi Electric Corp | Radiation irradiating system and radiation irradiating method |
JP3779878B2 (en) | 2001-01-30 | 2006-05-31 | 株式会社日立製作所 | Multi-leaf collimator |
EP1358656B1 (en) | 2001-02-05 | 2007-04-04 | Gesellschaft für Schwerionenforschung mbH | Apparatus for generating and selecting ions used in a heavy ion cancer therapy facility |
EP1265462A1 (en) | 2001-06-08 | 2002-12-11 | Ion Beam Applications S.A. | Device and method for the intensity control of a beam extracted from a particle accelerator |
JP2003086400A (en) | 2001-09-11 | 2003-03-20 | Hitachi Ltd | Accelerator system and medical accelerator facility |
US6781060B2 (en) | 2002-07-26 | 2004-08-24 | X-Ray Optical Systems Incorporated | Electrical connector, a cable sleeve, and a method for fabricating an electrical connection |
DE50307871D1 (en) | 2002-01-25 | 2007-09-20 | Schwerionenforsch Gmbh | DETECTOR FOR DETECTING PARTICLE RAYS AND METHOD FOR THE PRODUCTION THEREOF |
DE10205949B4 (en) | 2002-02-12 | 2013-04-25 | Gsi Helmholtzzentrum Für Schwerionenforschung Gmbh | A method and apparatus for controlling a raster scan irradiation apparatus for heavy ions or protons with beam extraction |
JP3691020B2 (en) | 2002-02-28 | 2005-08-31 | 株式会社日立製作所 | Medical charged particle irradiation equipment |
JP4072359B2 (en) | 2002-02-28 | 2008-04-09 | 株式会社日立製作所 | Charged particle beam irradiation equipment |
JP3801938B2 (en) | 2002-03-26 | 2006-07-26 | 株式会社日立製作所 | Particle beam therapy system and method for adjusting charged particle beam trajectory |
EP1358908A1 (en) | 2002-05-03 | 2003-11-05 | Ion Beam Applications S.A. | Device for irradiation therapy with charged particles |
EP1531902A1 (en) | 2002-05-31 | 2005-05-25 | Ion Beam Applications S.A. | Apparatus for irradiating a target volume |
US6777700B2 (en) | 2002-06-12 | 2004-08-17 | Hitachi, Ltd. | Particle beam irradiation system and method of adjusting irradiation apparatus |
EP1385362A1 (en) | 2002-07-22 | 2004-01-28 | Ion Beam Applications S.A. | Cyclotron provided with new particle beam sweeping means |
US6785359B2 (en) | 2002-07-30 | 2004-08-31 | Ge Medical Systems Global Technology Company, Llc | Cathode for high emission x-ray tube |
DE10241178B4 (en) | 2002-09-05 | 2007-03-29 | Mt Aerospace Ag | Isokinetic gantry arrangement for the isocentric guidance of a particle beam and method for its design |
WO2004026401A1 (en) | 2002-09-18 | 2004-04-01 | Paul Scherrer Institut | System for performing proton therapy |
JP3748426B2 (en) | 2002-09-30 | 2006-02-22 | 株式会社日立製作所 | Medical particle beam irradiation equipment |
WO2004049770A1 (en) | 2002-11-25 | 2004-06-10 | Ion Beam Applications S.A. | Cyclotron |
KR101077630B1 (en) | 2003-01-02 | 2011-10-27 | 로마 린다 유니버시티 메디칼 센터 | Configuration management and retrieval system for proton beam therapy system |
EP1587421A2 (en) | 2003-01-09 | 2005-10-26 | Koninklijke Philips Electronics N.V. | Respiration monitor for computed tomography |
EP1439566B1 (en) | 2003-01-17 | 2019-08-28 | ICT, Integrated Circuit Testing Gesellschaft für Halbleiterprüftechnik mbH | Charged particle beam apparatus and method for operating the same |
US20040218719A1 (en) | 2003-01-21 | 2004-11-04 | Brown Kevin John | Computed tomogrophy scanning |
WO2004073364A1 (en) | 2003-02-17 | 2004-08-26 | Mitsubishi Denki Kabushiki Kaisha | Charged particle accelerator |
JP3748433B2 (en) | 2003-03-05 | 2006-02-22 | 株式会社日立製作所 | Bed positioning device and positioning method thereof |
JP3859605B2 (en) | 2003-03-07 | 2006-12-20 | 株式会社日立製作所 | Particle beam therapy system and particle beam extraction method |
JP3655292B2 (en) | 2003-04-14 | 2005-06-02 | 株式会社日立製作所 | Particle beam irradiation apparatus and method for adjusting charged particle beam irradiation apparatus |
JP2004321408A (en) | 2003-04-23 | 2004-11-18 | Mitsubishi Electric Corp | Radiation irradiation device and radiation irradiation method |
DE602004017366D1 (en) | 2003-05-13 | 2008-12-04 | Hitachi Ltd | Device for irradiation with particle beams and radiation planning unit |
EP1624933B1 (en) | 2003-05-13 | 2007-07-18 | Ion Beam Applications S.A. | Method and system for automatic beam allocation in a multi-room particle beam treatment facility |
US6770888B1 (en) | 2003-05-15 | 2004-08-03 | Axcelis Technologies, Inc. | High mass resolution magnet for ribbon beam ion implanters |
US7367955B2 (en) | 2003-06-13 | 2008-05-06 | Wisconsin Alumni Research Foundation | Combined laser spirometer motion tracking system for radiotherapy |
JP2005027681A (en) | 2003-07-07 | 2005-02-03 | Hitachi Ltd | Treatment device using charged particle and treatment system using charged particle |
US6838676B1 (en) | 2003-07-21 | 2005-01-04 | Hbar Technologies, Llc | Particle beam processing system |
US7199382B2 (en) | 2003-08-12 | 2007-04-03 | Loma Linda University Medical Center | Patient alignment system with external measurement and object coordination for radiation therapy system |
JP3685194B2 (en) | 2003-09-10 | 2005-08-17 | 株式会社日立製作所 | Particle beam therapy device, range modulation rotation device, and method of attaching range modulation rotation device |
US7342516B2 (en) | 2003-10-08 | 2008-03-11 | Hitachi, Ltd. | Method and apparatus for communicating map and route guidance information for vehicle navigation |
JP4114590B2 (en) | 2003-10-24 | 2008-07-09 | 株式会社日立製作所 | Particle beam therapy system |
JP3912364B2 (en) | 2003-11-07 | 2007-05-09 | 株式会社日立製作所 | Particle beam therapy system |
DE602004011560T2 (en) | 2003-12-02 | 2009-02-05 | Radinova Ab | MORE ROOM RADIATION TREATMENT SYSTEM |
ATE414987T1 (en) | 2003-12-02 | 2008-12-15 | Comet Holding Ag | MODULAR X-RAY TUBE AND METHOD FOR PRODUCING SAME |
JP3643371B1 (en) | 2003-12-10 | 2005-04-27 | 株式会社日立製作所 | Method of adjusting particle beam irradiation apparatus and irradiation field forming apparatus |
JP4443917B2 (en) | 2003-12-26 | 2010-03-31 | 株式会社日立製作所 | Particle beam therapy system |
US7651459B2 (en) | 2004-01-06 | 2010-01-26 | Neuronetics, Inc. | Method and apparatus for coil positioning for TMS studies |
CA2556934C (en) | 2004-02-20 | 2018-05-22 | James F. Dempsey | System for delivering conformal radiation therapy while simultaneously imaging soft tissue |
CA2461964A1 (en) | 2004-03-19 | 2005-09-19 | Is2 Medical Systems Inc. | A system for a medical nuclear camera |
US7310404B2 (en) | 2004-03-24 | 2007-12-18 | Canon Kabushiki Kaisha | Radiation CT radiographing device, radiation CT radiographing system, and radiation CT radiographing method using the same |
EP1584353A1 (en) | 2004-04-05 | 2005-10-12 | Paul Scherrer Institut | A system for delivery of proton therapy |
JP4497997B2 (en) | 2004-04-21 | 2010-07-07 | キヤノン株式会社 | Radiation imaging apparatus and control method thereof |
DE102004027071A1 (en) | 2004-05-19 | 2006-01-05 | Gesellschaft für Schwerionenforschung mbH | Beam feeder for medical particle accelerator has arbitration unit with switching logic, monitoring unit and sequential control and provides direct access of control room of irradiation-active surgery room for particle beam interruption |
DE202004009421U1 (en) | 2004-06-16 | 2005-11-03 | Gesellschaft für Schwerionenforschung mbH | Particle accelerator for ion beam radiation therapy |
EP1618831A3 (en) | 2004-06-29 | 2006-04-19 | Nippon Cable System Inc. | A moving device in pipe lines |
US7515681B2 (en) | 2004-06-30 | 2009-04-07 | Lexitek, Inc. | High resolution proton beam monitor |
DE102004032012B4 (en) | 2004-07-01 | 2008-09-18 | Siemens Ag | Device for placing a patient |
US7208748B2 (en) | 2004-07-21 | 2007-04-24 | Still River Systems, Inc. | Programmable particle scatterer for radiation therapy beam formation |
ES2720574T3 (en) | 2004-07-21 | 2019-07-23 | Mevion Medical Systems Inc | Programmable radio frequency waveform generator for a synchrocycle |
JP4489529B2 (en) | 2004-07-28 | 2010-06-23 | 株式会社日立製作所 | Particle beam therapy system and control system for particle beam therapy system |
EP1623738B1 (en) | 2004-08-06 | 2007-09-12 | BrainLAB AG | Volumetric imaging in a radiation therapy device |
JP4508789B2 (en) | 2004-09-07 | 2010-07-21 | キヤノン株式会社 | X-ray equipment |
JP2006098056A (en) | 2004-09-28 | 2006-04-13 | Hitachi Ltd | Corpuscular ray irradiation system |
JP2006128087A (en) | 2004-09-30 | 2006-05-18 | Hitachi Ltd | Charged particle beam emitting device and charged particle beam emitting method |
JP3806723B2 (en) | 2004-11-16 | 2006-08-09 | 株式会社日立製作所 | Particle beam irradiation system |
EP1709994A1 (en) | 2005-04-04 | 2006-10-11 | Ion Beam Applications S.A. | Patient positioning imaging device and method |
US20060163496A1 (en) | 2005-01-24 | 2006-07-27 | Kazuo Hiramoto | Ion beam delivery equipment and an ion beam delivery method |
US7193227B2 (en) | 2005-01-24 | 2007-03-20 | Hitachi, Ltd. | Ion beam therapy system and its couch positioning method |
CN100500095C (en) | 2005-01-31 | 2009-06-17 | 株式会社东芝 | X-ray diagnostic apparatus |
US7938121B2 (en) | 2005-02-11 | 2011-05-10 | Merit Medical Systems, Inc. | Abdominal restraint for medical procedures |
JP4219905B2 (en) | 2005-02-25 | 2009-02-04 | 株式会社日立製作所 | Rotating gantry for radiation therapy equipment |
JP5094707B2 (en) | 2005-03-09 | 2012-12-12 | パウル・シェラー・インスティトゥート | A system that captures X-ray images by Beams Eye View (BEV) with a wide field of view at the same time as proton therapy |
JP2006280457A (en) | 2005-03-31 | 2006-10-19 | Hitachi Ltd | Apparatus and method for radiating charged particle beam |
JP4158931B2 (en) | 2005-04-13 | 2008-10-01 | 三菱電機株式会社 | Particle beam therapy system |
US7492858B2 (en) | 2005-05-20 | 2009-02-17 | Varian Medical Systems, Inc. | System and method for imaging and treatment of tumorous tissue in breasts using computed tomography and radiotherapy |
US7385203B2 (en) | 2005-06-07 | 2008-06-10 | Hitachi, Ltd. | Charged particle beam extraction system and method |
US7349522B2 (en) | 2005-06-22 | 2008-03-25 | Board Of Trustees Of The University Of Arkansas | Dynamic radiation therapy simulation system |
JP3882843B2 (en) | 2005-06-30 | 2007-02-21 | 株式会社日立製作所 | Rotating irradiation device |
DE102005033471A1 (en) | 2005-07-18 | 2007-01-25 | Siemens Ag | A breathing body imaging procedure records breathing signals and takes X ray projections with source intensity modulate to depend on breath signal and breath signal ratio derived threshold |
KR20080039916A (en) | 2005-07-22 | 2008-05-07 | 토모테라피 인코포레이티드 | System and method of delivering radiation therapy to a moving region of interest |
US20070040115A1 (en) | 2005-08-05 | 2007-02-22 | Publicover Julia G | Method for calibrating particle beam energy |
DE102005041606B4 (en) | 2005-09-01 | 2007-09-27 | Siemens Ag | Patient positioning device for radiotherapy |
JP5245193B2 (en) | 2005-09-07 | 2013-07-24 | 株式会社日立製作所 | Charged particle beam irradiation system and charged particle beam extraction method |
US7955270B2 (en) | 2005-10-04 | 2011-06-07 | Stanford University | Method and apparatus for respiratory audio-visual biofeedback for imaging and radiotherapy |
CN101361156B (en) | 2005-11-18 | 2012-12-12 | 梅维昂医疗系统股份有限公司 | Charged particle radiation therapy |
EP1795229A1 (en) | 2005-12-12 | 2007-06-13 | Ion Beam Applications S.A. | Device and method for positioning a patient in a radiation therapy apparatus |
US7432516B2 (en) | 2006-01-24 | 2008-10-07 | Brookhaven Science Associates, Llc | Rapid cycling medical synchrotron and beam delivery system |
JP4696965B2 (en) | 2006-02-24 | 2011-06-08 | 株式会社日立製作所 | Charged particle beam irradiation system and charged particle beam extraction method |
US7526066B2 (en) | 2006-03-07 | 2009-04-28 | Orbital Therapy, Llc | Radiation therapy system for treating breasts and extremities |
JP4730167B2 (en) | 2006-03-29 | 2011-07-20 | 株式会社日立製作所 | Particle beam irradiation system |
US7394082B2 (en) | 2006-05-01 | 2008-07-01 | Hitachi, Ltd. | Ion beam delivery equipment and an ion beam delivery method |
US7394889B2 (en) | 2006-05-18 | 2008-07-01 | Varian Medical Systems Technologies, Inc. | Contrast-enhanced cone beam X-ray imaging, evaluation, monitoring and treatment delivery |
US7476883B2 (en) | 2006-05-26 | 2009-01-13 | Advanced Biomarker Technologies, Llc | Biomarker generator system |
US7402822B2 (en) | 2006-06-05 | 2008-07-22 | Varian Medical Systems Technologies, Inc. | Particle beam nozzle transport system |
US7851773B2 (en) | 2006-06-13 | 2010-12-14 | Semiquip, Inc. | Ion beam apparatus and method employing magnetic scanning |
EP2040800A2 (en) | 2006-07-06 | 2009-04-01 | Ion Beam Applications S.A. | Method and software for irradiating a target volume with a particle beam and device implementing same |
JP4206414B2 (en) | 2006-07-07 | 2009-01-14 | 株式会社日立製作所 | Charged particle beam extraction apparatus and charged particle beam extraction method |
JP4872540B2 (en) | 2006-08-31 | 2012-02-08 | 株式会社日立製作所 | Rotating irradiation treatment device |
US7701677B2 (en) | 2006-09-07 | 2010-04-20 | Massachusetts Institute Of Technology | Inductive quench for magnet protection |
CN101523544A (en) | 2006-10-13 | 2009-09-02 | 皇家飞利浦电子股份有限公司 | Electron optical apparatus, X-ray emitting device and method of producing an electron beam |
DE102006057709B4 (en) | 2006-12-07 | 2015-04-02 | Dräger Medical GmbH | Apparatus and method for determining a respiratory rate |
US7826593B2 (en) | 2006-12-19 | 2010-11-02 | C-Rad Innovation Ab | Collimator |
US9326742B2 (en) | 2007-01-01 | 2016-05-03 | Bayer Healthcare Llc | Systems for integrated radiopharmaceutical generation, preparation, transportation and administration |
EP1952841B1 (en) | 2007-01-16 | 2010-09-15 | Mitsubishi Heavy Industries, Ltd. | Radiotherapy system for performing radiotherapy with precise irradiation |
US7763873B2 (en) | 2007-02-27 | 2010-07-27 | Wisconsin Alumni Research Foundation | Ion radiation therapy system with variable beam resolution |
US7397901B1 (en) | 2007-02-28 | 2008-07-08 | Varian Medical Systems Technologies, Inc. | Multi-leaf collimator with leaves formed of different materials |
US7453076B2 (en) | 2007-03-23 | 2008-11-18 | Nanolife Sciences, Inc. | Bi-polar treatment facility for treating target cells with both positive and negative ions |
US7995813B2 (en) | 2007-04-12 | 2011-08-09 | Varian Medical Systems, Inc. | Reducing variation in radiation treatment therapy planning |
JP5500766B2 (en) | 2007-05-14 | 2014-05-21 | キヤノン株式会社 | X-ray imaging device |
CN101765406B (en) | 2007-05-24 | 2012-04-18 | P治疗有限公司 | Irradiation treatment apparatus and method |
JP4378396B2 (en) | 2007-06-22 | 2009-12-02 | 株式会社日立製作所 | Particle beam irradiation system |
US20110080172A1 (en) | 2007-07-03 | 2011-04-07 | Eric Jan Banning-Geertsma | Transmitter system, method of inducing a transient electromagnetic field in an earth formation, method of obtaining a transient electromagnetic response signal, and method of producing a hydrocarbon fluid |
JP4339904B2 (en) | 2007-08-17 | 2009-10-07 | 株式会社日立製作所 | Particle beam therapy system |
US7848488B2 (en) | 2007-09-10 | 2010-12-07 | Varian Medical Systems, Inc. | Radiation systems having tiltable gantry |
US7634057B2 (en) | 2007-09-18 | 2009-12-15 | Moshe Ein-Gal | Radiotherapy system with turntable |
US8003964B2 (en) | 2007-10-11 | 2011-08-23 | Still River Systems Incorporated | Applying a particle beam to a patient |
US8581523B2 (en) | 2007-11-30 | 2013-11-12 | Mevion Medical Systems, Inc. | Interrupted particle source |
JP5074915B2 (en) | 2007-12-21 | 2012-11-14 | 株式会社日立製作所 | Charged particle beam irradiation system |
US7919765B2 (en) | 2008-03-20 | 2011-04-05 | Varian Medical Systems Particle Therapy Gmbh | Non-continuous particle beam irradiation method and apparatus |
US7801277B2 (en) | 2008-03-26 | 2010-09-21 | General Electric Company | Field emitter based electron source with minimized beam emittance growth |
EP2105763A1 (en) | 2008-03-29 | 2009-09-30 | Ion Beam Applications S.A. | Device and method for measuring characteristics of an ion beam |
JP4691574B2 (en) | 2008-05-14 | 2011-06-01 | 株式会社日立製作所 | Charged particle beam extraction apparatus and charged particle beam extraction method |
JP4691576B2 (en) | 2008-05-20 | 2011-06-01 | 株式会社日立製作所 | Particle beam therapy system |
US7953205B2 (en) | 2008-05-22 | 2011-05-31 | Vladimir Balakin | Synchronized X-ray / breathing method and apparatus used in conjunction with a charged particle cancer therapy system |
US8188688B2 (en) | 2008-05-22 | 2012-05-29 | Vladimir Balakin | Magnetic field control method and apparatus used in conjunction with a charged particle cancer therapy system |
US8718231B2 (en) | 2008-05-22 | 2014-05-06 | Vladimir Balakin | X-ray tomography method and apparatus used in conjunction with a charged particle cancer therapy system |
US8436327B2 (en) | 2008-05-22 | 2013-05-07 | Vladimir Balakin | Multi-field charged particle cancer therapy method and apparatus |
AU2009249867B2 (en) | 2008-05-22 | 2013-05-02 | Vladimir Yegorovich Balakin | Charged particle beam extraction method and apparatus used in conjunction with a charged particle cancer therapy system |
US8642978B2 (en) | 2008-05-22 | 2014-02-04 | Vladimir Balakin | Charged particle cancer therapy dose distribution method and apparatus |
US7940894B2 (en) | 2008-05-22 | 2011-05-10 | Vladimir Balakin | Elongated lifetime X-ray method and apparatus used in conjunction with a charged particle cancer therapy system |
US8373143B2 (en) | 2008-05-22 | 2013-02-12 | Vladimir Balakin | Patient immobilization and repositioning method and apparatus used in conjunction with charged particle cancer therapy |
US9056199B2 (en) * | 2008-05-22 | 2015-06-16 | Vladimir Balakin | Charged particle treatment, rapid patient positioning apparatus and method of use thereof |
US8373146B2 (en) | 2008-05-22 | 2013-02-12 | Vladimir Balakin | RF accelerator method and apparatus used in conjunction with a charged particle cancer therapy system |
US8519365B2 (en) * | 2008-05-22 | 2013-08-27 | Vladimir Balakin | Charged particle cancer therapy imaging method and apparatus |
US20090314960A1 (en) | 2008-05-22 | 2009-12-24 | Vladimir Balakin | Patient positioning method and apparatus used in conjunction with a charged particle cancer therapy system |
US8378311B2 (en) | 2008-05-22 | 2013-02-19 | Vladimir Balakin | Synchrotron power cycling apparatus and method of use thereof |
US8368038B2 (en) | 2008-05-22 | 2013-02-05 | Vladimir Balakin | Method and apparatus for intensity control of a charged particle beam extracted from a synchrotron |
US8089054B2 (en) | 2008-05-22 | 2012-01-03 | Vladimir Balakin | Charged particle beam acceleration and extraction method and apparatus used in conjunction with a charged particle cancer therapy system |
US9044600B2 (en) | 2008-05-22 | 2015-06-02 | Vladimir Balakin | Proton tomography apparatus and method of operation therefor |
US8710462B2 (en) | 2008-05-22 | 2014-04-29 | Vladimir Balakin | Charged particle cancer therapy beam path control method and apparatus |
US8045679B2 (en) | 2008-05-22 | 2011-10-25 | Vladimir Balakin | Charged particle cancer therapy X-ray method and apparatus |
US8309941B2 (en) | 2008-05-22 | 2012-11-13 | Vladimir Balakin | Charged particle cancer therapy and patient breath monitoring method and apparatus |
US8399866B2 (en) | 2008-05-22 | 2013-03-19 | Vladimir Balakin | Charged particle extraction apparatus and method of use thereof |
US8766217B2 (en) | 2008-05-22 | 2014-07-01 | Vladimir Yegorovich Balakin | Multi-field charged particle cancer therapy method and apparatus |
US8969834B2 (en) * | 2008-05-22 | 2015-03-03 | Vladimir Balakin | Charged particle therapy patient constraint apparatus and method of use thereof |
US8624528B2 (en) | 2008-05-22 | 2014-01-07 | Vladimir Balakin | Method and apparatus coordinating synchrotron acceleration periods with patient respiration periods |
US7939809B2 (en) * | 2008-05-22 | 2011-05-10 | Vladimir Balakin | Charged particle beam extraction method and apparatus used in conjunction with a charged particle cancer therapy system |
US8378321B2 (en) | 2008-05-22 | 2013-02-19 | Vladimir Balakin | Charged particle cancer therapy and patient positioning method and apparatus |
US7943913B2 (en) | 2008-05-22 | 2011-05-17 | Vladimir Balakin | Negative ion source method and apparatus used in conjunction with a charged particle cancer therapy system |
US8374314B2 (en) | 2008-05-22 | 2013-02-12 | Vladimir Balakin | Synchronized X-ray / breathing method and apparatus used in conjunction with a charged particle cancer therapy system |
US8093564B2 (en) | 2008-05-22 | 2012-01-10 | Vladimir Balakin | Ion beam focusing lens method and apparatus used in conjunction with a charged particle cancer therapy system |
US7834336B2 (en) | 2008-05-28 | 2010-11-16 | Varian Medical Systems, Inc. | Treatment of patient tumors by charged particle therapy |
US7987053B2 (en) | 2008-05-30 | 2011-07-26 | Varian Medical Systems International Ag | Monitor units calculation method for proton fields |
JP4691583B2 (en) | 2008-07-02 | 2011-06-01 | 株式会社日立製作所 | Charged particle beam irradiation system and charged particle beam extraction method |
EP2140913A1 (en) | 2008-07-03 | 2010-01-06 | Ion Beam Applications S.A. | Device and method for particle therapy verification |
US8627822B2 (en) | 2008-07-14 | 2014-01-14 | Vladimir Balakin | Semi-vertical positioning method and apparatus used in conjunction with a charged particle cancer therapy system |
WO2010019584A1 (en) | 2008-08-11 | 2010-02-18 | Ion Beam Applications S.A. | High-current dc proton accelerator |
US7817778B2 (en) | 2008-08-29 | 2010-10-19 | Varian Medical Systems International Ag | Interactive treatment plan optimization for radiation therapy |
JP2010068929A (en) | 2008-09-17 | 2010-04-02 | Fujifilm Corp | Mamma x-ray transmission plane image and tomographic image radiographing apparatus |
US7940891B2 (en) | 2008-10-22 | 2011-05-10 | Varian Medical Systems, Inc. | Methods and systems for treating breast cancer using external beam radiation |
BRPI0924903B8 (en) | 2009-03-04 | 2021-06-22 | Zakrytoe Aktsionernoe Obshchestvo Protom | apparatus for generating a negative ion beam for use in charged particle radiation therapy and method for generating a negative ion beam for use with charged particle radiation therapy |
ATE511890T1 (en) | 2009-04-22 | 2011-06-15 | Ion Beam Applic | PARTICLE BEAM THERAPY SYSTEM WITH X-RAY IMAGING DEVICE |
US7894574B1 (en) | 2009-09-22 | 2011-02-22 | Varian Medical Systems International Ag | Apparatus and method pertaining to dynamic use of a radiation therapy collimator |
JP5133319B2 (en) | 2009-09-30 | 2013-01-30 | 株式会社日立製作所 | Particle beam irradiation system and control method thereof |
US8009804B2 (en) | 2009-10-20 | 2011-08-30 | Varian Medical Systems International Ag | Dose calculation method for multiple fields |
WO2011060141A1 (en) | 2009-11-12 | 2011-05-19 | Oncology Tech Llc | An integrated beam modifying assembly for use with a proton beam therapy machine |
US8933651B2 (en) | 2012-11-16 | 2015-01-13 | Vladimir Balakin | Charged particle accelerator magnet apparatus and method of use thereof |
-
2014
- 2014-06-02 US US14/293,861 patent/US9498649B2/en active Active - Reinstated
-
2016
- 2016-08-09 US US15/232,512 patent/US20170087381A1/en not_active Abandoned
Patent Citations (12)
Publication number | Priority date | Publication date | Assignee | Title |
---|---|---|---|---|
US6034377A (en) * | 1997-11-12 | 2000-03-07 | Mitsubishi Denki Kabushiki Kaisha | Charged particle beam irradiation apparatus and method of irradiation with charged particle beam |
US6246066B1 (en) * | 1997-12-25 | 2001-06-12 | Mitsubishi Denki Kabushiki Kaisha | Magnetic field generator and charged particle beam irradiator |
US6826423B1 (en) * | 1999-01-04 | 2004-11-30 | Midco-Medical Instrumentation And Diagnostics Corporation | Whole body stereotactic localization and immobilization system |
US20060002511A1 (en) * | 2003-08-12 | 2006-01-05 | Miller Daniel W | Modular patient support system |
US7860550B2 (en) * | 2004-04-06 | 2010-12-28 | Accuray, Inc. | Patient positioning assembly |
US20090209852A1 (en) * | 2005-03-02 | 2009-08-20 | Calypso Medical Technologies, Inc. | Systems and Methods for Treating a Patient Using Guided Radiation Therapy or Surgery |
US8210899B2 (en) * | 2006-11-21 | 2012-07-03 | Loma Linda University Medical Center | Device and method for immobilizing patients for breast radiation therapy |
US20090129556A1 (en) * | 2007-11-19 | 2009-05-21 | Pyronia Medical Technologies, Incorporated | Patient positioning system and methods for diagnostic radiology and radiotherapy |
US20120264997A1 (en) * | 2008-04-25 | 2012-10-18 | Radiadyne, Llc | External immobilizer |
US20140257011A1 (en) * | 2009-04-17 | 2014-09-11 | Stephen L. Spotts | Treatment delivery control system and method of operation thereof |
US20120294424A1 (en) * | 2010-01-18 | 2012-11-22 | The Board Of Trustees Of The Leland Stanford Junior University | Method And Apparatus for Radioablation of Regular Targets such as Sympathetic Nerves |
US20140100409A1 (en) * | 2012-10-09 | 2014-04-10 | Milford Burton Kime | Targeted Nuclear Fusion Tumor Therapy |
Cited By (2)
Publication number | Priority date | Publication date | Assignee | Title |
---|---|---|---|---|
US11958183B2 (en) | 2019-09-19 | 2024-04-16 | The Research Foundation For The State University Of New York | Negotiation-based human-robot collaboration via augmented reality |
US20230269860A1 (en) * | 2022-02-21 | 2023-08-24 | Leidos Engineering, LLC | High electron trapping ratio betatron |
Also Published As
Publication number | Publication date |
---|---|
US9498649B2 (en) | 2016-11-22 |
US20150343238A1 (en) | 2015-12-03 |
Similar Documents
Publication | Publication Date | Title |
---|---|---|
US9498649B2 (en) | Charged particle cancer therapy patient constraint apparatus and method of use thereof | |
US8399866B2 (en) | Charged particle extraction apparatus and method of use thereof | |
US9056199B2 (en) | Charged particle treatment, rapid patient positioning apparatus and method of use thereof | |
US8519365B2 (en) | Charged particle cancer therapy imaging method and apparatus | |
US9044600B2 (en) | Proton tomography apparatus and method of operation therefor | |
US8969834B2 (en) | Charged particle therapy patient constraint apparatus and method of use thereof | |
US8378311B2 (en) | Synchrotron power cycling apparatus and method of use thereof | |
US8941084B2 (en) | Charged particle cancer therapy dose distribution method and apparatus | |
US8637833B2 (en) | Synchrotron power supply apparatus and method of use thereof | |
US8614429B2 (en) | Multi-axis/multi-field charged particle cancer therapy method and apparatus | |
US8569717B2 (en) | Intensity modulated three-dimensional radiation scanning method and apparatus | |
US9757594B2 (en) | Rotatable targeting magnet apparatus and method of use thereof in conjunction with a charged particle cancer therapy system | |
US8933651B2 (en) | Charged particle accelerator magnet apparatus and method of use thereof | |
US9168392B1 (en) | Charged particle cancer therapy system X-ray apparatus and method of use thereof | |
US9543106B2 (en) | Tandem charged particle accelerator including carbon ion beam injector and carbon stripping foil | |
US8975600B2 (en) | Treatment delivery control system and method of operation thereof | |
US20160250503A1 (en) | Treatment delivery control system and method of operation thereof | |
US10137316B2 (en) | Charged particle treatment, rapid patient positioning apparatus and method of use thereof | |
US9616252B2 (en) | Multi-field cancer therapy apparatus and method of use thereof | |
US9302122B2 (en) | Co-rotatable targeting apparatus and method of use thereof in conjunction with a charged particle cancer therapy system | |
US9682254B2 (en) | Cancer surface searing apparatus and method of use thereof | |
US11648420B2 (en) | Imaging assisted integrated tomography—cancer treatment apparatus and method of use thereof |
Legal Events
Date | Code | Title | Description |
---|---|---|---|
STCB | Information on status: application discontinuation |
Free format text: ABANDONED -- FAILURE TO PAY ISSUE FEE |